Docs: minor correction
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.86"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552015
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.endtable
440
441The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448.cindex "web site"
449.cindex "FTP site"
450The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453&%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454&%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457.cindex "wiki"
458.cindex "FAQ"
459As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496.cindex "training courses"
497Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503.cindex "bug reports"
504.cindex "reporting bugs"
505Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513.cindex "FTP site"
514.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516.display
517&*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518.endd
519This is mirrored by
520.display
521&*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522.endd
523The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531.display
532&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534.endd
535where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540.cindex "distribution" "public key"
541.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548&_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554&url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564.endd
565For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573.display
574&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578.endd
579These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584.ilist
585.cindex "limitations of Exim"
586.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592.next
593.cindex "domainless addresses"
594.cindex "address" "without domain"
595Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599arrival.
600.next
601.cindex "transport" "external"
602.cindex "external transports"
603The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609.next
610Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613other means.
614.next
615Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619a number of common scanners are provided.
620.endlist
621
622
623.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6403, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652.cindex "terminology definitions"
653.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656below) by a blank line.
657
658.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665rise to further bounce messages.
666
667The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670otherwise.
671
672The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675until a later time.
676
677The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681.cindex "envelope, definition of"
682.cindex "sender" "definition of"
683A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691.cindex "header section" "definition of"
692The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696line.
697
698.cindex "local part" "definition of"
699.cindex "domain" "definition of"
700The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711.cindex "return path" "definition of"
712&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713message's envelope.
714
715.cindex "queue" "definition of"
716The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743.cindex "incorporated code"
744.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745.cindex "PCRE"
746.cindex "OpenDMARC"
747A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749.ilist
750Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756.next
757.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762following statements:
763
764.blockquote
765Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770version.
771This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775restrictions applied to it).
776.endblockquote
777.next
778.cindex "SPA authentication"
779.cindex "Samba project"
780.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784under the Gnu GPL.
785.next
786.cindex "Cyrus"
787.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792conditions expressed therein.
793
794.blockquote
795Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799are met:
800
801.olist
802Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804.next
805Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808distribution.
809.next
810The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813details, please contact
814.display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821.endd
822.next
823Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824acknowledgment:
825
826&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836.endlist
837.endblockquote
838
839.next
840.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841.cindex "X-windows"
842.cindex "Athena"
843The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848.blockquote
849Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852All Rights Reserved
853
854Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868SOFTWARE.
869.endblockquote
870
871.next
872.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877source code.
878
879.next
880Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883.endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897.cindex "design philosophy"
898Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907.cindex "policy control" "overview"
908Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914.ilist
915.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924error code.
925.next
926An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928.next
929When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933.next
934When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939.next
940Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943.next
944After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946runs at the start of every delivery process.
947.endlist
948
949
950
951.section "User filters" "SECID12"
952.cindex "filter" "introduction"
953.cindex "Sieve filter"
954In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959of filtering are available:
960
961.ilist
962Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963by RFC 3028.
964.next
965Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967.endlist
968
969User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975.cindex "format" "of message id"
976.cindex "id of message"
977.cindex "base62"
978.cindex "base36"
979.cindex "Darwin"
980.cindex "Cygwin"
981Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988not always case-sensitive.
989
990.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996somewhat eccentric:
997
998.ilist
999The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002way of representing the date and time of day).
1003.next
1004After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005received the message.
1006.next
1007There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008.olist
1009.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014.next
1015If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017(1/100) of a second.
1018.endlist
1019.endlist
1020
1021After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029.cindex "receiving mail"
1030.cindex "message" "reception"
1031The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034there are several possibilities:
1035
1036.ilist
1037If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040.next
1041If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047.next
1048If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053.next
1054A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058.endlist
1059
1060
1061.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112affect file system performance.
1113
1114The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136.cindex "message" "life of"
1137.cindex "message" "frozen"
1138A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150to be sent.
1151
1152.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158.cindex "message" "log file for"
1159.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168systems.
1169
1170.cindex "journal file"
1171.cindex "file" "journal"
1172All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191.cindex "router" "definition of"
1192.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207the driver's features in general.
1208
1209A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213to be bounced.
1214
1215A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232configuration.
1233
1234The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242configured to fail the address.
1243
1244The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261.cindex "router" "for verification"
1262.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267&%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282.cindex "router" "running details"
1283.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284.cindex "router" "result of running"
1285As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289the following:
1290
1291.ilist
1292&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294original address ceases,
1295.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300end of routing.
1301
1302Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307.next
1308&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313.next
1314&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319.next
1320&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323.next
1324&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328.next
1329&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331.endlist
1332
1333If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347.cindex "case of local parts"
1348.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365.ilist
1366The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371of any other conditions.
1372.next
1373Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376address.
1377Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382.next
1383If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388.next
1389Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392.next
1393Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395.next
1396If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397of domains that it defines.
1398.next
1399.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409.next
1410.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412.vindex "&$home$&"
1413If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417remaining preconditions.
1418.next
1419If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423could lead to confusion.
1424.next
1425If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426set of addresses that it defines.
1427.next
1428If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429specified files is tested.
1430.next
1431.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435.endlist
1436
1437
1438Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452.ilist
1453If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458filtering'&.
1459.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468filter.
1469.next
1470Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474processed entirely independently of each other.
1475.next
1476.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485.next
1486When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493addresses to the same domain.
1494.next
1495Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503.next
1504.cindex "queue runner"
1505When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514.next
1515.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521.next
1522If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525messages to other addresses.
1526.next
1527.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530&'deferred'&.
1531.next
1532When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535.endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543.cindex "queue runner"
1544Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551passed its retry time.
1552You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572also apply.
1573
1574If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577deferred,
1578.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1579Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602automatically.
1603
1604.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639.table2 140pt
1640.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648.endtable
1649
1650Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653.table2 140pt
1654.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661.endtable
1662
1663The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674system.
1675.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683.cindex "PCRE library"
1684Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692If your operating system has no
1693PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725possibilities:
1726
1727.olist
1728A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730.next
1731.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735file name is used unmodified.
1736.next
1737.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741.next
1742If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745.next
1746To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17482.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752.next
1753.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755&url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756operates on a single file.
1757.endlist
1758
1759.cindex "USE_DB"
1760.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765.code
1766USE_DB=yes
1767.endd
1768Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780in one of these lines:
1781.code
1782DBMLIB = -ldb
1783DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784.endd
1785Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789this example:
1790.code
1791INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793.endd
1794There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825be logged.
1826
1827.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830facilities, you need to set
1831.code
1832WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833.endd
1834in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857.cindex "RFC 2047"
1858The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863(default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868&url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871.code
1872HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873.endd
1874to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888line option).
1889
1890If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892implementing SSL.
1893
1894If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895.code
1896SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898.endd
1899in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901.code
1902SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905.endd
1906.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908.code
1909SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911.endd
1912.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914.code
1915SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918.endd
1919in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920library and include files. For example:
1921.code
1922SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926.endd
1927.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929.code
1930SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933.endd
1934
1935You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956you might have
1957.code
1958USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961.endd
1962in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964.code
1965exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966.endd
1967in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973further details.
1974
1975
1976.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982library files.
1983
1984Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989Exim used to
1990have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996.cindex "lookup modules"
1997.cindex "dynamic modules"
1998.cindex ".so building"
1999On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001on demand.
2002This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004dependencies.
2005Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017on demand:
2018.code
2019LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022.endd
2023
2024
2025.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026.cindex "build directory"
2027Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057.code
2058FULLECHO='' make -e
2059.endd
2060The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073order:
2074.display
2075&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077&_Local/Makefile_&
2078&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082.endd
2083.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089and are often not needed.
2090
2091The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106default values are.
2107
2108
2109.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121containing the lines
2122.code
2123CC=cc
2124CFLAGS=-std1
2125.endd
2126If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144.code
2145LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148.endd
2149and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157errors.
2158
2159.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169syntax. For instance:
2170.code
2171LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177.endd
2178
2179.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182.code
2183EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184.endd
2185must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194.code
2195X11=/usr/X11R6
2196XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198.endd
2199These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201.code
2202X11=/usr/openwin
2203XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205.endd
2206If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207definition of all three of these variables into your
2208&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221libraries.
2222
2223.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242.cindex "building Eximon"
2243A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244where the files that are involved are
2245.display
2246&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252.endd
2253.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260.ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264.cindex "installing Exim"
2265.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286.cindex "system aliases file"
2287.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306over SMTP.
2307
2308It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310command such as
2311.code
2312make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313.endd
2314This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338command:
2339.code
2340make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341.endd
2342The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346command:
2347.code
2348(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349.endd
2350.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353.ilist
2354&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356.next
2357&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358installed binary.
2359.endlist
2360
2361INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362.code
2363make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364.endd
2365The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368.code
2369make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370.endd
2371
2372
2373
2374.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379&<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398.cindex "testing" "installation"
2399Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402.code
2403exim -bV
2404.endd
2405If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410example,
2411.display
2412&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413.endd
2414should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415.display
2416&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417.endd
2418a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420user agent. For example:
2421.code
2422exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423From: user@your.domain.example
2424To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427This is a test message.
2428^D
2429.endd
2430The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440.display
2441&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442.endd
2443You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450.cindex "lock files"
2451One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475production version.
2476
2477
2478.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498as follows:
2499.code
2500sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504.endd
2505Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507favourite user agent.
2508
2509You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534.code
2535/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536.endd
2537If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542.code
2543pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544.endd
2545to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571were present before any other options.
2572The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573standard output.
2574This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582format.
2583
2584.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589.cindex "&'runq'&"
2590.cindex "queue runner"
2591If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596.cindex "alias file" "building"
2597.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612.ilist
2613.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620.cindex '&"From"& line'
2621.cindex "envelope sender"
2622Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639that are available to trusted users.
2640.next
2641.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659false.
2660.endlist
2661
2662
2663&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683. creates a man page for the options.
2684. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686.literal xml
2687<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688.literal off
2689
2690
2691.vlist
2692.vitem &%--%&
2693.oindex "--"
2694.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699.vitem &%--help%&
2700.oindex "&%--help%&"
2701This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703no arguments.
2704
2705.vitem &%--version%&
2706.oindex "&%--version%&"
2707This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708displayed.
2709
2710.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715ignored by Exim.
2716
2717.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718.oindex "&%-B%&"
2719.cindex "8-bit characters"
2720.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724.vitem &%-bd%&
2725.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726.cindex "daemon"
2727.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728.cindex "queue runner"
2729This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743When a listening daemon
2744.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750running as root.
2751
2752When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756The SIGHUP signal
2757.cindex "SIGHUP"
2758.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766.vitem &%-bdf%&
2767.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771.vitem &%-be%&
2772.oindex "&%-be%&"
2773.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804of a file. For example:
2805.code
2806exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807.endd
2808The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815&%-be%&).
2816
2817.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823system filters are recognized.
2824
2825.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827.cindex "filter" "testing"
2828.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835supplied.
2836
2837If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840.code
2841exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842.endd
2843This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847.code
2848# Exim filter
2849# Sieve filter
2850.endd
2851it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854redirection lists.
2855
2856The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861When testing a filter file,
2862.cindex "&""From""& line"
2863.cindex "envelope sender"
2864.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869options).
2870
2871.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876&$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884actually being delivered.
2885
2886.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890prefix.
2891
2892.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896suffix.
2897
2898.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908after a full stop. For example:
2909.code
2910exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912.endd
2913When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915conversion to the canonical form is
2916&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924&*Warning 1*&:
2925.cindex "RFC 1413"
2926You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929connection.
2930
2931&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940session were authenticated.
2941
2942The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948specialized SMTP test program such as
2949&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957.vitem &%-bi%&
2958.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959.cindex "alias file" "building"
2960.cindex "building alias file"
2961.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966recognized.
2967
2968If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977.vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979.cindex "querying exim information"
2980We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988.cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002.vitem &%-bm%&
3003.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004.cindex "local message reception"
3005This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024The format
3025.cindex "message" "format"
3026.cindex "format" "message"
3027.cindex "&""From""& line"
3028.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032.code
3033From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035.endd
3036(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050.cindex "testing", "malware"
3051.cindex "malware scan test"
3052This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068.vitem &%-bnq%&
3069.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090.vitem &%-bP%&
3091.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097arguments, for example:
3098.code
3099exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100.endd
3101.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106users, the output is as in this example:
3107.code
3108mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109.endd
3110If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3111output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3112
3113If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3114configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3115backward compatibility.)
3116If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3117is the name of the file that was actually used.
3118
3119.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3120If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3121name will not be output.
3122
3123.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3124.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3125If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3126directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3127respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3128sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3129written directly into the spool directory.
3130
3131If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3132.code
3133exim -bP +local_domains
3134.endd
3135it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3136local part) and outputs what it finds.
3137
3138.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3139.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3140.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3141If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3142followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3143that driver are output. For example:
3144.code
3145exim -bP transport local_delivery
3146.endd
3147The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3148options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3149using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3150&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3151settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3152&%authenticators%&.
3153
3154.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3155If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3156are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3157for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3158The output format is one item per line.
3159
3160.vitem &%-bp%&
3161.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3162.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3163.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3164This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3165standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3166just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3167admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3168to allow any user to see the queue.
3169
3170Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3171.code
317225m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3173 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3174 <other addresses>
3175.endd
3176.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3177.cindex "size" "of message"
3178The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3179(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3180identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3181envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3182&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3183the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3184before the sender address.
3185
3186.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3187If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3188&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3189
3190The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3191displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3192been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3193expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3194displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3195complete.
3196
3197
3198.vitem &%-bpa%&
3199.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3200This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3201that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3202alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3203of just &"D"&.
3204
3205
3206.vitem &%-bpc%&
3207.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3208.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3209This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3210to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3211&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3212
3213
3214.vitem &%-bpr%&
3215.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3216This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3217chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3218lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3219going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3220
3221.vitem &%-bpra%&
3222.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3223This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3224
3225.vitem &%-bpru%&
3226.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3227This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3228
3229
3230.vitem &%-bpu%&
3231.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3232This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3233addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3234forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3235router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3236
3237
3238.vitem &%-brt%&
3239.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3240.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3241.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3242This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3243arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3244and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3245.code
3246exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3247Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3248.endd
3249See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3250argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3251&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3252contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3253retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3254with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3255rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3256sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3257used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3258.code
3259exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3260Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3261.endd
3262
3263.vitem &%-brw%&
3264.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3265.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3266.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3267This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3268a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3269complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3270would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3271&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3272
3273.vitem &%-bS%&
3274.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3275.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3276.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3277This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3278for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3279submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3280input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3281input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3282&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3283believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3284
3285The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3286dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3287provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3288
3289As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3290messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3291Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3292&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3293
3294Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3295as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3296QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3297
3298.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3299If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3300error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3301was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3302was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3303
3304More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3305&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3306
3307.vitem &%-bs%&
3308.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3309.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3310.cindex "local SMTP input"
3311This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3312on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3313policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3314Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3315messages to the MTA.
3316
3317In
3318.cindex "sender" "source of"
3319this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3320set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3321Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3322the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3323&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3324&%-bnq%& option is used.
3325
3326.cindex "inetd"
3327The
3328&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3329using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3330whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3331&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3332above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3333Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3334the listening daemon.
3335
3336.vitem &%-bt%&
3337.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3338.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3339.cindex "address" "testing"
3340This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3341as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3342written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3343user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3344sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3345
3346If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3347right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3348
3349Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3350&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3351security issues.
3352
3353Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3354(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3355written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3356&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3357genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3358program.
3359
3360.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3361The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3362failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3363code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3364
3365.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3366&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3367addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3368This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3369always shown.
3370
3371&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3372routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3373message,
3374.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3375you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3376&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3377default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3378whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3379those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3380doing such tests.
3381
3382.vitem &%-bV%&
3383.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3384.cindex "version number of Exim"
3385This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3386number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3387It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3388specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3389name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3390
3391As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3392configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3393values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3394detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3395alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3396realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3397dynamic testing facilities.
3398
3399.vitem &%-bv%&
3400.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3401.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3402.cindex "address" "verification"
3403This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3404taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3405not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3406happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3407(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3408including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3409
3410If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3411failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3412usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3413
3414If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3415right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3416
3417Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3418&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3419security issues.
3420
3421Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3422that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3423router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3424verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3425address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3426
3427If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3428address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3429latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3430causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3431addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3432and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3433to succeed.
3434
3435When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3436and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3437considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3438
3439The
3440.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3441return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3442failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3443code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3444
3445If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3446address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3447sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3448calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3449
3450.vitem &%-bvs%&
3451.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3452This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3453than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3454might happen.
3455
3456.vitem &%-bw%&
3457.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3458.cindex "daemon"
3459.cindex "inetd"
3460.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3461This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3462similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3463and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3464
3465In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3466listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3467inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3468each port only when the first connection is received.
3469
3470If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3471which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3472
3473.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3474.oindex "&%-C%&"
3475.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3476.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3477.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3478This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3479list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3480compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3481name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3482file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3483proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3484
3485When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3486from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3487runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3488However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3489file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3490which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3491listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3492CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3493not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3494
3495Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3496configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3497even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3498running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3499delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3500test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3501on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3502
3503If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3504prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3505must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3506However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3507CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3508usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3509unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3510
3511ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3512to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3513broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3514configuration file.
3515
3516The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3517syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3518caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3519require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3520specified by this option.
3521
3522
3523.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3524.oindex "&%-D%&"
3525.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3526This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3527(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3528unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3529If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3530completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3531
3532If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3533colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3534supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3535not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3536the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3537to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3538regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3539
3540The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3541command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3542string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3543synonymous:
3544.code
3545exim -DABC ...
3546exim -DABC= ...
3547.endd
3548To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3549quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3550example:
3551.code
3552exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3553.endd
3554&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3555
3556
3557.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3558.oindex "&%-d%&"
3559.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3560.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3561This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3562error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3563database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3564filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3565writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3566return code.
3567
3568When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3569standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3570some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3571made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3572of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3573debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3574no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3575are:
3576.display
3577&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3578&`auth `& authenticators
3579&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3580&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3581&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3582&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3583&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3584&`filter `& filter handling
3585&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3586&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3587&`ident `& ident lookup
3588&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3589&`lists `& matching things in lists
3590&`load `& system load checks
3591&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3592 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3593&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3594&`memory `& memory handling
3595&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3596&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3597&`queue_run `& queue runs
3598&`receive `& general message reception logic
3599&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3600&`retry `& retry handling
3601&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3602&`route `& address routing
3603&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3604&`tls `& TLS logic
3605&`transport `& transports
3606&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3607&`verify `& address verification logic
3608&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3609.endd
3610The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3611for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3612tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3613is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3614generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3615turn everything off.
3616
3617.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3618.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3619The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3620with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3621unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3622rather than stderr.
3623
3624The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3625&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3626However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3627daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3628automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3629run in parallel.
3630
3631The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3632of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3633in processing.
3634
3635If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3636any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3637
3638.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3639.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3640This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3641starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3642subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3643behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3644
3645.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3646.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3647This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3648handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3649described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3650
3651.vitem &%-E%&
3652.oindex "&%-E%&"
3653.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3654This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3655failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3656and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3657generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3658could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3659follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3660new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3661
3662.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3663.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3664There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3665called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3666example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3667form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3668
3669.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3670.oindex "&%-F%&"
3671.cindex "sender" "name"
3672.cindex "name" "of sender"
3673This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3674message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3675entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3676their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3677between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3678
3679.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3680.oindex "&%-f%&"
3681.cindex "sender" "address"
3682.cindex "address" "sender"
3683.cindex "trusted users"
3684.cindex "envelope sender"
3685.cindex "user" "trusted"
3686This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3687message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3688by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3689users to use it.
3690
3691Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3692trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3693options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3694of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3695domain.
3696
3697There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3698can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3699never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3700string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3701examples of shell commands:
3702.code
3703exim -f '<>' user@domain
3704exim -f "" user@domain
3705.endd
3706In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3707with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3708&%-bv%& options.
3709
3710Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3711it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3712refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3713though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3714
3715White
3716.cindex "&""From""& line"
3717space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3718given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3719locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3720&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3721if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3722
3723.vitem &%-G%&
3724.oindex "&%-G%&"
3725.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3726This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3727.code
3728control = suppress_local_fixups
3729.endd
3730for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3731bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3732in future.
3733
3734As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3735this option.
3736
3737.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3738.oindex "&%-h%&"
3739.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3740This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3741Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3742headers.)
3743
3744.vitem &%-i%&
3745.oindex "&%-i%&"
3746.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3747.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3748This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3749line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3750no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3751command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3752
3753.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3754.oindex "&%-L%&"
3755.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3756This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3757file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3758Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3759read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3760effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3761
3762The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3763
3764.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3765.oindex "&%-M%&"
3766.cindex "forcing delivery"
3767.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3768.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3769This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3770any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3771delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3772and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3773
3774Retry
3775.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3776hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3777the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3778to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3779which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3780for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3781
3782The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3783not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3784produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3785use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3786
3787.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3788.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3789.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3790.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3791This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3792message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3793id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3794active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3795can be used only by an admin user.
3796
3797.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3798 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3799.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3800.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3801.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3802.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3803This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3804by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3805an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3806given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3807must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3808
3809.vitem &%-MCA%&
3810.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3811This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3812by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3813connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3814
3815.vitem &%-MCD%&
3816.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3817This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3818by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3819remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3820
3821.vitem &%-MCP%&
3822.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3823This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3824by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3825which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3826
3827.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3828.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3829This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3830by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3831started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3832together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3833signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3834messages through the same SMTP connection.
3835
3836.vitem &%-MCS%&
3837.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3838This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3839by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3840SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3841connection.
3842
3843.vitem &%-MCT%&
3844.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3845This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3846by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3847host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3848
3849.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3850.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3851.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3852.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3853This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3854but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3855that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3856provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3857order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3858However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3859respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3860overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3861If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3862&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3863and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3864
3865.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3866.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3867.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3868.cindex "sender" "changing"
3869This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3870given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3871&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3872be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3873is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3874This option can be used only by an admin user.
3875
3876.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3877.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3878.cindex "freezing messages"
3879.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3880This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3881prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3882either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3883However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3884attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3885user.
3886
3887.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3888.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3889.cindex "giving up on messages"
3890.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3891.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3892This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3893including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3894their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3895is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3896Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3897user.
3898
3899.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3900.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3901.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3902This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3903as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3904message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3905altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3906
3907.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3908.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3909.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3910.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3911.cindex "removing recipients"
3912This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3913(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3914the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3915addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3916(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3917can be used only by an admin user.
3918
3919.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3920.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3921.cindex "removing messages"
3922.cindex "abandoning mail"
3923.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3924This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3925bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3926the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3927only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3928placed on the queue.
3929
3930.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3931.oindex "&%-Mset%&
3932.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3933.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3934This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3935string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3936the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3937&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3938available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3939make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3940user. See also &%-bem%&.
3941
3942.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3943.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3944.cindex "thawing messages"
3945.cindex "unfreezing messages"
3946.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3947.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3948This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3949&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3950messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3951by an admin user.
3952
3953.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3954.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3955.cindex "listing" "message body"
3956.cindex "message" "listing body of"
3957This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3958written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3959
3960.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3961.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3962.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3963.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3964This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3965be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3966only by an admin user.
3967
3968.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3969.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3970.cindex "listing" "message headers"
3971.cindex "header lines" "listing"
3972.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3973This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3974written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3975
3976.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3977.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3978.cindex "listing" "message log"
3979.cindex "message" "listing message log"
3980This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3981the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3982
3983.vitem &%-m%&
3984.oindex "&%-m%&"
3985This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3986treats it that way too.
3987
3988.vitem &%-N%&
3989.oindex "&%-N%&"
3990.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3991.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3992This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3993level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3994it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3995had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3996database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3997than &"=>"&.
3998
3999Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4000user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4001words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4002which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4003address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4004routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4005the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4006for that message.
4007
4008.vitem &%-n%&
4009.oindex "&%-n%&"
4010This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4011For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4012When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4013
4014.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4015.oindex "&%-O%&"
4016This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4017Exim.
4018
4019.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4020.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4021.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4022This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4023alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4024description above.
4025
4026.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4027.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4028.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4029.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4030.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4031This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4032be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4033transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4034
4035.vitem &%-odb%&
4036.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4037.cindex "background delivery"
4038.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4039This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4040including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4041messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4042delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4043processes to finish.
4044
4045When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4046leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4047and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4048This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4049
4050If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4051(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4052overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4053setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4054
4055.vitem &%-odf%&
4056.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4057.cindex "foreground delivery"
4058.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4059This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4060accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4061&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4062and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4063
4064The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4065process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4066during deliveries.
4067
4068However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4069false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4070
4071If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4072message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4073process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4074restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4075
4076
4077.vitem &%-odi%&
4078.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4079This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4080Sendmail.
4081
4082.vitem &%-odq%&
4083.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4084.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4085.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4086.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4087This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4088including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4089not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4090are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4091process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4092&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4093conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4094forces queueing.
4095
4096.vitem &%-odqs%&
4097.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4098.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4099This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4100However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4101&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4102configuration file is in effect.
4103
4104When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4105message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4106also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4107in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4108done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4109runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4110messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4111host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4112configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4113&%-qq%& option.
4114
4115.vitem &%-oee%&
4116.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4117.cindex "error" "reporting"
4118If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4119example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4120message.
4121
4122.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4123Provided
4124this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4125exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4126is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4127This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4128
4129.vitem &%-oem%&
4130.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4131.cindex "error" "reporting"
4132.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4133This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4134return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4135This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4136
4137.vitem &%-oep%&
4138.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4139.cindex "error" "reporting"
4140If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4141error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4142.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4143The return code is 1 for all errors.
4144
4145.vitem &%-oeq%&
4146.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4147.cindex "error" "reporting"
4148This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4149effect as &%-oep%&.
4150
4151.vitem &%-oew%&
4152.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4153.cindex "error" "reporting"
4154This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4155effect as &%-oem%&.
4156
4157.vitem &%-oi%&
4158.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4159.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4160This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4161line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4162single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4163lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4164&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4165
4166.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4167.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4168This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4169
4170.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4171.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4172.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4173A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4174with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4175over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4176&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4177other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4178
4179The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4180number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4181.code
4182exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4183.endd
4184An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4185followed by a colon and the port number:
4186.code
4187exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4188.endd
4189The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4190port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4191are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4192whichever one is last.
4193
4194.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4195.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4196.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4197See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4198option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4199name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4200This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4201authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4202
4203.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4204.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4205.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4206See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4207option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4208This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4209where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4210&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4211
4212.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4213.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4214.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4215See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4216option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4217overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4218messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4219default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4220specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4221&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4222
4223.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4224.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4225.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4226See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4227option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4228using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4229&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4230
4231.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4232.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4233.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4234See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4235option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4236delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4237messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4238abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4239running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4240
4241The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4242The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4243is sending the bounce.
4244
4245.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4246.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4247.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4248.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4249See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4250option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4251&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4252or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4253SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4254&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4255one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4256be set by &%-oMr%&.
4257
4258.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4259.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4260.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4261See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4262option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4263present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4264uses the name it is given.
4265
4266.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4267.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4268.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4269See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4270option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4271local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4272used, when there is no default.
4273
4274.vitem &%-om%&
4275.oindex "&%-om%&"
4276.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4277In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4278message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4279expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4280
4281.vitem &%-oo%&
4282.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4283.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4284This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4285whatever that means.
4286
4287.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4288.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4289.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4290.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4291This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4292value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4293written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4294without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4295because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4296
4297.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4298.oindex "&%-or%&"
4299.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4300This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4301set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4302by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4303described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4304
4305.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4306.oindex "&%-os%&"
4307.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4308.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4309This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4310applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4311the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4312for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4313
4314.vitem &%-ov%&
4315.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4316This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4317
4318.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4319.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4320.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4321.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4322.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4323This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4324is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4325of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4326in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4327file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4328
4329.vitem &%-pd%&
4330.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4331.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4332This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4333chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4334option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4335needed.
4336
4337.vitem &%-ps%&
4338.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4339.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4340This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4341chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4342option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4343started.
4344
4345.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4346.oindex "&%-p%&"
4347For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4348.display
4349&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4350.endd
4351It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4352host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4353Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4354to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4355or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4356
4357.vitem &%-q%&
4358.oindex "&%-q%&"
4359.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4360This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4361configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4362relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4363and &%-S%& options).
4364
4365.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4366The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4367waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4368for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4369process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4370have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4371
4372If
4373.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4374.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4375.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4376the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4377passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4378proceeding.
4379
4380When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4381process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4382mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4383this to be repeated periodically.
4384
4385Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4386random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4387If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4388MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4389
4390It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4391order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4392&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4393
4394.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4395The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4396behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4397appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4398
4399.vitem &%-qq...%&
4400.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4401.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4402.cindex "queue" "routing"
4403.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4404An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4405stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4406every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4407transports are run.
4408
4409.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4410The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4411is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4412complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4413place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4414delivered down a single SMTP
4415.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4416.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4417.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4418connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4419This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4420intermittently.
4421
4422.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4423.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4424.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4425If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4426those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4427delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4428&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4429
4430.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4431.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4432.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4433.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4434If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4435message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4436their retry times are tried.
4437
4438.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4439.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4440.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4441If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4442frozen or not.
4443
4444.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4445.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4446.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4447The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4448be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4449for later delivery.
4450
4451.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4452.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4453When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4454lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4455starting message id. For example:
4456.code
4457exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4458.endd
4459Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4460second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4461are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4462.code
4463exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4464.endd
4465just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4466&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4467that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4468mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4469are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4470queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4471
4472.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4473.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4474.cindex "periodic queue running"
4475When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4476starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4477(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4478&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4479single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4480combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4481.code
4482/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4483.endd
4484Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4485process every 30 minutes.
4486
4487When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4488pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4489
4490.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4491.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4492This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4493compatibility.
4494
4495.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4496.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4497This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4498
4499.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4500.oindex "&%-R%&"
4501.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4502.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4503.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4504The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4505is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4506which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4507<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4508
4509This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4510perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4511queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4512address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4513way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4514regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4515
4516If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4517you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4518.code
4519exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4520.endd
4521This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4522every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4523applied to each queue run.
4524
4525Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4526are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4527information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4528means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4529existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4530address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4531will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4532information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4533address will be skipped.
4534
4535.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4536If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4537all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4538&'ff'& is present.
4539
4540The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4541to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4542command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4543effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4544an arbitrary command instead.
4545
4546.vitem &%-r%&
4547.oindex "&%-r%&"
4548This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4549
4550.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4551.oindex "&%-S%&"
4552.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4553.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4554This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4555message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4556conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4557has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4558
4559.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4560.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4561This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4562recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4563&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4564
4565.vitem &%-t%&
4566.oindex "&%-t%&"
4567.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4568.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4569.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4570.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4571When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4572input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4573from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4574from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4575takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4576
4577.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4578If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4579is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4580the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4581and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4582Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4583Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4584argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4585Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4586instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4587&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4588
4589.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4590If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4591recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4592lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4593with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4594&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4595
4596RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4597message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4598added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4599not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4600nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4601In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4602are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4603once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4604&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4605
4606.vitem &%-ti%&
4607.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4608This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4609compatibility with Sendmail.
4610
4611.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4612.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4613.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4614.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4615This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4616incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4617&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4618&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4619
4620
4621.vitem &%-U%&
4622.oindex "&%-U%&"
4623.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4624Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4625documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4626syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4627set. Exim ignores this option.
4628
4629.vitem &%-v%&
4630.oindex "&%-v%&"
4631This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4632describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4633receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4634dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4635the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4636selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4637unconditional.
4638
4639.vitem &%-x%&
4640.oindex "&%-x%&"
4641AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4642National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4643It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4644this option.
4645
4646.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4647.oindex "&%-X%&"
4648This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4649to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4650
4651.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4652.oindex "&%-z%&"
4653This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4654Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4655Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4656under most shells.
4657.endlist
4658
4659.ecindex IIDclo1
4660.ecindex IIDclo2
4661
4662
4663. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4665. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4666. creates a man page for the options.
4667. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4668
4669.literal xml
4670<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4671.literal off
4672
4673
4674
4675
4676
4677. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4678. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4679
4680
4681.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4682 "The runtime configuration file"
4683
4684.cindex "run time configuration"
4685.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4686.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4687.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4688.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4689.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4690Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4691binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4692because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4693control.
4694
4695If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4696writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4697The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4698errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4699not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4700actually alter the string.
4701
4702The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4703reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4704most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4705give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4706existing file in the list.
4707
4708.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4709.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4710.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4711.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4712.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4713.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4714The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4715specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4716configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4717group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4718CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4719
4720&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4721to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4722easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4723CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4724who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4725
4726Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4727be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4728since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4729compromise the Exim user account.
4730
4731A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4732is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4733defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4734configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4735CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4736&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4737configuration.
4738
4739
4740
4741.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4742.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4743A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4744option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4745&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4746unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4747CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4748is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4749is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4750installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4751specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4752
4753Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4754with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4755listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4756testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4757delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4758Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4759the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4760can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4761message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4762&%-M%&).
4763
4764If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4765prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4766start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4767There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4768name can be used with &%-C%&.
4769
4770One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4771option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4772configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4773non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4774If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4775completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4776
4777The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4778to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4779necessarily be discarded.
4780WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4781considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4782values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4783is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4784transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4785values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4786
4787Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4788share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4789If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4790looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4791and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4792file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4793each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4794
4795In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4796different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4797help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4798
4799
4800
4801.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4802.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4803.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4804Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4805option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4806are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4807is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4808space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4809
4810.ilist
4811&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4812&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4813.next
4814.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4815&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4816are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4817.next
4818&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4819addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4820&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4821.next
4822&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4823define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4824&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4825.next
4826&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4827If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4828defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4829are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4830&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4831.next
4832&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4833when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4834chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4835.next
4836&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4837want to use this feature, you must set
4838.code
4839LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4840.endd
4841in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4842facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4843.endlist
4844
4845.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4846.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4847.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4848Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4849
4850Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4851leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4852# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4853and does not introduce a comment.
4854
4855Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4856the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4857backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4858lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4859appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4860
4861A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4862default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4863change settings as required.
4864
4865The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4866described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4867respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4868items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4869onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4870described.
4871
4872
4873
4874.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4875.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4876.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4877.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4878.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4879You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4880using this syntax:
4881.display
4882&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4883&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4884.endd
4885on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4886the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4887second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4888name is required.
4889
4890Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4891configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4892If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4893because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4894
4895The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4896comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4897for example:
4898.code
4899hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4900 .include /some/file
4901.endd
4902Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4903process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4904inclusion appears.
4905
4906
4907
4908.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4909.cindex "macro" "description of"
4910.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4911If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4912&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4913definition, and must be of the form
4914.display
4915<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4916.endd
4917The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4918in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4919continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4920space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4921a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4922
4923Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4924definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4925ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4926
4927.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4928Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4929files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4930scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4931replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4932for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4933the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4934define
4935.display
4936&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4937&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4938.endd
4939but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4940error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4941before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4942consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4943line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4944comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4945
4946
4947.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4948Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4949(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4950&'='&. For example:
4951.code
4952MAC = initial value
4953...
4954MAC == updated value
4955.endd
4956Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4957subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4958the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4959Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4960.code
4961MAC = initial value
4962...
4963MAC == MAC and something added
4964.endd
4965This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4966from a number of other files.
4967
4968.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4969The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4970&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4971used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4972using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4973file to be ignored.
4974
4975
4976
4977.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4978As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4979up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4980strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4981.code
4982ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4983 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4984.endd
4985This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4986.code
4987data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4988.endd
4989In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4990address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4991section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4992
4993
4994.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4995.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4996.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4997You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4998&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4999portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5000read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5001
5002The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5003be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5004that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5005line. Thus:
5006.code
5007.ifdef AAA
5008message_size_limit = 50M
5009.else
5010message_size_limit = 100M
5011.endif
5012.endd
5013sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5014(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5015otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5016is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5017obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5018
5019Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5020it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5021in this line"& will always be true.
5022
5023Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5024to clarify complicated nestings.
5025
5026
5027
5028.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5029.cindex "common option syntax"
5030.cindex "syntax of common options"
5031.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5032For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5033each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5034lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5035these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5036space) and then the value. For example:
5037.code
5038qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5039.endd
5040.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5041.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5042.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5043Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5044accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5045line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5046word &"hide"&. For example:
5047.code
5048hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5049.endd
5050For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5051.code
5052mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5053.endd
5054If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5055all instances of the same driver.
5056
5057The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5058that are found in option settings.
5059
5060
5061.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5062.cindex "format" "boolean"
5063.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5064.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5065.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5066Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5067different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5068the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5069if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5070boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5071&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5072the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5073.code
5074queue_only
5075queue_only = true
5076.endd
5077The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5078.code
5079no_queue_only
5080queue_only = false
5081.endd
5082You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5083
5084
5085
5086
5087.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5088.cindex "integer configuration values"
5089.cindex "format" "integer"
5090If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5091hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5092number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5093with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5094hexadecimal number.
5095
5096If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5097it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5098of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
50991024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5100and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5101used.
5102
5103
5104.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5105.cindex "integer format"
5106.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5107If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5108interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5109Such options are always output in octal.
5110
5111
5112.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5113.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5114.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5115If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5116integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5117
5118
5119
5120.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5121.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5122.cindex "format" "time interval"
5123A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5124the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5125
5126.table2 30pt
5127.irow &%s%& seconds
5128.irow &%m%& minutes
5129.irow &%h%& hours
5130.irow &%d%& days
5131.irow &%w%& weeks
5132.endtable
5133
5134For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5135intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5136is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5137
5138
5139
5140.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5141.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5142.cindex "format" "string"
5143If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5144or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5145consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5146the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5147removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5148Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5149appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5150therefore equivalent:
5151.code
5152trusted_users = uucp:mail
5153trusted_users = uucp:\
5154 # This comment line is ignored
5155 mail
5156.endd
5157.cindex "string" "quoted"
5158.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5159If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5160double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5161continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5162
5163.table2 100pt
5164.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5165.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5166.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5167.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5168.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5169.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5170 character"
5171.endtable
5172
5173If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5174character, that character replaces the pair.
5175
5176Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5177insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5178trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5179current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5180in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5181and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5182
5183
5184.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5185.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5186Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5187by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5188circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5189is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5190strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5191However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5192backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5193within a quoted configuration string.
5194
5195
5196.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5197.cindex "user name" "format of"
5198.cindex "format" "user name"
5199.cindex "groups" "name format"
5200.cindex "format" "group name"
5201User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5202above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5203either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5204&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5205
5206
5207.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5208.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5209.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5210.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5211The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5212default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5213the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5214&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5215are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5216particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5217&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5218
5219In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5220input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5221&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5222in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5223on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5224start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5225example, the list
5226.code
5227local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5228.endd
5229contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5230
5231&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5232list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5233colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5234be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5235
5236.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5237.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5238.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5239Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5240introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5241with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5242character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5243above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5244.code
5245local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5246.endd
5247This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5248&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5249confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5250
5251.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5252.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5253It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5254code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5255must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5256are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5257sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5258interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5259generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5260.code
5261domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5262.endd
5263This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5264to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5265expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5266the value in quotes. For example:
5267.code
5268local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5269.endd
5270Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5271doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5272set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5273enclosing an empty list item.
5274
5275
5276
5277.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5278.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5279An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5280separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5281.code
5282senders = user@domain :
5283.endd
5284contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5285in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5286items, the second of which is empty:
5287.code
5288senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5289.endd
5290&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5291are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5292would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5293just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5294.code
5295senders = :
5296.endd
5297In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5298is at the end of the list.
5299
5300
5301
5302
5303.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5304.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5305There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5306and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5307instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5308a sequence of lines like this:
5309.display
5310<&'instance name'&>:
5311 <&'option'&>
5312 ...
5313 <&'option'&>
5314.endd
5315In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5316followed by three options settings:
5317.code
5318localuser:
5319 driver = accept
5320 check_local_user
5321 transport = local_delivery
5322.endd
5323For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5324setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5325settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5326deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5327a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5328described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5329
5330You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5331the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5332
5333The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5334passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5335transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5336authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5337them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5338server.
5339
5340.cindex "generic options"
5341.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5342Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5343and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5344same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5345&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5346.cindex "private options"
5347The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5348they all have default values.
5349
5350The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5351precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5352this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5353
5354Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5355elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5356with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5357a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5358instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5359confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5360configuration lines:
5361.code
5362remote_smtp:
5363 driver = smtp
5364.endd
5365create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5366&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5367different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5368instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5369thus:
5370.code
5371special_smtp:
5372 driver = smtp
5373 port = 1234
5374 command_timeout = 10s
5375.endd
5376The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5377these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5378lines.
5379
5380Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5381list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5382defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5383option.
5384
5385
5386
5387
5388
5389
5390. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5391. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5392
5393.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5394.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5395.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5396The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5397is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5398the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5399configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5400of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5401itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5402initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5403mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5404
5405
5406
5407.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5408The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5409file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5410the line
5411.code
5412# primary_hostname =
5413.endd
5414This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5415to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5416can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5417it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5418
5419The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5420.code
5421domainlist local_domains = @
5422domainlist relay_to_domains =
5423hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5424.endd
5425These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5426domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5427domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5428configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5429
5430The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5431later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5432on the local host.
5433
5434.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5435There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5436of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5437called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5438be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5439the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5440
5441The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5442list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5443controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5444domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5445domain is permitted.
5446
5447The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5448used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5449that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5450loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5451submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5452hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5453
5454Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5455we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5456and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5457
5458The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5459.code
5460acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5461acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5462.endd
5463These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5464during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5465command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5466respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5467&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5468section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5469accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5470to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5471contents of a message to be checked.
5472
5473Two commented-out option settings are next:
5474.code
5475# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5476# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5477.endd
5478These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5479content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5480scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5481details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5482
5483Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5484.code
5485# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5486# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5487# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5488.endd
5489These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5490support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5491first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5492connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5493other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5494key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5495More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5496
5497Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5498.code
5499# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5500# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5501.endd
5502.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5503.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5504.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5505.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5506.cindex "smtps protocol"
5507.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5508.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5509These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5510server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5511TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5512more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5513on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5514port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5515configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5516non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5517&<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5518
5519Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5520.code
5521# qualify_domain =
5522# qualify_recipient =
5523.endd
5524The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5525complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5526receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5527the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5528you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5529addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5530
5531.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5532The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5533addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5534(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5535.code
5536# allow_domain_literals
5537.endd
5538The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5539Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5540quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5541try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5542people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5543&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5544
5545The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5546.code
5547never_users = root
5548.endd
5549It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5550convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5551setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5552The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5553list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5554FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5555contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5556FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5557
5558When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5559Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5560line,
5561.code
5562host_lookup = *
5563.endd
5564specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5565in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5566information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5567or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5568Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5569because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5570unreachable.
5571
5572The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
55731413 (hence their names):
5574.code
5575rfc1413_hosts = *
5576rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5577.endd
5578These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5579Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5580terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5581of an incoming SMTP connection.
5582If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5583information, you can change this.
5584
5585This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5586and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5587.code
5588prdr_enable = true
5589.endd
5590
5591When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5592be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5593if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5594find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5595.code
5596# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5597# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5598.endd
5599show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5600and recipient addresses, respectively.
5601
5602The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5603over the default:
5604.code
5605log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5606 +tls_certificate_verified
5607.endd
5608
5609The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5610.code
5611# percent_hack_domains =
5612.endd
5613It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5614This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5615anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5616
5617The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5618concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5619message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5620occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5621address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5622bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5623are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5624always bounce messages.
5625.code
5626ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5627timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5628.endd
5629The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5630discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5631message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5632after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5633bounce message ever lasts a week.
5634
5635
5636
5637.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5638.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5639.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5640In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5641It starts with the line
5642.code
5643begin acl
5644.endd
5645and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5646&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5647and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5648
5649.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5650The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5651RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5652are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5653rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5654result of the ACL processing.
5655.code
5656acl_check_rcpt:
5657.endd
5658This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5659ACL, and names it.
5660.code
5661accept hosts = :
5662.endd
5663This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5664But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5665names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5666list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5667host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5668important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5669
5670What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5671messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5672input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5673manner.
5674.code
5675deny message = Restricted characters in address
5676 domains = +local_domains
5677 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5678
5679deny message = Restricted characters in address
5680 domains = !+local_domains
5681 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5682.endd
5683These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5684characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5685Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5686&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5687in Internet mail addresses.
5688
5689The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5690addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5691option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5692in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5693programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5694at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5695characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5696policy of being as safe as possible.
5697
5698The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5699to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5700first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5701&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5702reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5703&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5704
5705The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5706block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5707or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5708have to modify this rule.
5709
5710Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5711allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5712common convention of local parts constructed as
5713&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5714the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5715with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5716file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5717that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5718is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5719
5720The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5721allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5722and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5723with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5724local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5725and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5726(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5727.code
5728accept local_parts = postmaster
5729 domains = +local_domains
5730.endd
5731This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5732local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5733&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5734reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5735&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5736
5737The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5738by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5739in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5740.code
5741require verify = sender
5742.endd
5743This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5744ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5745address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5746see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5747addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5748used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5749discusses the details of address verification.
5750.code
5751accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5752 control = submission
5753.endd
5754This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5755hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5756verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5757that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5758second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5759is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5760messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5761&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5762probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5763.code
5764accept authenticated = *
5765 control = submission
5766.endd
5767This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5768Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5769likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5770authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5771examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5772fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5773.code
5774require message = relay not permitted
5775 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5776.endd
5777This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5778one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5779.code
5780require verify = recipient
5781.endd
5782This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5783fails, the address is rejected.
5784.code
5785# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5786# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5787# $dnslist_text
5788# dnslists = black.list.example
5789#
5790# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5791# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5792# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5793# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5794.endd
5795These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5796sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5797from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5798line.
5799.code
5800# require verify = csa
5801.endd
5802This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5803authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5804records.
5805.code
5806accept
5807.endd
5808The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5809address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5810.code
5811acl_check_data:
5812.endd
5813This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5814of this ACL are commented out:
5815.code
5816# deny malware = *
5817# message = This message contains a virus \
5818# ($malware_name).
5819.endd
5820These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5821viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5822suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5823virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5824.code
5825# warn spam = nobody
5826# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5827# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5828# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5829# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5830.endd
5831These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5832SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5833and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5834&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5835series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5836whatever the spam score.
5837.code
5838accept
5839.endd
5840This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5841
5842
5843.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5844.cindex "default" "routers"
5845.cindex "routers" "default"
5846The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5847by the line
5848.code
5849begin routers
5850.endd
5851Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5852messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5853accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5854matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5855manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5856.code
5857# domain_literal:
5858# driver = ipliteral
5859# domains = !+local_domains
5860# transport = remote_smtp
5861.endd
5862.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5863This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5864support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5865you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5866&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5867.code
5868dnslookup:
5869 driver = dnslookup
5870 domains = ! +local_domains
5871 transport = remote_smtp
5872 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5873 no_more
5874.endd
5875The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5876domains. This is specified by the line
5877.code
5878domains = ! +local_domains
5879.endd
5880The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5881exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5882that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5883the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5884indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5885passed on to the following routers.
5886
5887The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5888and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5889the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5890instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5891one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5892
5893The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5894DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5895router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5896specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5897in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5898the address fails and is bounced.
5899
5900The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5901be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5902encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5903whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5904Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5905email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5906continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5907out.
5908.code
5909system_aliases:
5910 driver = redirect
5911 allow_fail
5912 allow_defer
5913 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5914# user = exim
5915 file_transport = address_file
5916 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5917.endd
5918Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5919domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5920alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5921data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5922the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5923the next router.
5924
5925&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5926often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5927file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5928&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5929.code
5930userforward:
5931 driver = redirect
5932 check_local_user
5933# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5934# local_part_suffix_optional
5935 file = $home/.forward
5936# allow_filter
5937 no_verify
5938 no_expn
5939 check_ancestor
5940 file_transport = address_file
5941 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5942 reply_transport = address_reply
5943.endd
5944This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5945redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5946individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5947local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5948router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5949namely:
5950.code
5951# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5952# local_part_suffix_optional
5953.endd
5954.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5955show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5956is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5957by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5958variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5959presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5960the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5961
5962When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5963home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5964declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5965redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5966
5967.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5968Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5969files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5970is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5971of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5972filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5973separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5974
5975The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5976verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5977There are two reasons for doing this:
5978
5979.olist
5980Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5981checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5982unnecessary work.
5983.next
5984More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5985command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5986The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5987It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5988this time.
5989.endlist
5990
5991The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5992address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5993works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5994forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5995
5996The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5997forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5998auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5999.code
6000a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6001.endd
6002the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6003transport.
6004.code
6005localuser:
6006 driver = accept
6007 check_local_user
6008# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6009# local_part_suffix_optional
6010 transport = local_delivery
6011.endd
6012The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6013part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6014the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6015routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6016same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6017
6018
6019.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6020.cindex "default" "transports"
6021.cindex "transports" "default"
6022Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6023only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6024not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6025.code
6026begin transports
6027.endd
6028One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6029.code
6030remote_smtp:
6031 driver = smtp
6032 hosts_try_prdr = *
6033.endd
6034This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6035The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6036The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6037It is negotiated between client and server
6038and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6039All other options are defaulted.
6040.code
6041local_delivery:
6042 driver = appendfile
6043 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6044 delivery_date_add
6045 envelope_to_add
6046 return_path_add
6047# group = mail
6048# mode = 0660
6049.endd
6050This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6051traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6052local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6053directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6054under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6055show how this can be done.
6056
6057Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6058&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6059similarly-named options above.
6060.code
6061address_pipe:
6062 driver = pipe
6063 return_output
6064.endd
6065This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6066redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6067option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6068be returned to the sender.
6069.code
6070address_file:
6071 driver = appendfile
6072 delivery_date_add
6073 envelope_to_add
6074 return_path_add
6075.endd
6076This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6077redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6078&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6079.code
6080address_reply:
6081 driver = autoreply
6082.endd
6083This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6084filter files.
6085
6086
6087
6088.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6089.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6090.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6091The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6092Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6093introduced by the line
6094.code
6095begin retry
6096.endd
6097In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6098errors:
6099.code
6100* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6101.endd
6102This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
61032 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
61041.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6105is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6106
6107If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6108if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6109temporary errors into permanent errors.
6110
6111
6112.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6113The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6114.code
6115begin rewrite
6116.endd
6117contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6118rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6119
6120
6121
6122.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6123.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6124The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6125.code
6126begin authenticators
6127.endd
6128defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6129configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6130which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6131standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6132mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6133to support most MUA software.
6134
6135The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6136.code
6137#PLAIN:
6138# driver = plaintext
6139# server_set_id = $auth2
6140# server_prompts = :
6141# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6142# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6143.endd
6144And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6145.code
6146#LOGIN:
6147# driver = plaintext
6148# server_set_id = $auth1
6149# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6150# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6151# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6152.endd
6153
6154The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6155in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6156&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6157that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6158i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6159when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6160when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6161need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6162
6163The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6164password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6165To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6166expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6167
6168Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6169usercode and password are in different positions.
6170Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6171
6172.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6173
6174
6175
6176. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6177. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6178
6179.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6180
6181.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6182.cindex "PCRE"
6183Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6184uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6185matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6186regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6187Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6188O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6189
6190The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6191are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6192description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6193the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6194the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6195case-insensitive.
6196
6197In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6198it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6199or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6200second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6201.code
6202domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6203.endd
6204The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6205precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6206of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6207regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6208backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6209normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6210matched.
6211
6212There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6213recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6214string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6215these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6216it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6217match anywhere in the subject string.
6218
6219In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6220you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6221.code
6222domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6223.endd
6224matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6225You need to use:
6226.code
6227domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6228.endd
6229if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6230$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6231
6232
6233
6234. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6235. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6236
6237.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6238.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6239.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6240.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6241Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6242messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6243
6244.olist
6245A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6246cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6247lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6248can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6249&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6250The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6251.next
6252Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6253way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6254returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6255succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6256chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6257The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6258.endlist
6259
6260String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6261that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6262involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6263if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6264time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6265chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6266
6267.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6268It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6269lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6270processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6271Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6272.code
6273domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6274domains = lsearch;/some/file
6275.endd
6276The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6277No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6278defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6279The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6280file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6281.code
6282192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6283192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6284.endd
6285When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6286possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6287
6288In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6289Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6290in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6291.code
6292domain1:
6293domain2:
6294.endd
6295Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6296matches the list item.
6297
6298It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6299Consider a file containing lines like this:
6300.code
6301192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6302.endd
6303If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6304first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6305causes a second lookup to occur.
6306
6307The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6308available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6309lookup is permitted.
6310
6311
6312.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6313.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6314.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6315Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6316
6317.ilist
6318The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6319and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6320lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6321.next
6322.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6323The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6324key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6325Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6326.endlist
6327
6328The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6329the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6330default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6331.code
6332LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6333LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6334.endd
6335which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6336For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6337libraries and header files before building Exim.
6338
6339
6340
6341
6342.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6343.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6344.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6345The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6346
6347.ilist
6348.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6349.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6350.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6351&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6352string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6353indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6354re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6355aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6356be found in several places:
6357.display
6358&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6359&url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6360&url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6361.endd
6362A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6363because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6364However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6365you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6366.next
6367.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6368.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6369.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6370&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6371DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6372zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6373&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6374
6375.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6376For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6377when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6378using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6379the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6380that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6381other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6382.next
6383.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6384.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6385.cindex "sasldb2"
6386.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6387&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6388interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6389ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6390authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6391&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6392&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6393.next
6394.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6395.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6396.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6397.cindex "Courier"
6398.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6399.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6400&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6401is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6402if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6403other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6404use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6405calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6406utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6407by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6408.next
6409.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6410.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6411&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6412whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6413contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6414the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6415symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6416lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6417&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6418.next
6419.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6420.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6421&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6422terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6423file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6424IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6425being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6426.code
64271.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6428192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6429"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6430"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6431.endd
6432The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6433file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6434key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6435&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6436&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6437
6438&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6439&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6440lookup types support only literal keys.
6441
6442&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6443the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6444&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6445.next
6446.cindex "linear search"
6447.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6448.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6449.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6450&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6451line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6452end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6453letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6454in the file is used.
6455
6456White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6457line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6458continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6459space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6460junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6461colon, for example:
6462.code
6463baduser: :fail:
6464.endd
6465Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6466middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6467that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6468wildcarding of any kind.
6469
6470.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6471.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6472In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6473characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6474If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6475matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6476contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6477quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6478quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6479
6480.next
6481.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6482.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6483.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6484&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6485the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6486&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6487reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6488aliases; the full map names must be used.
6489
6490.next
6491.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6492.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6493.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6494.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6495&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6496&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6497the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6498that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6499used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6500
6501.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6502Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6503file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6504&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6505
6506. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6507. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6508
6509.olist
6510The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6511.code
6512 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6513 *fish data for anythingfish
6514.endd
6515.next
6516The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6517example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6518.code
6519 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6520.endd
6521Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6522expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6523string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6524.code
6525 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6526.endd
6527The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6528expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6529For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6530.code
6531 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6532.endd
6533
6534If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6535either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6536ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6537colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6538escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6539
6540&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6541match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6542is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6543takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6544&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6545
6546.next
6547Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6548is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6549lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6550example:
6551.code
6552 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6553.endd
6554The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6555.endlist olist
6556
6557Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6558continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6559be followed by optional colons.
6560
6561&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6562&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6563lookup types support only literal keys.
6564.endlist ilist
6565
6566
6567.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6568.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6569.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6570The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6571many of them are given in later sections.
6572
6573.ilist
6574.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6575.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6576&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6577are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6578records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6579.next
6580.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6581.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6582&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6583.next
6584.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6585.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6586&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6587returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6588that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6589called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6590any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6591.next
6592.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6593.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6594&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6595MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6596.next
6597.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6598.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6599&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6600the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6601.next
6602.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6603.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6604&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6605Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6606.next
6607.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6608.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6609.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6610&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6611lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6612success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6613lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6614password value. For example:
6615.code
6616*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6617.endd
6618.next
6619.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6620.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6621&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6622PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6623
6624.next
6625.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6626.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6627&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6628that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6629
6630.next
6631&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6632not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6633.next
6634.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6635.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6636&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6637allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6638address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6639obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6640at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6641superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6642&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6643.code
6644require condition = \
6645 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6646.endd
6647The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6648the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6649this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6650one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6651.endlist
6652
6653
6654
6655.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6656.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6657Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6658completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6659reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6660options such as a list of local domains.
6661
6662When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6663of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6664temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6665or may give up altogether.
6666
6667
6668
6669.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6670.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6671.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6672.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6673.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6674.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6675In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6676that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6677
6678&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6679lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6680specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6681
6682If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6683and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6684provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6685
6686.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6687.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6688.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6689Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6690&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6691character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6692by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6693that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6694take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6695For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6696.code
6697data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6698.endd
6699Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6700looks up these keys, in this order:
6701.code
6702jane@eyre.example
6703*@eyre.example
6704*
6705.endd
6706The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6707&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6708complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6709Exim move on to try the next key.
6710
6711
6712
6713.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6714.cindex "partial matching"
6715.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6716.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6717.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6718.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6719The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6720match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6721being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6722information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6723domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6724a key in a DBM file is
6725.code
6726*.dates.fict.example
6727.endd
6728then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6729&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6730by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6731file.
6732
6733&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6734also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6735&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6736
6737Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6738keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6739be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6740partial matching keys
6741beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6742Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6743unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6744
6745Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6746the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6747is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6748is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6749fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6750start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6751remains.
6752
6753A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6754by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6755&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6756modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6757subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6758up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6759.code
67602250.dates.fict.example
6761*.2250.dates.fict.example
6762*.dates.fict.example
6763*.fict.example
6764.endd
6765As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6766finishes.
6767
6768.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6769.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6770The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6771changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6772formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6773parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6774.code
6775domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6776.endd
6777In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6778&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6779components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6780other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6781.code
6782domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6783.endd
6784For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6785&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6786
6787If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6788just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6789down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6790
6791.ilist
6792If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6793.next
6794If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6795example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6796.next
6797Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6798remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6799for &"*"& on its own.
6800.next
6801Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6802.endlist
6803
6804
6805If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6806&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6807this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6808specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6809prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6810lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6811&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6812
6813The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6814in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6815dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6816in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6817subject key is always followed by a dot.
6818
6819
6820
6821
6822.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6823.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6824.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6825Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6826lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6827of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6828single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6829
6830For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6831another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6832many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6833the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6834closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6835own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6836
6837The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6838strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6839complete.
6840
6841
6842
6843
6844.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6845.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6846.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6847When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6848is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6849the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6850.code
6851[name=$local_part]
6852.endd
6853will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6854For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6855.code
6856[name="$local_part"]
6857.endd
6858but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6859NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6860rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6861of the following form is provided:
6862.code
6863${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6864.endd
6865For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6866.code
6867[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6868.endd
6869See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6870operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6871lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6872
6873
6874
6875
6876.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6877.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6878.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6879.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6880The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6881of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6882an expansion string could contain:
6883.code
6884${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6885.endd
6886If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6887is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6888&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6889&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6890
6891The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6892and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6893If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6894
6895For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6896concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6897depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6898between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6899by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6900.code
6901${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6902.endd
6903It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6904white space is ignored.
6905For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6906an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6907separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6908
6909.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6910When the type is PTR,
6911the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6912&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6913.code
6914${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6915.endd
6916If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6917altered and nothing is added.
6918
6919.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6920.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6921For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6922each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6923port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6924The field separator can be modified as above.
6925
6926.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6927.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6928For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6929unless a field separator is specified.
6930To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6931For SPF records the
6932default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6933.code
6934${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6935${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6936${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6937.endd
6938It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6939white space is ignored.
6940
6941.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6942For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6943successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6944Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6945specified.
6946.code
6947${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6948.endd
6949
6950.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6951.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6952.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6953.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6954Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6955each followed by a comma,
6956that may appear before the record type.
6957
6958The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6959temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6960a defer-option modifier.
6961The possible keywords are
6962&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6963With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6964whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6965ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6966With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6967error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6968succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6969.code
6970${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6971${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6972.endd
6973Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6974yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6975
6976.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6977Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6978The possible keywords are
6979&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6980With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6981with the lookup.
6982With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6983is not labelled as authenticated data
6984is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6985The default is &"never"&.
6986
6987See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6988
6989.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6990.cindex "DNS" timeout
6991Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6992The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
6993(e.g. &"5s"&).
6994The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
6995
6996Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
6997The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
6998The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
6999
7000.new
7001.cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
7002.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7003.cindex DNS TTL
7004Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7005The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7006value of the set of returned DNS records.
7007.wen
7008
7009
7010.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7011.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7012By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7013each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7014the pseudo-type MXH:
7015.code
7016${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7017.endd
7018In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7019returned.
7020
7021.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7022Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7023records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7024component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7025records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7026error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7027but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7028top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7029.code
7030${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7031${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7032.endd
7033Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7034the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7035the name servers for &%edu%&.
7036
7037You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7038top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7039sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7040given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7041for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7042such a list.
7043
7044.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7045A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7046records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7047&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7048not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7049result of a successful lookup such as:
7050.code
7051${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7052.endd
7053has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7054The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7055authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7056
7057.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7058The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7059and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7060(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7061.code
7062${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7063.endd
7064
7065
7066.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7067In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7068However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7069&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7070the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7071.code
7072${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7073${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7074${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7075.endd
7076In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7077the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7078to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7079case, it does not treat it as a list.
7080
7081The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7082in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7083different separator can be specified, as described above.
7084
7085
7086
7087
7088.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7089.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7090.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7091.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7092The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7093become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7094implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7095contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7096the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7097it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7098indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7099your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7100.code
7101LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7102LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7103LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7104LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7105LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7106.endd
7107If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7108same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7109
7110There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7111the way they handle the results of a query:
7112
7113.ilist
7114&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7115gives an error.
7116.next
7117&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7118Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7119.next
7120&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7121from all of them are returned.
7122.endlist
7123
7124
7125For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7126Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7127the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7128First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7129
7130
7131.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7132.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7133An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7134the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7135.code
7136data = ${lookup ldap \
7137 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7138 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7139.endd
7140.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7141The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7142secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7143encrypted TLS connection is used.
7144
7145With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7146LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7147See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7148
7149Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7150controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7151&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7152your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7153&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7154certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7155running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7156methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7157&_exim.conf_&.
7158
7159
7160.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7161.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7162Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7163and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7164within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7165reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7166
7167The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7168filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7169the string:
7170.code
7171* => \2A
7172( => \28
7173) => \29
7174\ => \5C
7175.endd
7176in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7177to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7178.code
7179! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7180.endd
7181are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7182.code
7183${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7184.endd
7185yields
7186.code
7187%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7188.endd
7189Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7190.code
7191a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7192.endd
7193The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7194base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7195by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7196.code
7197, + " \ < > ;
7198.endd
7199It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7200before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7201is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7202.code
7203${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7204.endd
7205yields
7206.code
7207%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7208.endd
7209Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7210.code
7211\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7212.endd
7213There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7214authentication below.
7215
7216
7217.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7218.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7219The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7220is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7221an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7222by starting it with
7223.code
7224ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7225.endd
7226If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7227used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7228taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7229colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7230handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7231returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7232are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7233Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7234failures, and timeouts.
7235
7236For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7237of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7238&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7239doubled. For example
7240.code
7241ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7242.endd
7243If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7244to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7245the local host) is used.
7246
7247If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7248a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7249&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7250to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7251not available.
7252
7253For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7254for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7255can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7256the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7257.code
7258ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7259.endd
7260When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7261&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7262.code
7263${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7264.endd
7265When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7266a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7267specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7268socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7269&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7270or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7271the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7272backup host.
7273
7274If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7275specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7276&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7277
7278.ilist
7279Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7280interface.
7281.next
7282Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7283.endlist
7284
7285
7286Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7287&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7288
7289
7290
7291.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7292.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7293The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7294information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7295be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7296spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7297when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7298them. The following names are recognized:
7299.display
7300&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7301&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7302&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7303&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7304&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7305&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7306&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7307&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7308.endd
7309The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7310&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7311must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7312library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7313
7314The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7315backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7316enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7317network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7318&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7319LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7320if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7321SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7322Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7323
7324The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7325set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7326
7327The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7328to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7329default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7330server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7331different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7332different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7333alternate list (colon-separated).
7334
7335Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7336values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7337.code
7338${lookup ldap
7339 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7340 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7341 {$value}fail}
7342.endd
7343The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7344any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7345which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7346non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7347
7348The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7349connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7350on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7351
7352When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7353removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7354some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7355quoting has two advantages:
7356
7357.ilist
7358It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7359DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7360.next
7361It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7362.endlist
7363
7364For example, a setting such as
7365.code
7366USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7367.endd
7368should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7369
7370Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7371expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7372field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7373does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7374.code
7375PASS=${quote:$3}
7376.endd
7377The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7378SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7379&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7380
7381
7382
7383.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7384.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7385The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7386as a sequence of values, for example
7387.code
7388cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7389.endd
7390The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7391search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7392the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7393values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7394you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7395directory.
7396
7397In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7398result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7399has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7400
7401If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7402strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7403quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7404backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7405Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7406(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7407Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7408output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7409same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7410
7411Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7412LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7413&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7414&%attr2%& has only one value:
7415.code
7416ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7417value1.1,value1,,2
7418
7419ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7420value two
7421
7422ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7423attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7424
7425ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7426objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7427.endd
7428You can
7429make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7430results of LDAP lookups.
7431The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7432individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7433The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7434of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7435The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7436comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7437
7438
7439
7440
7441.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7442.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7443.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7444NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7445and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7446contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7447of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7448values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7449.code
7450[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7451.endd
7452might return the string
7453.code
7454name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7455home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7456.endd
7457(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7458.code
7459[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7460.endd
7461would just return
7462.code
7463Martin Guerre
7464.endd
7465with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7466for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7467operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7468
7469
7470
7471.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7472.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7473.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7474.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7475.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7476.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7477.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7478.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7479.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7480.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7481Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7482databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7483might be
7484.code
7485${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7486 {$value}fail}
7487.endd
7488If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7489field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7490.code
7491${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7492 {$value}}
7493.endd
7494might be
7495.code
7496home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7497.endd
7498Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7499quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7500field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7501.code
7502Mister X
7503.endd
7504If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7505with a newline between the data for each row.
7506
7507
7508.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7509.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7510.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7511.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7512.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7513.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7514.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7515.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7516.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7517If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7518&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7519option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7520information.
7521(For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7522queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7523&<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7524items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7525Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7526name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7527.code
7528hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7529.endd
7530Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7531&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7532option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7533.code
7534hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7535 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7536.endd
7537For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7538because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7539query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7540a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7541found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7542servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7543
7544.new
7545The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7546convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7547respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7548itself are escaped with backslashes.
7549.wen
7550
7551.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7552For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7553it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7554done by starting the query with
7555.display
7556&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7557.endd
7558Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7559.olist
7560If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7561global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7562of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7563taken from there.
7564.next
7565If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7566.endlist
7567The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7568Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7569successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7570
7571This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7572are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7573master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7574like this:
7575.code
7576mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7577 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7578 master/db/name/pw
7579.endd
7580In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7581.code
7582${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7583.endd
7584That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7585the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7586option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7587.code
7588${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7589.endd
7590
7591
7592.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7593For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7594causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7595socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7596each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7597.display
7598<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7599 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7600.endd
7601Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7602the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7603
7604No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7605the queries.
7606
7607If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7608or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7609
7610&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7611anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7612is zero because no rows are affected.
7613
7614
7615.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7616PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7617This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7618However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7619database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7620looks like this:
7621.code
7622hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7623.endd
7624In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7625given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7626visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7627
7628If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7629update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7630affected.
7631
7632.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7633.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7634.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7635SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7636addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7637daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7638of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7639separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7640contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7641.code
7642${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7643 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7644.endd
7645In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7646.code
7647domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7648 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7649.endd
7650The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7651quote, which it doubles.
7652
7653The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7654internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7655update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7656are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7657waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7658to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7659option.
7660.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7661.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7662
7663
7664. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7665. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7666
7667.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7668 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7669 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7670.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7671A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7672email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7673contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7674are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7675arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7676
7677Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7678host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7679different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7680general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7681
7682Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7683support all the complexity available in
7684domain, host, address and local part lists.
7685
7686
7687
7688.section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7689.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7690Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7691expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7692into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7693but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7694&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7695discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7696
7697
7698If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7699testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7700expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7701
7702If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7703other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7704misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7705the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7706expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7707.code
7708deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7709 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7710.endd
7711The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7712&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7713senders based on the receiving domain.
7714
7715
7716
7717
7718.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7719.cindex "list" "negation"
7720.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7721Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7722leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7723defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7724it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7725(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7726
7727The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7728subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7729subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7730subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7731was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7732.code
7733domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7734.endd
7735matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7736neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7737list is positive. However, if the setting were
7738.code
7739domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7740.endd
7741then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7742list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7743as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7744
7745Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7746the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7747item.
7748
7749
7750
7751.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7752.cindex "list" "file name in"
7753If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7754name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7755processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7756file names are not allowed,
7757and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7758Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7759lines:
7760
7761.ilist
7762For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7763file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7764.next
7765Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7766address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7767white space or the start of the line. For example:
7768.code
7769not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7770.endd
7771.endlist
7772
7773Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7774file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7775is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7776so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7777
7778If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7779within the file is inverted. For example, if
7780.code
7781hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7782.endd
7783and the file contains the lines
7784.code
7785!a.b.c
7786*.b.c
7787.endd
7788then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7789any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7790
7791
7792
7793.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7794As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7795to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7796confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7797an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7798sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7799non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7800always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7801
7802If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7803list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7804in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7805&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7806
7807
7808
7809
7810.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7811.cindex "named lists"
7812.cindex "list" "named"
7813A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7814which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7815particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7816places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7817the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7818a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7819locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7820.code
7821domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7822.endd
7823Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7824for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7825configured with the line
7826.code
7827domains = +local_domains
7828.endd
7829The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7830except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7831.code
7832dnslookup:
7833 driver = dnslookup
7834 domains = ! +local_domains
7835 transport = remote_smtp
7836 no_more
7837.endd
7838The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7839the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7840respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7841equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7842.code
7843hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7844addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7845.endd
7846A named list may refer to other named lists:
7847.code
7848domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7849domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7850domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7851.endd
7852&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7853effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7854out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7855.code
7856domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7857domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7858.endd
7859The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7860list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7861means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7862.code
7863domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7864.endd
7865where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7866referenced lists if you can.
7867
7868Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7869address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7870lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7871.code
7872domains = +local_domains
7873.endd
7874on several of your routers
7875or in several ACL statements,
7876the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7877if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7878references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7879the same each time they are referenced.
7880
7881By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7882extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7883is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7884hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7885
7886
7887
7888.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7889.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7890.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7891At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7892configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7893write
7894.code
7895ALIST = host1 : host2
7896auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7897.endd
7898it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7899.code
7900auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7901.endd
7902Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7903list, and write
7904.code
7905hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7906auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7907.endd
7908the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7909.code
7910auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7911.endd
7912
7913
7914.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7915.cindex "list" "caching of named"
7916.cindex "caching" "named lists"
7917While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7918it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7919the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7920that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7921an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7922message. For example:
7923.code
7924domainlist special_domains = \
7925 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7926.endd
7927This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7928address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7929in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7930cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7931same list each time.
7932
7933By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7934cache the result anyway. For example:
7935.code
7936domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7937.endd
7938If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7939the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7940
7941
7942
7943.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7944.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7945.cindex "list" "domain list"
7946Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7947The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7948
7949.ilist
7950.cindex "primary host name"
7951.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7952.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7953.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7954.cindex "@ in a domain list"
7955If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7956as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7957possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7958differ only in their names.
7959.next
7960.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7961.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7962.cindex "domain literal"
7963If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7964in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7965only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7966&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7967control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7968In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7969.next
7970.cindex "@mx_any"
7971.cindex "@mx_primary"
7972.cindex "@mx_secondary"
7973.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7974If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7975has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7976.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7977&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7978are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7979local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7980but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7981preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7982
7983The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7984performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7985example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7986resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7987options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7988
7989Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7990patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7991list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7992ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7993on a router). For example:
7994.code
7995domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7996.endd
7997This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7998the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7999
8000The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8001host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8002contain negative items.
8003
8004Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8005be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8006list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8007.code
8008domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8009 an.other.domain : ...
8010.endd
8011so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8012involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8013.code
8014domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8015 an.other.domain ? ...
8016.endd
8017.next
8018.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8019.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8020.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8021If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8022are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8023domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8024list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8025matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8026list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8027&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8028
8029.next
8030.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8031.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8032If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8033expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8034function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8035Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8036default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8037with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8038are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8039
8040&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8041must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8042use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8043it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8044expression by expansion, of course).
8045.next
8046.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8047.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8048If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8049semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8050must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8051&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8052.code
8053domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8054.endd
8055The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8056key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8057only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8058is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8059or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8060&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8061other statements in the same ACL.
8062
8063.next
8064Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8065&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8066.code
8067domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8068.endd
8069This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8070works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8071
8072.next
8073.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8074Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8075a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8076original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8077select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8078value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8079expansion variable.
8080.next
8081If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8082semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8083pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8084chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8085.code
8086hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8087 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8088.endd
8089In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8090example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8091whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8092&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8093variable and can be referred to in other options.
8094.next
8095.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8096If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8097between the pattern and the domain.
8098.endlist
8099
8100Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8101.code
8102domainlist funny_domains = \
8103 @ : \
8104 lib.unseen.edu : \
8105 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8106 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8107 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8108 nis;domains.byname : \
8109 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8110.endd
8111There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8112an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8113explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8114but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8115patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8116patterns earlier.
8117
8118
8119
8120.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8121.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8122.cindex "list" "host list"
8123Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8124example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8125may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8126two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8127pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8128You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8129involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8130
8131
8132.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8133.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8134.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8135If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8136involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8137process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8138not used.
8139
8140.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8141The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8142the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8143
8144
8145
8146.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8147.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8148If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8149the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8150&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8151list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8152systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8153concerns.)
8154
8155The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8156inspecting its IP address:
8157
8158.ilist
8159If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8160with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8161to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8162&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8163This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8164with the IP address of the subject host.
8165
8166If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8167lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8168ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8169temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8170what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8171
8172.next
8173.cindex "@ in a host list"
8174If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8175domain name, as just described.
8176
8177.next
8178If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8179subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8180IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8181be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8182separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8183without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8184IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8185that can never match a client host.
8186
8187.next
8188.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8189If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8190the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8191interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8192.code
8193accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8194accept hosts = @[]
8195.endd
8196.next
8197.cindex "CIDR notation"
8198If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8199example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8200host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8201included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8202specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8203significant end of the address.
8204
8205&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8206of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8207address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8208addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8209.code
8210192.168.23.236/31
8211.endd
8212matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
821332 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8214matches.
8215
8216Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8217.code
8218recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8219 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8220.endd
8221The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8222appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8223For example:
8224.code
8225recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8226.endd
8227could make use of a file containing
8228.code
8229172.16.0.0/12
82303ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8231.endd
8232to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8233addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8234changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8235.code
8236recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8237 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8238.endd
8239The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8240list.
8241.endlist
8242
8243
8244
8245.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8246 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8247.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8248When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8249address, the pattern takes this form:
8250.display
8251&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8252.endd
8253For example:
8254.code
8255hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8256.endd
8257The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8258IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8259letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8260&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8261quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8262returned by the lookup is not used.
8263
8264.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8265.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8266Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8267patterns of this form:
8268.display
8269&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8270.endd
8271For example:
8272.code
8273net24-dbm;/networks.db
8274.endd
8275The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8276length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8277mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8278is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8279&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8280
8281When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8282of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8283terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8284to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8285recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8286(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8287For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8288converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8289addresses are always used.
8290
8291Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8292colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8293However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8294configurations.
8295
8296&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8297IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8298the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8299case the IP address is used on its own.
8300
8301
8302
8303.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8304.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8305.cindex "unknown host name"
8306.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8307There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8308remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8309complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8310address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8311above.)
8312
8313If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8314patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8315Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8316DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8317Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8318effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8319Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8320
8321Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8322against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8323
8324By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8325if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8326&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8327are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8328security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8329for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8330Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8331discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8332found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8333
8334There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8335found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8336
8337.cindex "host" "alias for"
8338.cindex "alias for host"
8339As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8340of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8341
8342.ilist
8343.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8344If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8345the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8346&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8347requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8348expression.
8349.next
8350.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8351.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8352If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8353matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8354expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8355case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8356syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8357example,
8358.code
8359^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8360.endd
8361is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8362&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8363that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8364string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8365part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8366.code
8367sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8368.endd
8369&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8370&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8371example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8372required.
8373.endlist
8374
8375
8376
8377
8378.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8379.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8380While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8381name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8382from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8383behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8384
8385&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8386apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8387
8388.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8389.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8390Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8391lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8392Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8393does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8394To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8395&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8396not recognized in an indirected file).
8397
8398.ilist
8399If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8400cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8401.code
8402host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8403.endd
8404rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8405any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8406
8407.next
8408If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8409be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8410example:
8411.code
8412accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8413 192.168.4.5
8414.endd
8415accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8416whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8417name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8418.endlist
8419
8420Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8421list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8422list.
8423
8424.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8425 "SECTmixwilhos"
8426.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8427
8428This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8429as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8430wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8431
8432.ilist
8433If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8434IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8435addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8436.code
8437accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8438.endd
8439The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8440left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8441without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8442a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8443pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8444&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8445if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8446
8447.next
8448If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8449address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8450.code
8451accept hosts = *.friend.example
8452accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8453.endd
8454If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8455&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8456&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8457this section.
8458.endlist
8459
8460
8461.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8462 "SECTtemdnserr"
8463.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8464.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8465.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8466A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8467&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8468host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8469&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8470section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8471host lists such as whitelists.
8472
8473
8474
8475.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8476 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8477.cindex "unknown host name"
8478.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8479If a pattern is of the form
8480.display
8481<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8482.endd
8483for example
8484.code
8485dbm;/host/accept/list
8486.endd
8487a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8488lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8489is not used.
8490
8491&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8492keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8493addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8494&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8495two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8496lookup, both using the same file.
8497
8498
8499
8500.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8501If a pattern is of the form
8502.display
8503<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8504.endd
8505the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8506data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8507&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8508.code
8509hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8510 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8511.endd
8512The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8513can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8514use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8515operator.
8516
8517If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8518looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8519&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8520
8521Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8522host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8523&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8524still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8525effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8526See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8527
8528
8529
8530
8531
8532.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8533.cindex "list" "address list"
8534.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8535.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8536Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8537is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8538always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8539list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8540using this option setting:
8541.code
8542senders = :
8543.endd
8544The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8545data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8546detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8547and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8548
8549Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8550example:
8551.code
8552senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8553.endd
8554A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8555character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8556semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8557subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8558with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8559the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8560wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8561.code
8562deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8563 *@+hostile_domains:\
8564 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8565 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8566.endd
8567.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8568.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8569If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8570specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8571treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8572
8573If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8574contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8575address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8576domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8577is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8578.code
8579deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8580.endd
8581
8582The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8583address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8584senders:
8585
8586.ilist
8587.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8588.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8589If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8590done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8591You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8592as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8593to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8594.code
8595deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8596 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8597.endd
8598The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8599start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8600
8601.next
8602.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8603Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8604lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8605example:
8606.code
8607deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8608 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8609 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8610.endd
8611Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8612lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8613not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8614always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8615
8616Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8617cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8618panic log.
8619.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8620However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8621&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8622default. For example, with this lookup:
8623.code
8624accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8625.endd
8626the file could contains lines like this:
8627.code
8628user1@domain1.example
8629*@domain2.example
8630.endd
8631and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8632that are tried is:
8633.code
8634nimrod@jaeger.example
8635*@jaeger.example
8636*
8637.endd
8638&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8639would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8640
8641&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8642.code
8643deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8644deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8645.endd
8646The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8647because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8648domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8649.endlist
8650
8651
8652The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8653If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8654always fails.
8655
8656
8657.ilist
8658.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8659.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8660.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8661If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8662(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8663split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8664it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8665from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8666of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8667
8668.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8669The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8670keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8671patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8672even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8673with
8674.code
8675deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8676.endd
8677the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8678.code
8679baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8680.endd
8681to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8682
8683.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8684If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8685has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8686may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8687but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8688surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8689.code
8690aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8691 spammer3 : spammer4
8692.endd
8693As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8694doubling.
8695
8696If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8697of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8698list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8699might have entries like
8700.code
8701aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8702xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8703*: ^\d{8}$
8704.endd
8705in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8706local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8707each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8708chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8709
8710.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8711It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8712them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8713
8714.next
8715The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8716lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8717can only return a single list of local parts.
8718.endlist
8719
8720&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8721in these two examples:
8722.code
8723senders = +my_list
8724senders = *@+my_list
8725.endd
8726In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8727example it is a named domain list.
8728
8729
8730
8731
8732.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8733.cindex "case of local parts"
8734.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8735.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8736Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8737case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8738Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8739Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8740blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8741lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8742default.
8743
8744The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8745address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8746comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8747the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8748that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8749keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8750works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8751case-independent.
8752
8753.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8754To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8755an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8756part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8757longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8758lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8759performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8760become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8761
8762
8763
8764.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8765.cindex "list" "local part list"
8766.cindex "local part" "list"
8767Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8768lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8769setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8770set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8771case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8772matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8773&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8774option is case-sensitive from the start.
8775
8776If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8777comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8778only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8779Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8780that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8781&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8782Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8783types.
8784.ecindex IIDdohoadli
8785
8786
8787
8788
8789. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8790. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8791
8792.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8793.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8794Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8795them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8796
8797When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8798when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8799start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8800below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8801escape character, as described in the following section.
8802
8803Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8804dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8805options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8806the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8807conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8808reasons.
8809
8810
8811
8812.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8813.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8814An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8815backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8816character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8817If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8818required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8819the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8820
8821.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8822A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8823two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8824expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8825.code
8826deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8827.endd
8828On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8829without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8830string.
8831
8832
8833
8834.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8835.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8836A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8837expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8838carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8839octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8840backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8841encoding.
8842
8843These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8844in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8845and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8846
8847
8848.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8849.cindex "expansion" "testing"
8850.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8851.oindex "&%-be%&"
8852Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8853takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8854arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8855to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8856since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8857value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8858database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8859and &%nhash%&.
8860
8861Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8862instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8863using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8864
8865.oindex "&%-bem%&"
8866If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8867from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8868option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8869read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8870.code
8871exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8872.endd
8873The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8874Exim message identifier. For example:
8875.code
8876exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8877.endd
8878This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8879is therefore restricted to admin users.
8880
8881
8882.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8883.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8884A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8885alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8886(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8887used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8888instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8889the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8890that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8891its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8892from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8893taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8894being expanded.
8895
8896
8897
8898
8899.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8900The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8901between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8902outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8903white space is significant.
8904
8905.vlist
8906.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8907.cindex "expansion" "variables"
8908Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8909.code
8910$local_part
8911${domain}
8912.endd
8913The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8914characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8915&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8916section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8917given, the expansion fails.
8918
8919.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8920.cindex "expansion" "operators"
8921The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8922<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8923.code
8924${lc:$local_part}
8925.endd
8926The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8927leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8928below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8929one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8930string easier to understand.
8931
8932.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8933This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8934expansion item below.
8935
8936
8937.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8938.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8939.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8940The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8941arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8942Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8943arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8944and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8945are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8946a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8947the result of the expansion.
8948If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8949the expansion result is an empty string.
8950If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8951
8952
8953.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8954 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8955.cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8956.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8957.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8958The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8959The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
8960the certificate. Supported fields are:
8961.display
8962&`version `&
8963&`serial_number `&
8964&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8965&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8966&`notbefore `& time
8967&`notafter `& time
8968&`sig_algorithm `&
8969&`signature `&
8970&`subj_altname `& tagged list
8971&`ocsp_uri `& list
8972&`crl_uri `& list
8973.endd
8974If the field is found,
8975<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8976otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8977variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8978is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8979
8980If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8981key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8982extracted is used.
8983
8984Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8985
8986The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8987output a Distinguished Name string which is
8988not quite
8989parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8990(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8991RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8992a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8993result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8994The separator may be changed by another modifier of
8995a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8996Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8997
8998The field selectors marked as "time" above
8999take an optional modifier of "int"
9000for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9001Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9002in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9003
9004The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9005newline-separated by default,
9006(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9007The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9008a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9009
9010The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9011prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9012Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9013which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9014if so the element tags are omitted.
9015
9016If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9017
9018.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9019 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9020.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9021This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9022This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9023.code
9024EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9025.endd
9026set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9027object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9028(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9029
9030There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9031a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9032included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9033are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9034must have the following type:
9035.code
9036int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9037.endd
9038Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9039function should return one of the following values:
9040
9041&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9042into the expanded string that is being built.
9043
9044&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9045from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9046
9047&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9048taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9049
9050&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9051
9052When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9053you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9054configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9055
9056
9057.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9058.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9059.cindex "environment" "value from"
9060The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9061removed.
9062This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9063If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9064and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9065
9066Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9067appear, for example:
9068.code
9069${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9070.endd
9071This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9072{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9073
9074If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9075search failure.
9076If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9077search success.
9078
9079
9080.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9081 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9082.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9083.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9084The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9085white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9086must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9087form:
9088.display
9089<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9090.endd
9091.vindex "&$value$&"
9092where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9093values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9094values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9095described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9096for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9097the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9098otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9099variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9100is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9101
9102If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9103key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9104extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9105yield &"2001"&:
9106.code
9107${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9108${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9109.endd
9110Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9111appear, for example:
9112.code
9113${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9114.endd
9115This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9116{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9117
9118
9119.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9120 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9121.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9122.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9123The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9124apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9125This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9126behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9127extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9128argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9129<&'string3'&> as before.
9130
9131The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9132separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9133The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9134counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9135number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9136number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9137expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9138provided. For example:
9139.code
9140${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9141.endd
9142yields &"42"&, and
9143.code
9144${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9145.endd
9146yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9147empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9148
9149
9150.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9151.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9152.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9153.vindex "&$item$&"
9154After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9155default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9156in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9157evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9158item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9159separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9160input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9161.code
9162${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9163.endd
9164yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9165to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9166
9167
9168.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9169.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9170.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9171This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9172early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9173(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9174
9175The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9176<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9177<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9178use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9179.code
9180${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9181.endd
9182The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9183or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9184Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9185function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9186first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9187.code
9188abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9189.endd
9190If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9191letters appear. For example:
9192.display
9193&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9194&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9195&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9196.endd
9197
9198.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9199 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9200 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9201 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9202 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9203 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9204.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9205.vindex "&$header_$&"
9206.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9207.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9208.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9209.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9210.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9211Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9212.code
9213$header_reply-to:
9214.endd
9215The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9216internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9217lines) may be present.
9218
9219The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9220the data in the header line is interpreted.
9221
9222.ilist
9223.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9224&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9225processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9226
9227.next
9228.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9229&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9230or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9231character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9232&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9233.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9234produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9235what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9236
9237.next
9238&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9239standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9240be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9241returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9242&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9243a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9244.endlist ilist
9245
9246In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9247command of the following form:
9248.code
9249headers charset "UTF-8"
9250.endd
9251This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9252subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9253character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9254option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9255value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9256ISO-8859-1.
9257
9258Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9259any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9260&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9261if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9262
9263Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9264this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9265message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9266filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9267router or transport are not accessible.
9268
9269For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9270before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9271message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9272are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9273point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9274by earlier ACLs are visible.
9275
9276Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9277following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9278this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9279white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9280expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9281expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9282section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9283header.)
9284
9285If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9286to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9287&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9288each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9289newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9290newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9291those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9292junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9293
9294
9295.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9296.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9297.cindex &%hmac%&
9298This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9299shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9300RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9301&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9302cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9303or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9304present. For example:
9305.code
9306${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9307.endd
9308For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9309produces:
9310.code
9311dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9312.endd
9313As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9314an Exim configuration:
9315.code
9316SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9317.endd
9318In a router or a transport you could then have:
9319.code
9320headers_add = \
9321 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9322 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9323 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9324.endd
9325Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9326&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9327this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9328host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9329using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9330&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9331
9332
9333.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9334.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9335.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9336If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9337item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9338in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9339.code
9340${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9341.endd
9342The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9343true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9344be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9345case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9346&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9347
9348If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9349is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9350cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9351.code
9352condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9353.endd
9354you can use
9355.code
9356condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9357.endd
9358
9359.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9360.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9361.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9362The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9363strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9364you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9365change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9366some of the braces:
9367.code
9368${length_<n>:<string>}
9369.endd
9370The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9371of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9372&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9373
9374
9375.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9376 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9377.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9378.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9379.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9380The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9381apart from an optional leading minus,
9382and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9383
9384After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9385default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9386
9387The first field of the list is numbered one.
9388If the number is negative, the fields are
9389counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9390The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9391then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9392
9393If the modulus of the
9394number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9395the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9396
9397For example:
9398.code
9399${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9400.endd
9401yields &"42"&, and
9402.code
9403${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9404.endd
9405yields &"result: 42"&.
9406
9407If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9408If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9409extracted is used.
9410You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9411
9412
9413.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9414 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9415This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9416described in the next item.
9417
9418.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9419 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9420.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9421.cindex "file" "lookups"
9422.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9423The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9424discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9425lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9426<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9427
9428If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9429a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9430other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9431in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9432out by the system administrator.
9433
9434.vindex "&$value$&"
9435If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9436During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9437lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9438level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9439the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9440string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9441lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9442original lookup fails.
9443
9444If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9445data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9446expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9447the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9448appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9449to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9450{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9451successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9452
9453For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9454search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9455type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9456&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9457
9458.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9459If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9460and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9461They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9462
9463This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9464.code
9465${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9466.endd
9467This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9468the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9469.code
9470${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9471 {$value}fail}
9472.endd
9473
9474
9475.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9476.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9477.vindex "&$item$&"
9478After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9479default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9480in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9481expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9482for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9483setting is not included in the output. For example:
9484.code
9485${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9486.endd
9487expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9488value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9489and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9490
9491.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9492.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9493.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9494The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9495<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9496if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9497can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9498.code
9499${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9500.endd
9501The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9502the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9503processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9504slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9505example,
9506.code
9507${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9508.endd
9509returns the string &"6/33"&.
9510
9511
9512
9513.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9514.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9515.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9516This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9517interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9518expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9519additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9520name of the subroutine, is nine.
9521
9522The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9523the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9524way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9525Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9526return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9527not its contents.
9528
9529If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9530with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9531Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9532
9533The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9534out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9535
9536
9537.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9538.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9539The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9540keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9541it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9542to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9543as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9544and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9545
9546.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9547 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9548.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9549This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9550checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9551yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9552empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9553prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9554version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9555variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9556
9557These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9558retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9559against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9560which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9561
9562The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9563string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9564result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9565whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9566is the expansion of the third argument.
9567
9568All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9569However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9570For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9571
9572.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9573.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9574.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9575.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9576The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9577then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9578the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9579newlines are left in the string.
9580String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9581you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9582the string expansion fails.
9583
9584The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9585locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9586
9587
9588
9589.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9590 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9591.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9592.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9593.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9594This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9595string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9596examples:
9597.code
9598${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9599${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9600.endd
9601For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9602For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9603a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9604number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9605optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9606example:
9607.code
9608${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9609.endd
9610Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9611one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9612both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9613(unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9614is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9615extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9616.code
9617${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9618.endd
9619A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9620that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9621turns them into spaces:
9622.code
9623${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9624.endd
9625As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9626happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9627addition, the following errors can occur:
9628
9629.ilist
9630Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9631.next
9632Failure to connect the socket;
9633.next
9634Failure to write the request string;
9635.next
9636Timeout on reading from the socket.
9637.endlist
9638
9639By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9640you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9641errors occurs. For example:
9642.code
9643${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9644 {socket failure}}
9645.endd
9646You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9647expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9648and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9649if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9650non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9651
9652The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9653locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9654
9655
9656.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9657.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9658.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9659.vindex "&$value$&"
9660.vindex "&$item$&"
9661This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9662<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9663separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9664assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9665list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9666them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9667iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9668added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9669number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9670.code
9671${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9672.endd
9673The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9674can be found:
9675.code
9676${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9677.endd
9678At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9679restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9680expansion items.
9681
9682.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9683This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9684expansion item above.
9685
9686.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9687 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9688.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9689.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9690The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9691split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9692in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9693executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9694a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9695
9696Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9697which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9698simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9699script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9700variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9701quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9702in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9703around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9704variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9705character.
9706
9707The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9708and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9709.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9710.vindex "&$value$&"
9711If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9712and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9713from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9714<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9715expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9716&$value$&.
9717
9718If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9719can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9720command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9721of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9722
9723.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9724The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9725In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9726troubleshoot:
9727.code
9728warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9729 log_message = Output of id: $value
9730.endd
9731If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9732shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9733.code
9734${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9735.endd
9736
9737.vindex "&$runrc$&"
9738The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9739remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9740.code
9741if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9742 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9743 ...
9744endif
9745.endd
9746If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9747the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9748commands.
9749
9750&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9751option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9752testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9753by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9754
9755The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9756out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9757
9758
9759.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9760.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9761.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9762This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9763option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9764modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9765into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9766a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9767.code
9768${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9769.endd
9770yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9771if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9772substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9773.code
9774${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9775.endd
9776yields &"defabc"&, and
9777.code
9778${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9779.endd
9780yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9781the regular expression from string expansion.
9782
9783
9784
9785.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9786.cindex sorting "a list"
9787.cindex list sorting
9788.cindex expansion "list sorting"
9789After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9790default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9791The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9792of a two-argument expansion condition.
9793The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9794The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9795if the first value should sort before the second value.
9796The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9797the element being placed in &$item$&,
9798to give values for comparison.
9799
9800The item result is a sorted list,
9801with the original list separator,
9802of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9803
9804Examples:
9805.code
9806${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9807.endd
9808sorts a list of numbers, and
9809.code
9810${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9811.endd
9812will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9813
9814
9815.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9816.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9817.cindex "substring extraction"
9818.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9819The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9820<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9821if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9822can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9823.code
9824${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9825.endd
9826The second number is optional (in both notations).
9827If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9828omitted.
9829
9830The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9831&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9832length required. For example
9833.code
9834${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9835.endd
9836If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9837null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9838length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9839given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9840
9841The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9842from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9843second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9844.code
9845${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9846.endd
9847yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9848length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9849the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9850.code
9851${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9852.endd
9853yields an empty string, but
9854.code
9855${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9856.endd
9857yields &"1"&.
9858
9859When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9860is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9861string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9862no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9863.code
9864${substr_-1:abcde}
9865${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9866.endd
9867yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9868
9869
9870
9871.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9872 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9873.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9874.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9875This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9876argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9877matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9878replacement list. For example
9879.code
9880${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9881.endd
9882yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9883last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9884last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9885place.
9886.endlist
9887
9888
9889
9890.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9891.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9892For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9893the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9894The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9895following operations can be performed:
9896
9897.vlist
9898.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9899.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9900.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9901The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9902header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9903not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9904
9905
9906.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9907.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9908.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9909The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
99102822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9911operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9912result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9913doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9914Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9915
9916It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9917separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9918character. For example:
9919.code
9920${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9921.endd
9922expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9923expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9924address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9925processing lists.
9926
9927To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9928a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9929unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9930email address separator. For the example header line:
9931.code
9932From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9933.endd
9934The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9935properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9936It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9937example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9938de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9939The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9940quoted.
9941.code
9942# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9943=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9944user@example.com
9945# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9946Last:user@example.com
9947# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9948user@example.com
9949.endd
9950
9951.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9952.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9953.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9954The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9955base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9956the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9957its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9958names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9959be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9960
9961.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9962.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9963.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9964The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9965environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9966identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9967string.
9968
9969
9970.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9971.cindex "domain" "extraction"
9972.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9973The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9974from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9975
9976
9977.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9978.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9979.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9980If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9981escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9982significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9983is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9984
9985
9986.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9987.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9988.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9989.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9990These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9991expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9992arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9993logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9994integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9995C programming language):
9996.table2 70pt 300pt
9997.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9998.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9999.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10000.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10001.irow "" "and (&&)"
10002.irow "" "xor (^)"
10003.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10004.endtable
10005Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10006space is permitted before or after operators.
10007
10008For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10009hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10010decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10011permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10012times, which often do have leading zeros.
10013
10014A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10015or 1024*1024*1024,
10016respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10017a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10018
10019.display
10020&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10021&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10022&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10023&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10024&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10025&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10026&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10027&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10028&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10029&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10030&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10031.endd
10032
10033As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10034.code
10035deny message = Too many bad recipients
10036 condition = \
10037 ${if and { \
10038 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10039 { \
10040 < \
10041 {$recipients_count} \
10042 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10043 } \
10044 }{yes}{no}}
10045.endd
10046The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10047fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10048
10049
10050.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10051.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10052The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10053example,
10054.code
10055${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10056.endd
10057first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10058and then re-expands what it has found.
10059
10060
10061.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10062.cindex "Unicode"
10063.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10064.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10065.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10066The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10067email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10068to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10069UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10070converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10071the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10072
10073Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10074ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10075For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10076way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10077characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10078single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10079translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10080
10081
10082.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10083.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10084.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10085The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10086be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10087change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10088.code
10089${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10090.endd
10091See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10092abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10093
10094
10095
10096.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10097.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10098.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10099.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10100This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10101be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10102
10103
10104
10105.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10106.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10107.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10108This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10109escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10110as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10111byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10112
10113
10114.new
10115.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10116.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10117.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10118This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10119of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10120A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10121Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10122
10123.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10124.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10125.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10126.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10127This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10128Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10129set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10130A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10131Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10132.wen
10133
10134
10135.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10136.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10137.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10138.cindex "lower casing"
10139.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10140.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10141This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10142.code
10143${lc:$local_part}
10144.endd
10145
10146.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10147.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10148.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10149The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10150can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10151changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10152.code
10153${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10154.endd
10155See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10156&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10157when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10158
10159
10160.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10161.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10162.cindex "list" "item count"
10163.cindex "list" "count of items"
10164.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10165The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10166
10167
10168.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10169.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10170.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10171The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10172expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10173If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10174and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10175Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10176matching list is returned.
10177
10178
10179.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10180.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10181.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10182The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10183extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10184empty.
10185
10186
10187.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10188.cindex "masked IP address"
10189.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10190.cindex "CIDR notation"
10191.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10192.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10193If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10194slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10195expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10196masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10197the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10198.code
10199${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10200.endd
10201returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10202be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10203address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10204terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10205.code
10206${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10207.endd
10208returns the string
10209.code
102103ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10211.endd
10212Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10213
10214
10215.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10216.cindex "MD5 hash"
10217.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10218.cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10219.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10220The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10221as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10222
10223
10224.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10225.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10226.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10227The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10228that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10229strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10230.code
10231${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10232.endd
10233See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10234
10235
10236.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10237.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10238.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10239.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10240The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10241is an empty string or
10242contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10243Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10244Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10245respectively For example,
10246.code
10247${quote:ab"*"cd}
10248.endd
10249becomes
10250.code
10251"ab\"*\"cd"
10252.endd
10253The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10254variable or a message header.
10255
10256.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10257.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10258This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10259required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10260example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10261If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10262(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10263
10264
10265.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10266.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10267This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10268query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10269the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10270.code
10271${quote_ldap:two * two}
10272.endd
10273returns
10274.code
10275two%20%5C2A%20two
10276.endd
10277For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10278yields an unchanged string.
10279
10280
10281.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10282.cindex "random number"
10283This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10284supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10285on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10286If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10287If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10288for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10289Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10290srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10291random().
10292
10293
10294.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10295.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10296This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10297dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10298dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10299for DNS. For example,
10300.code
10301${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10302${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10303.endd
10304returns
10305.code
103064.2.0.192
10307f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10308.endd
10309
10310
10311.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10312.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10313.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10314.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10315This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10316encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10317assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10318&%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10319contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10320characters
10321.code
10322? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10323.endd
10324it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10325string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10326characters.
10327
10328
10329.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10330.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10331.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10332.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10333This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10334bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10335character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10336not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10337
10338&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10339access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10340to use this operator as well.
10341
10342
10343
10344.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10345.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10346.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10347.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10348The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10349characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10350variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10351
10352
10353.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10354.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10355.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10356.cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10357.cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10358The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10359it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10360
10361
10362.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10363.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10364.cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10365.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10366.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10367The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10368certificate,
10369and returns
10370it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10371Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10372
10373
10374.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10375.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10376.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10377.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10378The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10379function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10380expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10381series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10382except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10383a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1038410-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10385&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10386can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10387
10388The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10389the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10390systems for files larger than 2GB.
10391
10392.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10393.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10394.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10395.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10396This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10397
10398
10399
10400.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10401.cindex "expansion" "string length"
10402.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10403.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10404The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10405decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10406
10407
10408.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10409.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10410.cindex "substring extraction"
10411.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10412The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10413can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10414that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10415.code
10416${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10417.endd
10418See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10419abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10420
10421.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10422.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10423.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10424This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10425seconds.
10426
10427.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10428.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10429.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10430The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10431represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10432number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10433&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10434
10435.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10436.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10437.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10438.cindex "upper casing"
10439.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10440.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10441This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10442
10443.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10444.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10445.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10446.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10447.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10448.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10449This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10450.endlist
10451
10452
10453
10454
10455
10456
10457.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10458.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10459The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10460while expanding strings:
10461
10462.vlist
10463.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10464.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10465.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10466Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10467condition.
10468
10469.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10470.cindex "numeric comparison"
10471.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10472There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10473are:
10474.display
10475&`= `& equal
10476&`== `& equal
10477&`> `& greater
10478&`>= `& greater or equal
10479&`< `& less
10480&`<= `& less or equal
10481.endd
10482For example:
10483.code
10484${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10485.endd
10486Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10487two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10488optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10489lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10490As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10491zero.
10492
10493In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10494<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1049510M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10496
10497
10498.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10499 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10500.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10501.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10502The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10503arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10504Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10505arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10506and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10507are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10508a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10509the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10510If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10511If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10512
10513.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10514.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10515.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10516This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10517a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10518(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10519false if zero.
10520An empty string is treated as false.
10521Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10522thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10523All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10524
10525When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10526make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10527For example:
10528.code
10529${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10530.endd
10531
10532
10533.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10534.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10535.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10536Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10537where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10538loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10539and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10540true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10541
10542Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10543
10544.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10545.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10546.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10547.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10548This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10549authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10550necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10551included in the binary.
10552
10553The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10554compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10555be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10556encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10557does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10558&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10559Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10560string in LDAP form is:
10561.code
10562{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10563.endd
10564If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10565be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10566.code
10567${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10568.endd
10569The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10570supported:
10571
10572.ilist
10573.cindex "MD5 hash"
10574.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10575&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10576printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10577length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10578(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10579hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10580comparison fails.
10581
10582.next
10583.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10584&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10585printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10586length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10587If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10588SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10589
10590.next
10591.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10592&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10593only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10594systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10595whatever its length.
10596
10597.next
10598.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10599&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10600use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10601modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10602.endlist
10603Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10604&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10605HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10606operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10607the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10608support &[crypt16()]&.
10609
10610Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10611it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10612turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10613&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10614algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10615
10616However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10617functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10618Exim is seen as very low priority.
10619
10620If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10621comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10622determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10623default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10624function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10625
10626.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10627.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10628.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10629The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10630variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10631variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10632.code
10633${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10634.endd
10635Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10636variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10637
10638.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10639 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10640.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10641This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10642exists in the message. For example,
10643.code
10644${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10645.endd
10646&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10647the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10648
10649.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10650 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10651.cindex "string" "comparison"
10652.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10653.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10654.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10655The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10656resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10657letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10658
10659.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10660.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10661.cindex "file" "existence test"
10662.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10663The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10664condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10665is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10666users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10667
10668.vitem &*first_delivery*&
10669.cindex "delivery" "first"
10670.cindex "first delivery"
10671.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10672.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10673This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10674attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10675
10676
10677.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10678 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10679.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10680.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10681.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10682.vindex "&$item$&"
10683These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10684the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10685the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10686be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10687condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10688.ilist
10689For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10690the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10691items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10692.next
10693For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10694and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10695all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10696.endlist
10697Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10698items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10699that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10700list separator is changed to a comma:
10701.code
10702${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10703.endd
10704The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10705being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10706
10707To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10708
10709
10710.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10711 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10712.cindex "string" "comparison"
10713.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10714.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10715.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10716The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10717string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10718comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10719case-independent.
10720
10721.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10722 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10723.cindex "string" "comparison"
10724.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10725.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10726.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10727The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10728string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10729includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10730case-independent.
10731
10732.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10733 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10734.cindex "string" "comparison"
10735.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10736Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10737strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10738is true.
10739
10740These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10741Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10742.code
10743${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10744 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10745${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10746 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10747.endd
10748
10749.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10750 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10751 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10752.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10753.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10754.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10755.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10756.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10757The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10758an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10759&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10760
10761For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10762which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10763colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10764hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10765component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10766
10767&*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10768values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10769check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10770host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10771.code
10772${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10773.endd
10774to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10775
10776.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10777.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10778.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10779.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10780This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10781&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10782queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10783query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10784password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10785server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10786with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10787will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10788of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10789this can be used.
10790
10791
10792.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10793 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10794.cindex "string" "comparison"
10795.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10796.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10797.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10798The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10799string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10800comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10801case-independent.
10802
10803.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10804 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10805.cindex "string" "comparison"
10806.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10807.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10808.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10809The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10810string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10811includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10812case-independent.
10813
10814
10815.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10816.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10817.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10818.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10819The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10820expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10821regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10822escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10823(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10824premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10825&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10826For example,
10827.code
10828${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10829.endd
10830If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10831backslashes is also required.
10832
10833The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10834The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10835metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10836and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10837the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10838metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10839
10840.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10841At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10842substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10843succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10844will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10845of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10846combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10847variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10848
10849.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10850.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10851See &*match_local_part*&.
10852
10853.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10854.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10855See &*match_local_part*&.
10856
10857.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10858.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10859This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10860be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10861address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10862list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10863.code
10864${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10865.endd
10866The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10867
10868.ilist
10869An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10870.next
10871A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10872.next
10873An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10874useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10875in a single test such as
10876. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10877. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10878. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10879. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10880.code
10881 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10882.endd
10883where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10884.next
10885The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10886.next
10887Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10888even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10889address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10890&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10891masks. For example:
10892.code
10893 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10894.endd
10895It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10896do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10897address mask, for example:
10898.code
10899 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10900.endd
10901However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10902just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10903.code
10904 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10905.endd
10906.endlist ilist
10907
10908Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10909Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10910
10911Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10912
10913.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10914.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10915.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10916.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10917.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10918This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10919possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10920condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10921example is:
10922.code
10923${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10924.endd
10925In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10926list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10927expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10928Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10929.code
10930${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10931.endd
10932.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10933For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10934item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10935have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10936caselessly.
10937
10938Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10939Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10940
10941&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10942hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10943how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10944matched using &%match_ip%&.
10945
10946.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10947.cindex "PAM authentication"
10948.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10949.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10950.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10951.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10952&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10953(&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10954available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10955distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10956the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10957.code
10958SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10959.endd
10960in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10961in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10962
10963The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10964colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10965The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10966taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10967The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10968from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10969request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10970
10971There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10972characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10973separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10974item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10975of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10976.code
10977server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10978.endd
10979For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10980.code
10981server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10982.endd
10983In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10984running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10985messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10986A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10987Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10988The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10989to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10990group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10991
10992
10993.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10994.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10995.cindex "Cyrus"
10996.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10997.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10998This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10999This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11000that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11001deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11002
11003The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11004the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11005building Exim. For example:
11006.code
11007CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11008.endd
11009You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11010the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11011from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11012access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11013
11014The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11015password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11016configuration, you might have this:
11017.code
11018server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11019.endd
11020Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11021.code
11022server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11023.endd
11024.vitem &*queue_running*&
11025.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11026.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11027.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11028This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11029initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11030
11031
11032.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11033.cindex "Radius"
11034.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11035.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11036Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11037set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11038the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11039support.
11040
11041With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11042library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11043this library, you need to set
11044.code
11045RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11046.endd
11047in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11048&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11049.code
11050RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11051.endd
11052in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11053You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11054Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11055
11056The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11057Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11058the authentication is successful. For example:
11059.code
11060server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11061.endd
11062
11063
11064.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11065 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11066.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11067.cindex "Cyrus"
11068.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11069.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11070This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11071daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11072Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11073by a process that is not running as root.
11074
11075The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11076the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11077building Exim. For example:
11078.code
11079CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11080.endd
11081You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11082the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11083from the Cyrus SASL library.
11084
11085Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11086two are mandatory. For example:
11087.code
11088server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11089.endd
11090The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11091in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11092realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11093.endlist vlist
11094
11095
11096
11097.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11098.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11099Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11100and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11101conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11102sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11103the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11104
11105
11106.vlist
11107.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11108.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11109.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11110The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11111any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11112For example,
11113.code
11114${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11115.endd
11116When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11117evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11118numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11119
11120.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11121.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11122.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11123The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11124all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11125sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11126the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11127parsed but not evaluated.
11128.endlist
11129.ecindex IIDexpcond
11130
11131
11132
11133
11134.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11135.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11136This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11137of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11138support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11139
11140.vlist
11141.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11142.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11143When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11144captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11145processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11146In the expansion condition case
11147they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11148values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11149variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11150precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11151Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11152matching condition.
11153
11154.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11155Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11156any arguments are copied to these variables,
11157any unused variables being made empty.
11158
11159.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11160Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11161can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11162long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11163example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11164variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11165used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11166same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11167with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11168during subsequent delivery.
11169
11170.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11171These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11172are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11173received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11174message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11175also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11176message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11177and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11178delivery.
11179
11180.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11181Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11182this variable has the number of arguments.
11183
11184.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11185.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11186After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11187message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11188be preserved by coding like this:
11189.code
11190warn !verify = sender
11191 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11192.endd
11193You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11194&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11195failure.
11196
11197.vitem &$address_data$&
11198.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11199This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11200value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11201and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11202the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11203for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11204user filter files.
11205
11206If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11207a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11208conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11209to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11210of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11211from the child's routing.
11212
11213If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11214sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11215&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11216address.
11217
11218In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11219after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11220these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11221
11222.vitem &$address_file$&
11223.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11224When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11225to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11226is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11227default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11228.code
11229/home/r2d2/savemail
11230.endd
11231then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11232contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11233.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11234For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11235then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11236to the relevant file.
11237
11238.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11239.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11240When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11241this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11242
11243.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11244.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11245These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11246&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11247
11248.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11249.cindex "authentication" "id"
11250.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11251When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11252preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11253&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11254user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11255in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11256&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11257When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11258the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11259process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11260command line option.
11261
11262.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11263.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11264.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11265When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11266will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11267id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11268available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11269A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11270authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11271the ACL's as well.
11272
11273
11274.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11275.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11276.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11277.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11278.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11279When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11280SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11281described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11282&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11283available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11284sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11285
11286.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11287When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11288value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11289name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11290can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11291
11292
11293.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11294.cindex "authentication" "failure"
11295.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11296This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11297command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11298possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11299(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11300&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11301is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11302negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11303an undefined mechanism.
11304
11305.vitem &$av_failed$&
11306.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11307This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11308extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11309problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11310the ACL malware condition.
11311
11312.vitem &$body_linecount$&
11313.cindex "message body" "line count"
11314.cindex "body of message" "line count"
11315.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11316When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11317number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11318
11319.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11320.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11321.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11322.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11323.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11324When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11325number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11326
11327.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11328.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11329This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11330it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11331chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11332
11333.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11334.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11335This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11336up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11337file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11338
11339.vitem &$caller_gid$&
11340.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11341.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11342The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11343not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11344&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11345incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11346
11347.vitem &$caller_uid$&
11348.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11349.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11350The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11351not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11352&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11353incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11354
11355.vitem &$callout_address$&
11356.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11357After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11358address that was connected to.
11359
11360.vitem &$compile_number$&
11361.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11362The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11363of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11364compilations of the same version of the program.
11365
11366.vitem &$config_dir$&
11367.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11368The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11369&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11370contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11371&$config_dir$& is ".".
11372
11373.vitem &$config_file$&
11374.vindex "&$config_file$&"
11375The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11376
11377.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11378.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11379This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11380the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11381details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11382
11383.vitem &$demime_reason$&
11384.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11385This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11386content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11387see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11388
11389.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11390 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11391 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11392 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11393 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11394 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11395 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11396 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11397 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11398 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11399 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11400 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11401 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11402 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11403 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11404 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11405 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11406 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11407 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11408These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11409For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11410
11411.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11412.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11413When a message has been received this variable contains
11414a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11415For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11416
11417.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11418 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11419 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11420 &$dnslist_value$&
11421.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11422.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11423.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11424.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11425.cindex "black list (DNS)"
11426When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11427the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11428looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11429main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11430
11431.vitem &$domain$&
11432.vindex "&$domain$&"
11433When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11434contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11435case for &$domain$&.
11436
11437Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11438&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11439is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11440message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11441
11442When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11443RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11444have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11445at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11446the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11447which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11448
11449.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11450At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11451set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11452
11453The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11454
11455.ilist
11456When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11457the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11458&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11459normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11460is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11461&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11462the &(smtp)& transport.
11463
11464.next
11465When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11466&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11467it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11468rewrite domains by file lookup.
11469
11470.next
11471With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11472&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11473a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11474is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11475that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11476recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11477
11478.next
11479.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11480.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11481When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11482the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11483.endlist
11484
11485
11486.vitem &$domain_data$&
11487.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11488When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11489means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11490of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11491address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11492transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11493used.
11494
11495&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11496domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11497the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11498to nothing.
11499
11500.vitem &$exim_gid$&
11501.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11502This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11503
11504.vitem &$exim_path$&
11505.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11506This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11507
11508.vitem &$exim_uid$&
11509.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11510This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11511
11512.vitem &$exim_version$&
11513.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11514This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11515The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11516Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11517There may be other characters following the minor version.
11518
11519.vitem &$found_extension$&
11520.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11521This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11522content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11523see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11524
11525.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11526This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11527inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11528be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11529characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11530
11531.vitem &$headers_added$&
11532.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11533Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11534the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11535The headers are a newline-separated list.
11536
11537.vitem &$home$&
11538.vindex "&$home$&"
11539When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11540directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11541means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11542explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11543by a setting on the transport itself.
11544
11545When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11546of the environment variable HOME.
11547
11548.vitem &$host$&
11549.vindex "&$host$&"
11550If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11551list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11552to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11553to local and remote transports.
11554
11555.cindex "transport" "filter"
11556.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11557For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11558&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11559particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11560using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11561&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11562is connected.
11563
11564When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11565&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11566client is connected.
11567
11568
11569.vitem &$host_address$&
11570.vindex "&$host_address$&"
11571This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11572for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11573when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11574
11575.vitem &$host_data$&
11576.vindex "&$host_data$&"
11577If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11578result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11579allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11580.code
11581deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11582message = $host_data
11583.endd
11584.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11585.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11586.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11587This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11588message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11589name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11590variables is set to &"1"&.
11591
11592.ilist
11593If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11594succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11595
11596.next
11597If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11598tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11599lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11600.endlist ilist
11601
11602Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11603single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11604names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11605is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11606&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11607IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11608sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11609lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11610the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11611&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11612
11613.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11614.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11615See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11616
11617.vitem &$host_port$&
11618.vindex "&$host_port$&"
11619This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11620for an outbound connection.
11621
11622
11623.vitem &$inode$&
11624.vindex "&$inode$&"
11625The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11626option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11627of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11628a unique name for the file.
11629
11630.vitem &$interface_address$&
11631.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11632This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11633
11634.vitem &$interface_port$&
11635.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11636This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11637
11638.vitem &$item$&
11639.vindex "&$item$&"
11640This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11641conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11642&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11643empty.
11644
11645.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11646.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11647This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11648contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11649lookup.
11650
11651.vitem &$load_average$&
11652.vindex "&$load_average$&"
11653This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11654is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11655variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11656
11657.vitem &$local_part$&
11658.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11659When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11660variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11661delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11662session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11663
11664Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11665&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11666&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11667because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11668once.
11669
11670.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11671.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11672If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11673value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11674any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11675&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11676
11677When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11678result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11679the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11680&$address_pipe$&).
11681
11682When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11683local part of the recipient address.
11684
11685When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11686&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11687it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11688
11689In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11690the addresses
11691.code
11692"abc:xyz"@test.example
11693abc\:xyz@test.example
11694.endd
11695the value of &$local_part$& is
11696.code
11697abc:xyz
11698.endd
11699If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11700inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11701have:
11702.code
11703data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11704.endd
11705&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11706to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11707&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11708
11709.vitem &$local_part_data$&
11710.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11711When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11712lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11713router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11714to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11715handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11716
11717&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11718matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11719available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11720variable expands to nothing.
11721
11722.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11723.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11724When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11725specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11726variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11727
11728.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11729.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11730When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11731specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11732variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11733
11734.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11735.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11736This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11737a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11738
11739.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11740.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11741See &$local_user_uid$&.
11742
11743.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11744.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11745This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11746&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11747are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11748and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11749router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11750are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11751
11752.vitem &$localhost_number$&
11753.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11754This contains the expanded value of the
11755&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11756been read.
11757
11758.vitem &$log_inodes$&
11759.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11760The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11761log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11762referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11763the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11764
11765.vitem &$log_space$&
11766.vindex "&$log_space$&"
11767The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11768partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11769whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11770ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11771the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11772
11773
11774.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11775.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11776This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11777a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11778.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11779It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11780&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11781and &"yes"& if it was.
11782Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11783the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11784as authenticated data.
11785
11786.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11787.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11788This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11789&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11790&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11791contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11792without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11793variable is empty.
11794
11795.vitem &$malware_name$&
11796.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11797This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11798content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11799when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11800
11801.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11802.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11803.cindex "maximum" "line length"
11804.cindex "line length" "maximum"
11805This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11806received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11807character(s).
11808
11809.vitem &$message_age$&
11810.cindex "message" "age of"
11811.vindex "&$message_age$&"
11812This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11813of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11814delivery attempt.
11815
11816.vitem &$message_body$&
11817.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11818.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11819.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11820.vindex "&$message_body$&"
11821.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11822This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11823being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11824number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11825&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11826
11827.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11828By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11829easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11830this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11831zeros are always converted into spaces.
11832
11833.vitem &$message_body_end$&
11834.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11835.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11836.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11837This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11838body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11839&$message_body$&.
11840
11841.vitem &$message_body_size$&
11842.cindex "body of message" "size"
11843.cindex "message body" "size"
11844.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11845When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11846in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11847separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11848also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11849
11850.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11851.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11852When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11853unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11854An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11855received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11856line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11857&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11858
11859.vitem &$message_headers$&
11860.vindex &$message_headers$&
11861This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11862is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11863lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11864same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11865
11866.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11867.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11868This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11869contents of header lines is done.
11870
11871.vitem &$message_id$&
11872This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11873
11874.vitem &$message_linecount$&
11875.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11876This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11877message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11878During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11879number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11880routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11881&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11882lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11883from the body is not counted.
11884
11885As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11886appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11887&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11888file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11889header and the body).
11890
11891Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11892.code
11893deny message = Too many lines in message header
11894 condition = \
11895 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11896.endd
11897In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11898message has not yet been received.
11899
11900.vitem &$message_size$&
11901.cindex "size" "of message"
11902.cindex "message" "size"
11903.vindex "&$message_size$&"
11904When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11905most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11906message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11907deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11908expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11909doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11910precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11911&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11912
11913.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11914While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11915contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11916value may not, of course, be truthful.
11917
11918.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11919A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11920available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11921details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11922
11923.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11924These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11925of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11926
11927.vitem &$original_domain$&
11928.vindex "&$domain$&"
11929.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11930When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11931same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11932generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11933variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11934differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11935aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11936single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11937
11938If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11939filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11940part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11941
11942.vitem &$original_local_part$&
11943.vindex "&$local_part$&"
11944.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11945When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11946same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11947local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11948part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11949filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11950the original address.
11951
11952If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11953case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11954This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11955one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11956delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11957
11958If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11959filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11960part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11961
11962.vitem &$originator_gid$&
11963.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11964.cindex "sender" "gid"
11965.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11966.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11967This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11968message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11969gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11970normally the gid of the Exim user.
11971
11972.vitem &$originator_uid$&
11973.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11974.cindex "sender" "uid"
11975.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11976.vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11977The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11978messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11979For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11980user.
11981
11982.vitem &$parent_domain$&
11983.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11984This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11985above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11986
11987.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11988.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11989This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11990(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11991
11992.vitem &$pid$&
11993.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11994.vindex "&$pid$&"
11995This variable contains the current process id.
11996
11997.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11998.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11999.cindex "transport" "filter"
12000.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12001This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12002&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12003&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12004(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12005It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12006variable"& error if encountered.
12007
12008.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12009.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12010This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12011configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12012a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12013&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12014qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12015
12016
12017.new
12018.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12019.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12020This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12021current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12022.wen
12023
12024.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12025This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12026which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12027&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12028
12029.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12030This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12031which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12032&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12033
12034.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12035This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12036which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12037&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12038
12039.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12040.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12041The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12042
12043.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12044.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12045The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12046or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12047
12048.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12049.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12050When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12051RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12052RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12053
12054.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12055.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12056.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12057When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12058RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12059temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12060
12061.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12062.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12063When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12064RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12065permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12066
12067.vitem &$received_count$&
12068.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12069This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12070including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12071is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12072delivering.
12073
12074.vitem &$received_for$&
12075.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12076If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12077variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12078built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12079the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12080
12081.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12082.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12083As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12084variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12085is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12086&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12087the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12088option.
12089
12090As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12091could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12092on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12093values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12094messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12095time.
12096For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12097
12098.vitem &$received_port$&
12099.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12100See &$received_ip_address$&.
12101
12102.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12103.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12104When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12105protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12106by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12107&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12108(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12109is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12110connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12111
12112Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12113automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12114&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12115encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12116where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12117STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12118
12119The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12120messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12121identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12122
12123.vitem &$received_time$&
12124.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12125This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12126as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12127
12128.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12129.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12130This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12131condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12132until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12133.display
12134&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12135&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12136.endd
12137&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12138method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12139The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12140expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12141
12142.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12143.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12144In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12145information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12146
12147.ilist
12148&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12149was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12150
12151.next
12152&"route"&: Routing failed.
12153
12154.next
12155&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12156or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12157MAIL).
12158
12159.next
12160&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12161.next
12162
12163&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12164.endlist
12165
12166The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12167rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12168
12169.vitem &$recipients$&
12170.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12171This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12172a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12173is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12174unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12175cases:
12176
12177.olist
12178In a system filter file.
12179.next
12180In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12181is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12182&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12183&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12184.next
12185From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12186.endlist
12187
12188
12189.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12190.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12191When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12192envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12193from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12194increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12195
12196
12197.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12198.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12199This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12200&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12201
12202.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12203.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12204When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12205these variables contain the
12206captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12207
12208
12209.vitem &$reply_address$&
12210.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12211When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12212&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12213contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12214white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12215decoding or character code translation takes place.
12216
12217.vitem &$return_path$&
12218.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12219When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12220the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12221in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12222same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12223mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12224for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12225address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12226that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12227the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12228envelope sender.
12229
12230.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12231.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12232This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12233
12234.vitem &$router_name$&
12235.cindex "router" "name"
12236.cindex "name" "of router"
12237.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12238During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12239
12240.vitem &$runrc$&
12241.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12242.vindex "&$runrc$&"
12243This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12244&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12245assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12246preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12247reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12248another.
12249
12250.vitem &$self_hostname$&
12251.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12252.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12253When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12254local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12255One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12256happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12257original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12258
12259.vitem &$sender_address$&
12260.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12261When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12262that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12263is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12264value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12265
12266.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12267.vindex "&$address_data$&"
12268.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12269If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12270sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12271distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12272after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12273longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12274
12275.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12276.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12277The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12278
12279.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12280.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12281The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12282
12283.vitem &$sender_data$&
12284.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12285This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12286in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12287value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12288this:
12289.display
12290&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12291&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12292.endd
12293&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12294method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12295The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12296expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12297
12298.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12299.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12300When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12301name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12302brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12303enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12304issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12305looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12306&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12307start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12308verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12309the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12310the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12311
12312.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12313.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12314This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12315.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12316done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12317
12318.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12319.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12320When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12321command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12322set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12323the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12324
12325.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12326.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12327When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12328this variable contains that
12329host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12330
12331.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12332.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12333This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12334driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12335received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12336&$authenticated_id$&.
12337
12338.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12339.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12340If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12341(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12342otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12343resolver library states that both
12344the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12345other times, this variable is false.
12346
12347.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12348It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12349library, by setting:
12350.code
12351dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12352.endd
12353
12354Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12355validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12356
12357If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12358mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12359
12360
12361.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12362.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12363When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12364host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12365other means, this variable is empty.
12366
12367.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12368If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12369&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12370A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12371via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12372any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12373&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12374
12375.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12376However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12377DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12378&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12379
12380Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12381host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12382in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12383is set to &"1"&.
12384
12385Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12386maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12387these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12388following are true:
12389
12390.ilist
12391A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12392.next
12393The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12394configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12395to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12396.next
12397Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12398that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12399&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12400.next
12401The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12402In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12403EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12404.next
12405The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12406domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12407. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12408. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12409.code
12410 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12411.endd
12412which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12413IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12414.endlist
12415
12416
12417.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12418.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12419When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12420number that was used on the remote host.
12421
12422.vitem &$sender_ident$&
12423.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12424When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12425identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12426been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12427called Exim.
12428
12429.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12430A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12431&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12432&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12433
12434.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12435.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12436.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12437.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12438This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12439either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12440there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12441there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12442the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12443followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12444first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12445the parentheses.
12446
12447There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12448was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12449address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12450all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12451into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12452
12453.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12454.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12455In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12456about the failure. The details are the same as for
12457&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12458
12459.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12460.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12461This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12462been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12463used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12464on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12465connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12466
12467.vitem &$sending_port$&
12468.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12469This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12470been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12471connections, see &$received_port$&.
12472
12473.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12474.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12475During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12476host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12477&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12478value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12479
12480.vitem &$smtp_command$&
12481.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12482During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12483entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12484the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12485.code
12486MAIL FROM:<>
12487MAIL FROM: <>
12488.endd
12489For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12490command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12491rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12492the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12493
12494.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12495.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12496.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12497While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12498argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12499space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12500somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12501
12502.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12503.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12504This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12505daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12506in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12507connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12508the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12509never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12510there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12511single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12512daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12513
12514.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12515These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12516that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12517filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12518example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12519message is junk mail.
12520
12521.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12522A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12523is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12524&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12525
12526
12527.vitem &$spool_directory$&
12528.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12529The name of Exim's spool directory.
12530
12531.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12532.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12533The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12534being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12535If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12536is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12537
12538.vitem &$spool_space$&
12539.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12540The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12541Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12542variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12543find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12544value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12545megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12546.code
12547condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12548.endd
12549See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12550
12551
12552.vitem &$thisaddress$&
12553.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12554This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12555command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12556command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12557interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12558
12559.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12560.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12561Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12562on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12563this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12564If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12565The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12566when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12567
12568The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12569except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12570the outbound.
12571
12572.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12573.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12574Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12575on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12576this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12577If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12578
12579.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12580.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12581This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12582inbound connection when the message was received.
12583It is only useful as the argument of a
12584&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12585or a &%def%& condition.
12586
12587.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12588.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12589This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12590inbound connection when the message was received.
12591It is only useful as the argument of a
12592&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12593or a &%def%& condition.
12594If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12595which is not the leaf.
12596
12597.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12598.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12599This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12600outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12601&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12602or a &%def%& condition.
12603
12604.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12605.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12606This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12607outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12608&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12609or a &%def%& condition.
12610If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12611which is not the leaf.
12612
12613.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12614.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12615This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12616message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12617
12618The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12619except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12620the outbound.
12621
12622.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12623.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12624This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12625outbound SMTP connection was made,
12626and &"0"& otherwise.
12627
12628.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12629.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12630.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12631When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12632connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12633example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12634received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12635&$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12636non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12637
12638The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12639but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12640becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12641
12642.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12643.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12644This variable is
12645cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12646and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12647&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12648details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12649
12650.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12651.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12652When a message is received from a remote client connection
12653the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12654.code
126550 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
126561 No response to request
126572 Response not verified
126583 Verification failed
126594 Verification succeeded
12660.endd
12661
12662.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12663.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12664When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12665the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12666See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12667
12668.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12669.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12670.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12671When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12672connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12673the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12674&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12675If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12676which is not the leaf.
12677
12678The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12679except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12680the outbound.
12681
12682.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12683.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12684When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12685connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12686the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12687&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12688If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12689which is not the leaf.
12690
12691.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12692.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12693.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12694.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12695When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12696Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12697If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12698some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12699will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12700a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12701used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12702
12703The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12704except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12705the outbound.
12706
12707.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12708.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12709.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12710During outbound
12711SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12712the transport.
12713
12714.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12715.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12716The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12717files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12718
12719.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12720.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12721The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12722
12723.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12724.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12725The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12726
12727.vitem &$tod_full$&
12728.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12729A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12730+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12731positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12732values for those that are behind (west).
12733
12734.vitem &$tod_log$&
12735.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12736The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
127371995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12738
12739.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12740.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12741This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12742is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12743flag.
12744
12745.vitem &$tod_zone$&
12746.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12747This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12748-0500.
12749
12750.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12751.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12752This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12753by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12754
12755.vitem &$transport_name$&
12756.cindex "transport" "name"
12757.cindex "name" "of transport"
12758.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12759During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12760
12761.vitem &$value$&
12762.vindex "&$value$&"
12763This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12764or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12765&*reduce*& expansion.
12766
12767.vitem &$verify_mode$&
12768.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12769While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12770or for cutthrough delivery,
12771contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12772Otherwise, empty.
12773
12774.vitem &$version_number$&
12775.vindex "&$version_number$&"
12776The version number of Exim.
12777
12778.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12779.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12780This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12781delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12782
12783.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12784.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12785This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12786delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12787.endlist
12788.ecindex IIDstrexp
12789
12790
12791
12792. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12793. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12794
12795.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12796.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12797Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12798Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12799use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12800your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12801the line
12802.code
12803EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12804.endd
12805in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12806
12807
12808.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12809.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12810Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12811&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12812no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12813interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12814the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12815option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12816a newly created Perl interpreter.
12817
12818The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12819need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12820should usually be something like
12821.code
12822perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12823.endd
12824where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12825use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12826soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12827the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12828its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12829fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12830necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12831the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12832two ways:
12833
12834.ilist
12835.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12836Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12837a startup when Exim is entered.
12838.next
12839The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12840overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12841.endlist
12842
12843There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12844initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12845
12846
12847.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12848When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12849of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12850by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12851forms:
12852.code
12853${perl{foo}}
12854${perl{foo}{argument}}
12855${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12856.endd
12857which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12858arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12859with an error message of the form
12860.code
12861Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12862.endd
12863The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12864it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12865return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12866an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12867by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12868that was passed to &%die%&.
12869
12870
12871.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12872Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12873is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12874the Perl code
12875.code
12876my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12877.endd
12878makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12879Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12880&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12881
12882If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12883&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12884expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12885an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12886
12887.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12888.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12889Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12890&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12891debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12892&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12893timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12894
12895
12896.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12897.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12898You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12899Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12900before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12901SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12902is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12903error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12904avoided, but the output is lost.
12905
12906.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12907The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12908Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12909you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12910output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12911change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12912For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12913.code
12914$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12915.endd
12916Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12917example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12918include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12919as the first subroutine argument.
12920.ecindex IIDperl
12921
12922
12923. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12924. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12925
12926.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12927 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12928 "Starting the daemon"
12929.cindex "daemon" "starting"
12930.cindex "interface" "listening"
12931.cindex "network interface"
12932.cindex "interface" "network"
12933.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12934.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12935.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12936.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12937A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12938hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12939or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12940works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12941In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12942IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12943knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12944
12945.olist
12946When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12947and ports to listen on.
12948.next
12949When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12950are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12951processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12952same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12953when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12954local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12955option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12956as an error situation.
12957.next
12958When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12959for the outgoing connection.
12960.endlist
12961
12962
12963Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12964of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12965addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12966standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12967rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12968
12969In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12970interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12971options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12972chapter describes how they operate.
12973
12974When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12975actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12976
12977
12978
12979.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12980When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12981option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12982following options:
12983
12984.ilist
12985&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12986or service names.
12987(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12988.next
12989&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12990listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12991.endlist
12992
12993The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12994described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12995it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12996colons. For example:
12997.code
12998local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12999 192.168.23.65 ; \
13000 ::1 ; \
13001 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13002.endd
13003There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13004in &%local_interfaces%&:
13005
13006.olist
13007The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13008on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13009.code
13010local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13011 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13012.endd
13013.next
13014The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13015with a colon separator, for example:
13016.code
13017local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13018 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13019.endd
13020.endlist
13021
13022When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13023default setting contains just one port:
13024.code
13025daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13026.endd
13027If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13028specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13029&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13030&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13031IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13032
13033
13034
13035.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13036The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13037as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13038case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13039instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13040default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13041.code
13042local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13043.endd
13044when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13045.code
13046local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13047.endd
13048Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13049
13050
13051
13052.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13053The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13054&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13055instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13056option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13057the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13058exim.
13059
13060The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13061changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13062contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13063&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13064items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13065replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13066.code
13067-oX 1225
13068.endd
13069overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13070whereas
13071.code
13072-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13073.endd
13074overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13075(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13076value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13077
13078
13079
13080.section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13081.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13082.cindex "smtps protocol"
13083.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13084.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13085Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13086before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13087still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13088list of port numbers or service names,
13089connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13090common use of this option is expected to be
13091.code
13092tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13093.endd
13094because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13095a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13096this way when a daemon is started.
13097
13098&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13099daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13100&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13101because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13102connections via the daemon.)
13103
13104
13105
13106
13107.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13108.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13109IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13110can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13111interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13112address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13113percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13114adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13115.code
13116fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13117.endd
13118To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13119allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13120to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13121percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13122address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13123&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13124.code
13125IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13126.endd
13127is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13128Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13129instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13130function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13131&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13132
13133.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13134.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13135Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13136run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13137using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13138connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13139.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13140&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13141activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13142that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13143etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13144to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13145
13146On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13147disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13148option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13149and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13150IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13151
13152
13153
13154.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13155The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13156.code
13157daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13158local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13159.endd
13160This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13161Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13162the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13163read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13164
13165To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13166.code
13167daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13168.endd
13169(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13170.code
13171local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13172 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13173.endd
13174To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13175IPv4 loopback address only:
13176.code
13177local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13178.endd
13179To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13180.code
13181local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13182.endd
13183&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13184
13185
13186
13187.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13188The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13189whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13190addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13191treated as local.
13192
13193For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13194the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13195available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13196(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13197
13198Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13199many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13200email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13201interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13202&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13203&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13204used for listening. Consider this example:
13205.code
13206local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13207 192.168.53.235 ; \
13208 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13209
13210extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13211.endd
13212The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13213address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13214Exim is routing.
13215
13216In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13217address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13218desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13219these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13220This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13221during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13222host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13223addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13224
13225
13226
13227.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13228Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13229allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13230there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13231&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13232description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13233details.
13234
13235
13236
13237
13238. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13239. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13240
13241.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13242.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13243.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13244The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13245
13246.ilist
13247Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13248&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13249.next
13250Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13251&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13252section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13253.next
13254Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13255(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13256&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13257only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13258settings.
13259.endlist
13260
13261This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13262types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13263in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13264are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13265an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13266listed in more than one group.
13267
13268.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13269.table2
13270.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13271.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13272.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13273.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13274.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13275.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13276.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13277.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13278.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13279.endtable
13280
13281
13282.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13283.table2
13284.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13285.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13286.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13287.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13288.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13289.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13290.endtable
13291
13292
13293
13294.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13295.table2
13296.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13297.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13298.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13299.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13300.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13301.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13302.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13303.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13304.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13305.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13306.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13307.endtable
13308
13309
13310
13311.section "Logging" "SECID99"
13312.table2
13313.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13314.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13315.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13316.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13317.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13318.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13319.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13320.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13321.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13322.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13323.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13324.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13325.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13326.endtable
13327
13328
13329
13330.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13331.table2
13332.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13333.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13334.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13335.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13336.endtable
13337
13338
13339
13340.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13341.table2
13342.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13343.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13344.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13345.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13346.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13347.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13348.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13349.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13350.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13351.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13352.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13353.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13354.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13355.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13356.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13357.endtable
13358
13359
13360
13361.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13362.table2
13363.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13364.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13365.endtable
13366
13367
13368
13369.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13370.table2
13371.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13372.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13373.endtable
13374
13375
13376
13377.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13378.table2
13379.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13380.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13381.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13382.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13383.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13384.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13385.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13386.endtable
13387
13388
13389
13390.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13391.table2
13392.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13393.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13394.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13395.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13396.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13397.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13398.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13399.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13400.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13401.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13402.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13403.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13404.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13405.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13406.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13407.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13408 connection"
13409.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13410.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13411.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13412.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13413.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13414.endtable
13415
13416
13417
13418.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13419.table2
13420.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13421.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13422.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13423.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13424.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13425.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13426.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13427.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13428.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13429.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13430.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13431.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13432.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13433.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13434.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13435.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13436.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13437.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13438.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13439.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13440.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13441.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13442 words""&"
13443.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13444.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13445.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13446.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13447.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13448.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13449.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13450.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13451.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13452.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13453.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13454.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13455.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13456.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13457.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13458.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13459.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13460.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13461.endtable
13462
13463
13464
13465.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13466.table2
13467.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13468 item"
13469.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13470 item"
13471.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13472.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13473.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13474.endtable
13475
13476
13477
13478.section "TLS" "SECID108"
13479.table2
13480.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13481.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13482.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13483.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13484.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13485.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13486.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13487.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13488.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13489.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13490.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13491.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13492.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13493.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13494.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13495.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13496.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13497.endtable
13498
13499
13500
13501.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13502.table2
13503.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13504.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13505.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13506.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13507.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13508.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13509.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13510.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13511.endtable
13512
13513
13514
13515.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13516.table2
13517.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13518.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13519.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13520.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13521.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13522.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13523.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13524.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13525.endtable
13526
13527
13528
13529
13530.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13531.table2
13532.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13533.endtable
13534
13535
13536
13537
13538
13539.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13540See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13541
13542.table2
13543.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13544.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13545.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13546.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13547.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13548.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13549.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13550.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13551.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13552.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13553.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13554.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13555.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13556.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13557.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13558 connection"
13559.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13560.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13561.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13562.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13563.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13564.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13565.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13566.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13567.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13568.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13569.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13570.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13571.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13572.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13573.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13574.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13575.endtable
13576
13577
13578
13579.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13580.table2
13581.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13582.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13583.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13584.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13585.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13586.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13587.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13588.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13589.endtable
13590
13591
13592
13593.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13594.table2
13595.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13596.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13597.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13598.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13599 words""&"
13600.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13601.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13602.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13603.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13604.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13605.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13606.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13607.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13608.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13609.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13610.endtable
13611
13612
13613
13614.section "System filter" "SECID115"
13615.table2
13616.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13617.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13618 directory"
13619.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13620.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13621.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13622.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13623.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13624.endtable
13625
13626
13627
13628.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13629.table2
13630.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13631.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13632.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13633.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13634.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13635.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13636.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13637.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13638.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13639.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13640.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13641.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13642.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13643.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13644.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13645.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13646.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13647.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13648.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13649.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13650.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13651.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13652.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13653.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13654.endtable
13655
13656
13657
13658.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13659.table2
13660.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13661.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13662.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13663.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13664.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13665.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13666.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13667.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13668.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13669.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13670.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13671.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13672.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13673.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13674.endtable
13675
13676
13677
13678.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13679Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13680&dagger;.
13681
13682.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13683.cindex "8BITMIME"
13684.cindex "8-bit characters"
13685.cindex "log" "selectors"
13686.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13687This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13688EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13689However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13690takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13691
13692Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13693feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13694It now defaults to true.
13695A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13696.display
13697&url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13698.endd
13699
13700To log received 8BITMIME status use
13701.code
13702log_selector = +8bitmime
13703.endd
13704
13705.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13706.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13707.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13708This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13709read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13710further details.
13711
13712.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13713This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13714messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13715SMTP messages.
13716
13717.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13718.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13719.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13720This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13721non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13722
13723.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13724.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13725.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13726This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13727received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13728
13729.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13730.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13731This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13732See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13733
13734.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13735.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13736This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13737processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13738acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13739
13740.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13741.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13742.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13743.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13744.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13745This option defines the ACL that,
13746if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13747is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13748processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13749acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13750
13751.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13752.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13753This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13754of a received message.
13755See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13756
13757.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13758.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13759This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13760received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13761
13762.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13763.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13764This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13765received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13766
13767.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13768.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13769.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13770This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13771command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13772
13773
13774.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13775.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13776This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13777received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13778
13779.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13780.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13781This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13782a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13783&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13784
13785.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13786.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13787This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13788extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13789section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13790
13791.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13792.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13793This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13794ends without a QUIT command being received.
13795See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13796
13797.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13798This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13799received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13800further details.
13801
13802.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13803.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13804This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13805received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13806
13807.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13808.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13809This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13810received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13811
13812.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13813.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13814This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13815received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13816
13817.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13818.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13819This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13820received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13821
13822.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13823.cindex "admin user"
13824This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13825current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13826colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13827programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13828admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13829not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13830To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13831
13832.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13833.cindex "domain literal"
13834If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13835email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13836format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13837has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13838
13839Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13840format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13841addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13842&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13843domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13844configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13845the local host's IP addresses.
13846
13847
13848.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13849.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13850It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13851and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13852MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13853that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13854practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13855&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13856recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13857
13858.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13859.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13860.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13861Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13862camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13863that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13864experiment if they wish.
13865
13866If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13867UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13868letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13869enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13870adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13871suitable setting is:
13872.code
13873dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13874 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13875.endd
13876Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13877.code
13878dns_check_names_pattern =
13879.endd
13880That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13881
13882
13883.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13884.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13885.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13886If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13887response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13888Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13889Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13890advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13891authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13892&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13893authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13894
13895Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13896and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13897not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13898authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13899to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13900which Exim advertises AUTH.
13901
13902.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13903If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13904is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13905option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13906.code
13907auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13908.endd
13909.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13910If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13911the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13912expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13913
13914
13915.option auto_thaw main time 0s
13916.cindex "thawing messages"
13917.cindex "unfreezing messages"
13918If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13919new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13920this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13921being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13922saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13923
13924&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13925&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13926thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13927
13928
13929.option av_scanner main string "see below"
13930This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13931It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13932.code
13933sophie:/var/run/sophie
13934.endd
13935If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13936before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13937
13938
13939.option bi_command main string unset
13940.oindex "&%-bi%&"
13941This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13942the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13943just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13944required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13945
13946
13947.option bounce_message_file main string unset
13948.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13949.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13950This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13951for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13952chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13953
13954
13955.option bounce_message_text main string unset
13956When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13957message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13958delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13959
13960.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13961.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13962This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13963bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13964causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13965value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13966message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13967error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13968point at which the error was detected are returned.
13969.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13970
13971.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13972If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13973bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13974&%bounce_return_body%&.
13975
13976
13977.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13978.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13979.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13980.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13981This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13982senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13983limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13984any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13985that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13986
13987When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13988greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13989added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13990to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13991size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13992messages.
13993
13994.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13995.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13996.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13997.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13998This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13999bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14000connection. A typical setting might be:
14001.code
14002bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14003.endd
14004which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14005.code
14006MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14007.endd
14008The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14009address.
14010
14011.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14012.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14013.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14014This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14015domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14016section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14017
14018
14019.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14020This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14021domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14022section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14023
14024
14025.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14026This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14027address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14028section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14029
14030
14031.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14032This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14033address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14034section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14035
14036
14037.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14038This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14039callout verification. The default value is
14040.code
14041$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14042.endd
14043See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14044
14045
14046.option check_log_inodes main integer 0
14047See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14048
14049
14050.option check_log_space main integer 0
14051See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14052
14053.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14054.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14055.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14056RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14057system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14058word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14059multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14060exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14061of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14062set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14063
14064
14065.option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14066See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14067
14068
14069.option check_spool_space main integer 0
14070.cindex "checking disk space"
14071.cindex "disk space, checking"
14072.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14073The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14074message is accepted.
14075
14076.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14077.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14078.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14079.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14080When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14081want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14082testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14083&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14084
14085
14086&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14087either value is greater than zero, for example:
14088.code
14089check_spool_space = 10M
14090check_spool_inodes = 100
14091.endd
14092The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14093SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14094transit.
14095
14096&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14097files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14098&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14099
14100If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14101incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14102error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14103SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14104&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14105&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14106
14107The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14108number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14109
14110For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14111failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14112it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14113
14114.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14115.cindex "port" "for daemon"
14116.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14117This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14118listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14119backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14120
14121.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14122.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14123This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14124the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14125(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14126defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14127&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14128
14129.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14130See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14131
14132.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14133.cindex "warning of delay"
14134.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14135When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14136intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14137after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14138string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14139message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14140between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14141with
14142.code
14143delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14144.endd
14145the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14146the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14147because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14148just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14149.code
14150delay_warning = 6h
14151.endd
14152messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14153a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14154.code
14155delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14156.endd
14157Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14158which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14159Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14160
14161.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14162.vindex "&$domain$&"
14163The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14164deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14165expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14166forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14167&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14168not sent. The default is:
14169.code
14170delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14171 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14172 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14173 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14174 } {no}{yes}}
14175.endd
14176This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14177&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14178&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14179&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14180
14181.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14182.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14183.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14184If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14185delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14186the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14187of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14188chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14189
14190.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14191.cindex "load average"
14192.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14193When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14194becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14195ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14196See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14197
14198
14199.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14200.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14201Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14202message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14203handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14204should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14205removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14206occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14207
14208.option disable_fsync main boolean false
14209.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14210This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14211ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14212a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14213build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14214really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14215distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14216
14217When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14218updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14219such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14220Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14221
14222
14223.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14224.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14225If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14226activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14227that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14228etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14229to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14230
14231
14232.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14233.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14234This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14235It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14236the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14237See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14238
14239
14240.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14241.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14242DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14243&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14244keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14245incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14246may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14247anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14248This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14249by a setting such as this:
14250.code
14251dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14252.endd
14253This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14254&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14255since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14256&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14257when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14258options are applied after this global option.
14259
14260.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14261.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14262When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14263names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14264the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14265contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14266a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14267done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14268value of this option. The default pattern is
14269.code
14270dns_check_names_pattern = \
14271 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14272.endd
14273which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14274they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14275permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14276accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14277&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14278empty string.
14279
14280.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14281This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14282DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14283
14284.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14285This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14286reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14287section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14288
14289
14290.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14291.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14292.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14293If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14294DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14295default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14296
14297If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14298
14299
14300.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14301.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14302.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14303When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14304looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14305(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14306domain matches this list.
14307
14308This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14309not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14310servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14311
14312
14313.option dns_retrans main time 0s
14314.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14315.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14316.cindex "DNS" timeout
14317The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14318retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14319defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14320time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14321totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14322take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14323parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14324but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14325to set in them.
14326See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14327
14328
14329.option dns_retry main integer 0
14330See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14331
14332
14333.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14334.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14335.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14336If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14337(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14338DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14339match with this expanded domain list.
14340
14341Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14342authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14343bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14344mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14345Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14346a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14347
14348Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14349to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14350zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14351
14352If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14353in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14354authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14355authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14356record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14357
14358.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14359.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14360.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14361.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14362If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14363DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14364the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14365on.
14366
14367If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14368
14369
14370.option drop_cr main boolean false
14371This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14372handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14373described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14374
14375.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14376.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14377.cindex "DSN" "success"
14378.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14379DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14380and accepted from, these hosts.
14381Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14382and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14383A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14384A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14385are sent.
14386
14387.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14388.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14389.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14390This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14391bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14392Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14393.code
14394dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14395.endd
14396The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14397panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14398
14399.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14400.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14401Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14402message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14403handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14404message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14405be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14406the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14407delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14408
14409
14410.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14411.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14412.cindex "copy of bounce message"
14413Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14414generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14415coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14416items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14417a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14418must be enclosed in double quotes.
14419
14420Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14421(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14422the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14423items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14424are examined. For example:
14425.code
14426errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14427 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14428 postmaster@mydomain.example
14429.endd
14430.vindex "&$domain$&"
14431.vindex "&$local_part$&"
14432The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14433and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14434there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14435.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14436variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14437
14438
14439.option errors_reply_to main string unset
14440.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14441By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14442.display
14443&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14444.endd
14445.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14446where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14447A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14448&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14449overrides the default.
14450
14451Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14452&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14453and warning messages. For example:
14454.code
14455errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14456.endd
14457The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14458address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14459&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14460own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14461not used.
14462
14463
14464.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14465.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14466.cindex "Exim group"
14467This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14468privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14469option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14470of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14471configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14472security issues.
14473
14474
14475.option exim_path main string "see below"
14476.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14477This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14478needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14479the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14480is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14481other place.
14482&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14483you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14484where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14485settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14486
14487
14488.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14489.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14490.cindex "Exim user"
14491This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14492privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14493time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14494options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14495
14496Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14497&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14498not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14499used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14500
14501
14502.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14503This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14504routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14505&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14506
14507
14508. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14509. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14510
14511.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
14512 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14513.oindex "&%-t%&"
14514.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14515.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14516According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14517are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14518envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14519line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14520behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14521command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14522&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14523argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14524addresses.
14525
14526
14527.option finduser_retries main integer 0
14528.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14529On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14530distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14531related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14532Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14533errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14534many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14535retries.
14536
14537.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14538You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14539a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14540search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14541
14542
14543
14544.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14545.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14546On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14547ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14548delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14549&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14550feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14551warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14552freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14553is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14554supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14555message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14556freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14557log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14558logging that you require.
14559
14560
14561.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14562.cindex "HP-UX"
14563.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14564Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14565password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14566looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14567headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14568of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14569it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14570upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14571
14572When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14573expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14574login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14575user's name.
14576
14577.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14578Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14579pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14580name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14581.code
14582gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14583gecos_name = $1
14584.endd
14585
14586.option gecos_pattern main string unset
14587See &%gecos_name%& above.
14588
14589
14590.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14591This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14592server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14593implementations of TLS.
14594
14595
14596option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14597This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14598the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14599
14600See
14601&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14602for documentation.
14603
14604
14605
14606.option headers_charset main string "see below"
14607This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14608&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14609default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14610ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14611insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14612
14613
14614
14615.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14616.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14617.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14618This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14619section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14620&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14621sections are rejected.
14622
14623
14624.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14625.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14626.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14627This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14628all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14629header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14630zero means &"no limit"&.
14631
14632
14633
14634
14635.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14636.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14637.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14638Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14639mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14640some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14641this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14642if you want to do semantic checking.
14643See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14644set.
14645
14646
14647.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14648.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14649.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14650.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14651This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14652all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14653hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14654.code
14655helo_allow_chars = _
14656.endd
14657Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14658
14659
14660.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14661.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14662.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14663If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14664list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14665default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14666its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14667do.
14668
14669
14670.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14671.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14672.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14673By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14674&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14675to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14676condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14677Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14678to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14679necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14680encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14681Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14682
14683When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14684&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14685EHLO command either:
14686
14687.ilist
14688is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14689.next
14690.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14691.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14692matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14693calling host address, or
14694.next
14695when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14696.endlist
14697
14698However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14699fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14700be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14701
14702If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14703.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14704&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14705
14706.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14707.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14708.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14709Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14710backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14711name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14712&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14713rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14714If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14715error.
14716
14717.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14718.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14719.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14720This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14721manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14722&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14723verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14724item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14725it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14726
14727This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14728delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14729configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14730domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14731&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14732
14733A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14734messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14735time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14736retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14737
14738
14739.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14740.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14741Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14742is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14743&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14744option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14745default configuration file contains
14746.code
14747host_lookup = *
14748.endd
14749which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14750is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14751
14752After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14753has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14754this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14755
14756.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14757.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14758After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14759unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14760&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14761&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14762
14763
14764.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14765This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14766to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14767first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14768if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14769if you want.
14770
14771&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14772multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14773&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14774case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14775
14776
14777
14778.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14779.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14780If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14781as soon as the connection is made.
14782This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14783nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14784connections immediately.
14785
14786The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14787ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14788sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14789incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14790chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14791
14792
14793.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14794.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14795This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14796happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14797you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14798127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14799the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14800list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14801local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14802.code
14803hosts_connection_nolog = :
14804.endd
14805If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14806
14807
14808
14809.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14810.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14811.cindex "host" "treated as local"
14812If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14813if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14814records
14815or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14816host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14817
14818This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14819&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14820section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14821&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14822that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14823chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14824interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14825
14826
14827.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14828.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14829This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14830to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14831The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14832
14833
14834
14835.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14836.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14837.cindex "discarding bounce message"
14838This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14839that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14840suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14841
14842After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14843because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14844message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14845the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14846again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14847bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14848for frozen messages. For example,
14849.code
14850ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14851.endd
14852retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14853failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14854failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14855value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14856dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14857&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14858
14859
14860.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14861.cindex "&""From""& line"
14862.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14863Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14864the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14865message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14866such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14867match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14868process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14869&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14870
14871
14872.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14873See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14874
14875
14876.option keep_malformed main time 4d
14877This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14878have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14879next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14880logged.
14881
14882
14883.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14884.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14885This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14886a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14887While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14888Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14889and constrained to be a directory.
14890
14891
14892.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14893.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14894This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14895a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14896While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14897Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14898and constrained to be a file.
14899
14900
14901.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14902.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14903This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14904Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14905Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14906
14907
14908.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14909.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14910This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14911to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14912Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14913identity to be proven.
14914
14915
14916.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14917.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14918This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14919the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14920cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14921
14922
14923.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14924.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14925This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14926LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14927details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14928with LDAP support.
14929
14930
14931.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14932.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14933This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14934A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14935See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14936Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14937to hard/demand.
14938
14939
14940.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14941.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14942If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14943connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14944"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14945of SSL-on-connect.
14946In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14947by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14948
14949
14950.option ldap_version main integer unset
14951.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14952This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14953LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14954-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14955the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14956has been built with LDAP support.
14957
14958
14959
14960.option local_from_check main boolean true
14961.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14962.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14963When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14964an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14965checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14966the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14967
14968&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14969locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14970&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14971
14972You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14973on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14974&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14975and the default qualify domain.
14976
14977If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14978and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14979&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14980&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14981
14982.cindex "envelope sender"
14983These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14984is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14985&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14986
14987For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14988request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14989has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14990
14991
14992
14993
14994.option local_from_prefix main string unset
14995When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14996matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14997ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14998done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14999appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15000&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15001example, if
15002.code
15003local_from_prefix = *-
15004.endd
15005is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15006.code
15007From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15008.endd
15009will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15010matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15011qualify domain.
15012
15013
15014.option local_from_suffix main string unset
15015See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15016
15017
15018.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15019This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15020listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15021&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15022options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15023&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15024&%local_interfaces%& is
15025.code
15026local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15027.endd
15028when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15029.code
15030local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15031.endd
15032
15033.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15034.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15035.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15036This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15037&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15038the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15039message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15040non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15041
15042
15043
15044.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15045.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15046When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15047an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15048do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15049also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15050See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15051&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15052
15053
15054
15055
15056.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15057.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15058.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15059.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15060Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15061uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15062value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15063after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15064host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15065range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15066systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15067&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15068characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15069time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15070section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15071
15072
15073
15074.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15075.cindex "log" "file path for"
15076This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15077files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15078when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15079name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15080or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15081they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15082Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15083section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15084used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15085variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15086configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15087&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15088early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15089
15090
15091.option log_selector main string unset
15092.cindex "log" "selectors"
15093This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15094writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15095minus characters. For example:
15096.code
15097log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15098.endd
15099A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15100logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15101
15102
15103.option log_timezone main boolean false
15104.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15105.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15106.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15107By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15108timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15109in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15110avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15111&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15112timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15113of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15114&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15115another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15116
15117
15118.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15119.cindex "too many open files"
15120.cindex "open files, too many"
15121.cindex "file" "too many open"
15122.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15123.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15124This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15125lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15126Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15127file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15128recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15129actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15130as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15131open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15132&%lookup_open_max%&.
15133
15134
15135.option max_username_length main integer 0
15136.cindex "length of login name"
15137.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15138.cindex "limit" "user name length"
15139Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15140&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15141this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15142an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15143
15144
15145.option message_body_newlines main bool false
15146.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15147.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15148.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15149.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15150By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15151the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15152option is set true, this no longer happens.
15153
15154
15155.option message_body_visible main integer 500
15156.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15157.cindex "message body" "visible size"
15158.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15159.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15160This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15161&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15162
15163
15164.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15165.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15166If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15167(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15168locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15169means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15170Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15171Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15172replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15173empty string, the option is ignored.
15174
15175
15176.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15177If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15178the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15179message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15180take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15181the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15182it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15183yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15184before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15185that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15186means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15187colons will become hyphens.
15188
15189
15190.option message_logs main boolean true
15191.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15192.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15193If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15194&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15195Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15196minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15197per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15198which is not affected by this option.
15199
15200
15201.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15202.cindex "message" "size limit"
15203.cindex "limit" "message size"
15204.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15205This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15206value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15207to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15208TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15209optionally followed by K or M.
15210
15211&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15212other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15213the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15214error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15215&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15216
15217Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15218exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15219failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15220an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15221the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15222message that an individual transport can process.
15223
15224If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15225maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15226failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15227virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15228probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15229default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15230some problems may result.
15231
15232A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15233SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15234SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15235
15236
15237.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15238.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15239This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15240.code
15241SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15242.endd
15243in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15244moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15245and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15246standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15247lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15248
15249
15250.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15251Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15252it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15253contains a full description of this facility.
15254
15255
15256
15257.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15258.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15259This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15260be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15261option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15262
15263
15264.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15265This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15266message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15267recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15268It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15269safety precaution.
15270
15271When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15272list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15273the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15274contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15275can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15276
15277If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15278&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15279example is
15280.code
15281never_users = root:daemon:bin
15282.endd
15283Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15284harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15285transport driver.
15286
15287
15288.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15289.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15290This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15291by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15292each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15293
15294This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15295available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15296The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15297the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15298list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15299&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15300names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15301
15302Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15303SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15304yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15305adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15306invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15307
15308The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15309
15310Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15311"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15312with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15313some now infamous attacks.
15314
15315Examples:
15316.code
15317# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15318openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15319 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15320
15321# Disable older protocol versions:
15322openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15323.endd
15324
15325Possible options may include:
15326.ilist
15327&`all`&
15328.next
15329&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15330.next
15331&`cipher_server_preference`&
15332.next
15333&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15334.next
15335&`ephemeral_rsa`&
15336.next
15337&`legacy_server_connect`&
15338.next
15339&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15340.next
15341&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15342.next
15343&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15344.next
15345&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15346.next
15347&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15348.next
15349&`no_compression`&
15350.next
15351&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15352.next
15353&`no_sslv2`&
15354.next
15355&`no_sslv3`&
15356.next
15357&`no_ticket`&
15358.next
15359&`no_tlsv1`&
15360.next
15361&`no_tlsv1_1`&
15362.next
15363&`no_tlsv1_2`&
15364.next
15365&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15366.next
15367&`single_dh_use`&
15368.next
15369&`single_ecdh_use`&
15370.next
15371&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15372.next
15373&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15374.next
15375&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15376.next
15377&`tls_d5_bug`&
15378.next
15379&`tls_rollback_bug`&
15380.endlist
15381
15382As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15383all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15384to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15385to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15386release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15387where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15388
15389
15390.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15391.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15392This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15393to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15394The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15395
15396
15397.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15398.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15399.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15400.cindex "address" "source-routed"
15401The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15402percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15403replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15404also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15405option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15406but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15407an ACL.
15408
15409&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15410trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15411if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15412implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15413routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15414a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15415local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15416
15417
15418.option perl_at_start main boolean false
15419This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15420interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15421
15422
15423.option perl_startup main string unset
15424This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15425interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15426
15427
15428.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15429.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15430This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15431data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15432&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15433PostgreSQL support.
15434
15435
15436.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15437.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15438.cindex "pid file, path for"
15439This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15440process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15441to the host name:
15442.code
15443pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15444.endd
15445If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15446spool directory.
15447The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15448option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15449of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15450
15451
15452.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15453.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15454This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15455PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15456control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15457&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15458for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15459that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15460not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15461
15462
15463.option prdr_enable main boolean false
15464.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15465This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15466to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15467If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15468If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15469an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15470is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15471
15472.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15473.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15474If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15475completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15476called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15477purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15478volume of mail. Use with care!
15479
15480
15481.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15482.cindex "name" "of local host"
15483.cindex "host" "name of local"
15484.cindex "local host" "name of"
15485.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15486This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15487HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15488option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15489The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15490server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15491
15492If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15493name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15494contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15495&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15496version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15497explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15498
15499
15500.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15501.cindex "printing characters"
15502.cindex "8-bit characters"
15503By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1550432&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15505when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15506sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15507is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15508characters.
15509
15510This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15511&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15512the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15513described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15514Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15515standards.
15516
15517
15518.option process_log_path main string unset
15519.cindex "process log path"
15520.cindex "log" "process log"
15521.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15522This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15523&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15524utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15525in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15526can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15527different spool directories.
15528
15529
15530.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15531.oindex "&%-M%&"
15532.oindex "&%-R%&"
15533.oindex "&%-q%&"
15534The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15535admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15536&%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15537
15538
15539.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15540.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15541.cindex "address" "qualification"
15542This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15543addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15544recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15545are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15546also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15547locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15548
15549Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15550unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15551&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15552addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15553necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15554addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15555&%primary_hostname%& value.
15556
15557
15558.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15559This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15560addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15561
15562
15563
15564.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15565.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15566.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15567.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15568This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15569A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15570domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15571next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15572
15573
15574.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15575.oindex "&%-bp%&"
15576The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15577queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15578&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15579
15580
15581.option queue_only main boolean false
15582.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15583.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15584If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15585whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15586next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15587delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15588
15589The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15590and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15591&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15592&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15593
15594
15595.option queue_only_file main string unset
15596.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15597.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15598This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15599one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15600it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15601each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15602For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15603&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15604.code
15605queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15606.endd
15607causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15608&_/some/file_& exists.
15609
15610
15611.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15612.cindex "load average"
15613.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15614.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15615If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15616all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15617happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15618the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15619the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15620false.
15621
15622Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15623option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15624determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15625&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15626
15627
15628.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15629.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15630When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15631because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15632all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15633This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15634threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15635connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15636circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15637where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15638should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15639re-evaluated for each message.
15640
15641
15642.option queue_only_override main boolean true
15643.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15644When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15645setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15646&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15647to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15648
15649
15650.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15651.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15652If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15653in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15654must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15655single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15656and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15657single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15658the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15659avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15660&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15661when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15662large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15663
15664
15665
15666.option queue_run_max main integer 5
15667.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15668This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15669can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15670but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15671start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15672very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15673however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15674started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15675
15676Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15677the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15678run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15679the daemon's command line.
15680
15681.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15682.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15683.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15684When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15685received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15686However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15687&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15688message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15689has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15690when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15691over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15692SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15693&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15694&%queue_domains%&.
15695
15696
15697.option receive_timeout main time 0s
15698.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15699This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15700maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15701the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15702&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15703controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15704
15705.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15706.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15707.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15708This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15709added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15710on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15711used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15712added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15713&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15714header lines. The default setting is:
15715
15716.code
15717received_header_text = Received: \
15718 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15719 {${if def:sender_ident \
15720 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15721 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15722 by $primary_hostname \
15723 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15724 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15725 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15726 ${if def:sender_address \
15727 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15728 id $message_exim_id\
15729 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15730.endd
15731
15732The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15733support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15734locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15735header lines such as the following:
15736.code
15737Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15738by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15739(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15740id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15741for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15742Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15743id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15744.endd
15745Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15746the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15747checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15748message was accepted.
15749
15750
15751.option received_headers_max main integer 30
15752.cindex "loop" "prevention"
15753.cindex "mail loop prevention"
15754.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15755When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15756counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15757have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15758This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15759
15760
15761.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15762.cindex "unqualified addresses"
15763.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15764This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15765recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15766qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15767affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15768addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15769host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15770or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15771option was not set.
15772
15773
15774.option recipients_max main integer 0
15775.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15776.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15777If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15778original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15779by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15780all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15781Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15782done.
15783
15784.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15785&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15786RCPT commands in a single message.
15787
15788
15789.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15790If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15791recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15792error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15793error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15794initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15795for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15796
15797
15798.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15799.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15800This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15801hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15802does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15803message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15804have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15805deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15806deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15807each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15808same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15809&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15810with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15811tagged with its process id.
15812
15813This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15814message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15815manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15816deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15817is received.
15818
15819.cindex "number of deliveries"
15820.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15821If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15822need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15823are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15824daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15825fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15826runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15827delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15828then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15829&%remote_max_parallel%&.
15830
15831If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15832&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15833doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15834host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15835
15836
15837.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15838.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15839.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15840When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15841domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15842.code
15843remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15844.endd
15845would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15846then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15847
15848
15849.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15850.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15851This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15852database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15853host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15854past failures.
15855
15856
15857.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15858.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15859.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15860Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15861intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15862straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15863retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15864the default value.
15865
15866
15867.option return_path_remove main boolean true
15868.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15869RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15870&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15871The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15872MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15873in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15874&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15875received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15876the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15877
15878
15879.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15880This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15881
15882
15883.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15884.cindex "RFC 1413"
15885.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15886RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15887an item in the list.
15888The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15889for the system.
15890
15891.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15892.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15893.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15894This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15895no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15896
15897
15898.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15899.cindex "unqualified addresses"
15900.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15901This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15902sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15903&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15904not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15905it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15906&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15907using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15908
15909
15910.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15911.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15912.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15913This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15914If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15915and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15916Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15917
15918
15919
15920.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15921.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15922This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15923TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15924connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15925other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15926still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15927this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15928connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15929tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15930hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15931
15932
15933
15934.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15935.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15936.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15937.cindex "inetd"
15938This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15939that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15940control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15941value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15942non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15943set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15944
15945A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15946has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15947that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15948and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15949
15950
15951.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15952.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15953.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15954Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15955the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15956check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15957client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15958client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15959
15960When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15961allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15962but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15963or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15964starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15965counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15966following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15967MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15968
15969
15970.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15971You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15972check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15973changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15974live with.
15975
15976
15977. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15978. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15979. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15980. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15981. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15982. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15983. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15984. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15985. the option name to split.
15986
15987.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15988 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15989.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15990.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15991The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15992prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15993results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15994response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15995precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15996seen).
15997
15998
15999.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16000.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16001.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16002This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16003host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16004expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16005reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16006connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16007is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16008of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16009required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16010
16011&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16012constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16013happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16014without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16015could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16016doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16017
16018
16019
16020.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16021.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16022.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16023.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16024If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16025listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16026on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16027fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16028subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16029to all messages received in the same connection.
16030
16031A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16032if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16033also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16034various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16035
16036
16037. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16038
16039.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16040 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16041.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16042.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16043This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16044automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16045the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16046and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16047number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16048are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16049restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16050systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16051dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16052
16053
16054.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16055.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16056.cindex "host" "reserved"
16057When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16058number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16059that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16060&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16061restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16062of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16063of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16064the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16065individual host.
16066
16067For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16068set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16069connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16070provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16071
16072
16073.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16074.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16075.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16076.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16077This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16078several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16079is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16080responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16081incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16082
16083.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16084The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16085is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16086in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16087
16088If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16089expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16090used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16091panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16092value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16093For example:
16094.code
16095smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16096 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16097.endd
16098
16099Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16100messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16101verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16102&%helo_data%& value.
16103
16104.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16105.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16106.cindex "banner for SMTP"
16107.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16108.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16109This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16110positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16111.code
16112smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16113 $version_number $tod_full
16114.endd
16115Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16116multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16117appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16118in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16119multiline response).
16120
16121
16122.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16123.cindex "checking disk space"
16124.cindex "disk space, checking"
16125.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16126When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16127option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16128spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16129leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16130is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16131
16132
16133.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16134.cindex "connection backlog"
16135.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16136.cindex "backlog of connections"
16137This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16138this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16139of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16140attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16141say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16142out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16143value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16144attacks by SYN flooding.
16145
16146
16147.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16148.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16149.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16150The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16151the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16152synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16153fewer, but they still exist.
16154
16155Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16156for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16157client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16158SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16159for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16160input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16161does detect many instances.
16162
16163The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16164If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16165hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16166(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16167
16168
16169
16170.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16171.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16172.vindex "&$domain$&"
16173If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16174command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16175chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16176are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16177argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16178example:
16179.code
16180smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16181 $sender_host_address
16182.endd
16183A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16184complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16185run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16186a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16187receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16188the command.
16189
16190
16191.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16192.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16193When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16194one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16195section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16196
16197
16198.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16199.cindex "load average"
16200If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16201accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16202If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16203the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16204systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16205&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16206
16207
16208
16209.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16210.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16211.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16212Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16213particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16214.code
16215RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16216.endd
16217causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16218(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16219example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16220too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16221dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16222
16223.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16224When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16225&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16226Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16227&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16228not count towards the limit.
16229
16230
16231
16232.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16233.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16234.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16235If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16236Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16237that subvert web
16238clients
16239into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16240non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16241
16242
16243
16244.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16245.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16246.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16247.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16248Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16249can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16250recipients.
16251
16252Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16253facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16254&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16255&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16256
16257When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16258&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16259rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16260respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16261values:
16262
16263.ilist
16264A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16265.next
16266An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16267fractional parts are allowed here.
16268.next
16269A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16270.next
16271A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16272because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16273.endlist
16274
16275For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16276first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16277.code
16278smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16279smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16280.endd
16281The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16282two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16283seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16284delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16285
16286
16287.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16288See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16289
16290
16291.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16292See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16293
16294
16295.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16296.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16297.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16298This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16299input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16300data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16301the message is abandoned.
16302A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16303.code
16304SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16305SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16306.endd
16307The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16308means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16309
16310If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16311expanded before use and may depend on
16312&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16313
16314
16315.oindex "&%-os%&"
16316The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16317&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16318this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16319of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16320timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16321
16322
16323.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16324This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16325&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16326
16327
16328.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16329.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16330.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16331In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16332&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16333reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16334to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16335policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16336&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16337example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16338.code
16339550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16340550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16341.endd
16342
16343.option spamd_address main string "see below"
16344This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16345extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16346The default value is
16347.code
16348127.0.0.1 783
16349.endd
16350See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16351
16352
16353
16354.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16355.cindex "multiple spool directories"
16356.cindex "spool directory" "split"
16357.cindex "directories, multiple"
16358If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16359subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16360sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16361subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16362arrival of the message.
16363
16364Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16365where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16366directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16367directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16368are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16369
16370It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16371changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16372&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16373after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16374automatically deleted.
16375
16376When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16377changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16378trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16379sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16380sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16381spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16382particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16383if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16384entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16385
16386
16387.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16388.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16389This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16390it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16391configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16392string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16393&$primary_hostname$&.
16394
16395If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16396that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16397log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16398Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16399as failures in the configuration file.
16400
16401By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16402tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16403
16404.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16405.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16406This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16407access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16408
16409.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16410.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16411This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16412variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16413is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16414&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16415
16416.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16417.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16418If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16419items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16420treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16421passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16422option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16423
16424
16425.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16426.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16427.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16428If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16429ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16430MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16431domain causes a syntax error.
16432However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16433syntax checking.
16434
16435
16436.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16437.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16438When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16439separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16440be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16441separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16442nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16443particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16444both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16445containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16446Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16447the LOG_ALERT priority.
16448
16449
16450.option syslog_facility main string unset
16451.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16452This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16453syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16454&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16455If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16456details of Exim's logging.
16457
16458
16459
16460.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16461.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16462This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16463syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16464&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16465
16466
16467
16468.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16469.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16470If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16471omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16472details of Exim's logging.
16473
16474
16475.option system_filter main string&!! unset
16476.cindex "filter" "system filter"
16477.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16478.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16479This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16480the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16481must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16482generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16483appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16484which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16485&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16486
16487
16488.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16489.vindex "&$address_file$&"
16490This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16491&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16492implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16493During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16494
16495
16496.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16497.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16498This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16499command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16500the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16501
16502.option system_filter_group main string unset
16503.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16504This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16505gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16506with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16507
16508.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16509.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16510.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16511This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16512is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16513contains the pipe command.
16514
16515
16516.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16517.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16518This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16519is used in a system filter.
16520
16521
16522.option system_filter_user main string unset
16523.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16524If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16525delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16526process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16527Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16528is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16529configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16530specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16531&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16532
16533If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16534under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16535transport option overrides.
16536
16537
16538.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16539.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16540.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16541.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16542If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16543TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16544turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16545performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16546should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16547However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16548this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16549daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16550TCP_NODELAY.
16551
16552
16553.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16554.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16555.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16556If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16557message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16558is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16559bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16560sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16561If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16562frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16563
16564&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16565frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16566messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16567
16568
16569.option timezone main string unset
16570.cindex "timezone, setting"
16571The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16572running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16573created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16574to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16575.code
16576timezone = UTC
16577.endd
16578The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16579or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16580is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16581time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16582runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16583unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16584
16585
16586.new
16587.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16588.wen
16589.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16590.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16591.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16592When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16593of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16594response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16595chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16596.new
16597Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
16598using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If no certificate is available then
16599the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
16600.wen
16601
16602
16603.option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16604.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16605.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16606The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16607file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16608assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16609&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16610
16611&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16612receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16613use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16614option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16615
16616If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16617if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16618Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16619&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16620
16621.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16622.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16623.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16624This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16625be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16626
16627See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16628
16629
16630.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16631.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16632The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16633the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16634interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16635suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16636
16637The value must be at least 1024.
16638
16639The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16640hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16641by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16642
16643If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16644number.
16645
16646Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16647little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16648larger prime than requested.
16649
16650
16651.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16652.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16653The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16654to be used by Exim.
16655
16656If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16657parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16658PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16659OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16660fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16661loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16662and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16663
16664If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16665loaded by Exim.
16666
16667If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16668Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16669does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16670See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16671
16672If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16673a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
166742.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16675in IKE is assigned number 23.
16676
16677Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16678of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16679"ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16680"ike23".
16681
16682The available primes are:
16683&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16684&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16685&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16686
16687Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16688Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16689
16690The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16691to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16692whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16693tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16694need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16695userbase.
16696
16697Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16698is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16699applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16700used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16701mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16702prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16703acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16704
16705
16706.option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16707.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16708If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16709this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16710
16711Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16712For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16713are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16714which tell the library to choose.
16715
16716If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16717
16718
16719.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16720.cindex TLS "certificate status"
16721.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16722This option
16723must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16724status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16725Certificate Authority.
16726
16727.new
16728Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
16729.wen
16730
16731
16732.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16733.cindex SSMTP
16734.cindex SMTPS
16735This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16736operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16737set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16738further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16739
16740
16741
16742.option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16743.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16744The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16745file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16746the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16747key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16748&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16749
16750See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16751
16752
16753.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16754.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16755.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16756If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16757&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16758support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16759TLS session.
16760
16761
16762.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16763.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16764.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16765This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16766The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16767connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16768different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16769permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16770in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16771preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16772&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16773
16774
16775.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16776.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16777.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16778See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16779
16780
16781.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16782.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16783.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16784The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16785word "system"
16786or the absolute path to
16787a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16788match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16789
16790The "system" value for the option will use a
16791system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16792This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16793and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16794must be specified.
16795
16796The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
16797preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16798
16799With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16800explicitly
16801either by file or directory
16802are added to those given by the system default location.
16803
16804These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16805than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16806the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16807connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16808Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16809use the explicit directory version.
16810
16811See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16812
16813A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16814being unset.
16815
16816
16817.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16818.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16819.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16820This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16821certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16822&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16823either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16824&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16825
16826Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16827&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16828present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16829aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16830the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16831connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16832ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16833
16834A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16835matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16836certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16837abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16838state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16839such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16840but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16841certificate"&.
16842
16843Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16844certificates.
16845
16846
16847.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16848.cindex "trusted groups"
16849.cindex "groups" "trusted"
16850This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16851option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16852which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16853specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16854details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16855&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16856are trusted.
16857
16858.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16859.cindex "trusted users"
16860.cindex "user" "trusted"
16861This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16862option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16863trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16864&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16865If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16866Exim user are trusted.
16867
16868.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16869.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16870.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16871This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16872the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16873gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16874used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16875can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16876is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16877&%-F%& option.
16878
16879.option unknown_username main string unset
16880See &%unknown_login%&.
16881
16882.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16883.cindex "trusted users"
16884.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16885.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16886.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16887.cindex "envelope sender"
16888When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16889normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16890default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16891senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16892is used) is ignored.
16893
16894However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16895to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16896.code
16897exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16898.endd
16899.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16900The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16901other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16902users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16903patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16904identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16905users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16906followed by a hyphen
16907by a setting like this:
16908.code
16909untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16910.endd
16911If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16912restriction, you can use
16913.code
16914untrusted_set_sender = *
16915.endd
16916The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16917only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16918to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16919parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16920&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16921necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16922overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16923described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16924
16925The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16926&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16927&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16928envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16929sender address.
16930
16931
16932.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16933.cindex "&""From""& line"
16934.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16935Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16936an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16937particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16938of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16939matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16940&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16941default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16942.code
16943From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16944From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16945.endd
16946The pattern can be seen by running
16947.code
16948exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16949.endd
16950It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16951year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16952regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16953&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16954(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16955&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16956
16957
16958.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16959See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16960
16961
16962.option warn_message_file main string unset
16963.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16964.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16965This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16966for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16967been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16968&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16969&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16970
16971
16972.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16973.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16974If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16975See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16976.ecindex IIDconfima
16977.ecindex IIDmaiconf
16978
16979
16980
16981
16982. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16983. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16984
16985.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16986.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16987.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16988This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16989Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16990
16991For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16992&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16993which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16994provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16995&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16996
16997
16998
16999.option address_data routers string&!! unset
17000.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17001The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17002precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17003router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17004&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17005delivery of the address to be deferred.
17006
17007.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17008When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17009accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17010routers, and the eventual transport.
17011
17012&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17013that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17014in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17015either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17016put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17017
17018Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17019with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17020on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17021&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17022&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17023
17024The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17025for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17026you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17027.code
17028uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17029.endd
17030In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17031.code
17032file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17033.endd
17034This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17035lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17036
17037.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17038.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17039The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17040from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17041&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17042ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17043verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17044
17045
17046
17047.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17048.oindex "&%-bt%&"
17049.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17050If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17051by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17052your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17053having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17054routing.
17055
17056
17057
17058.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17059.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17060.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17061This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17062routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17063&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17064&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17065value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17066includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17067well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17068you could put:
17069.code
17070cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17071.endd
17072on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17073and
17074.code
17075cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17076.endd
17077on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17078this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17079explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17080logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17081
17082
17083.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17084.cindex "case of local parts"
17085.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17086By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17087manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17088If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17089this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17090part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17091turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17092more details.
17093
17094.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17095.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17096.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17097The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17098router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17099an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17100is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17101addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17102and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17103
17104This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17105recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17106modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17107(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17108
17109
17110
17111.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17112.cindex "local user, checking in router"
17113.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17114.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17115.vindex "&$home$&"
17116When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17117address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17118local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17119than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17120holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17121user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17122preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17123given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17124overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17125the router is skipped.
17126
17127If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17128or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17129setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17130two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17131setting to achieve this. For example:
17132.code
17133local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17134.endd
17135Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17136up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17137&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17138
17139
17140
17141.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17142.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17143This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17144router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17145evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17146result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17147&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17148router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17149
17150If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17151precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17152
17153This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17154All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17155
17156The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17157running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17158the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17159.code
17160condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17161.endd
17162Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17163.code
17164condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17165.endd
17166
17167A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17168.code
17169condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17170condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17171condition = foobar
17172.endd
17173
17174If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17175of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17176be specified using &%condition%&.
17177
17178Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17179are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17180they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17181parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17182ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17183Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17184Router rules processing behavior.
17185
17186This is best illustrated in an example:
17187.code
17188# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17189# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17190
17191$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17192true {yes} {no}}
17193
17194$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17195 {yes} {no}}
17196.endd
17197In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17198&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17199default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17200(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17201string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17202with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17203resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17204&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17205
17206In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17207&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17208mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17209conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17210string characters.
17211
17212Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17213true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17214match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17215contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17216expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17217
17218
17219.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17220.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17221If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17222option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17223the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17224If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17225output, and Exim carries on processing.
17226This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17227so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17228option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17229variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17230&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17231are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17232The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17233
17234
17235
17236.option disable_logging routers boolean false
17237If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17238or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17239unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17240transport option of the same name.
17241
17242.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17243.cindex "MX record" "security"
17244.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17245.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17246.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17247DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17248the dnssec request bit set.
17249This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17250
17251.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17252.cindex "MX record" "security"
17253.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17254.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17255.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17256DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17257the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17258(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17259This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17260
17261
17262.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17263.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17264.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17265If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17266the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17267lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17268expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17269a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17270
17271
17272
17273.option driver routers string unset
17274This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17275to be used.
17276
17277
17278.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17279.cindex "DSN" "success"
17280.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17281If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17282Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17283instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17284Not effective on redirect routers.
17285
17286
17287
17288.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17289.cindex "envelope sender"
17290.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17291If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17292transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17293there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17294message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17295provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17296expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17297
17298The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17299subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17300settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17301setting.
17302
17303If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17304the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17305address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17306expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17307
17308If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17309SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17310any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17311sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17312settings:
17313.code
17314errors_to =
17315errors_to = ""
17316.endd
17317An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17318this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17319no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17320address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17321overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17322
17323.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17324If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17325MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17326path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17327setting &%return_path%&.
17328
17329The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17330manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17331implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17332
17333
17334
17335.option expn routers&!? boolean true
17336.cindex "address" "testing"
17337.cindex "testing" "addresses"
17338.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17339.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17340If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17341as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17342want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17343on for the system alias file.
17344See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17345are evaluated.
17346
17347The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17348&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17349an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17350
17351
17352
17353.option fail_verify routers boolean false
17354.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17355Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17356&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17357
17358
17359
17360.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17361If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17362verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17363
17364
17365
17366.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17367If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17368verifying a sender, verification fails.
17369
17370
17371
17372.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17373.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17374.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17375String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17376colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17377changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17378each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17379defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17380&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17381
17382If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17383associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17384list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17385randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17386transport for further details.
17387
17388
17389.option group routers string&!! "see below"
17390.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17391.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17392.cindex "transport" "local"
17393.cindex "router" "setting group"
17394When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17395specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17396process.
17397The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17398error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17399The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17400is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17401and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17402
17403
17404
17405.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17406.cindex "header lines" "adding"
17407.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17408This option specifies a list of text headers,
17409newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17410that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17411Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17412option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17413the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17414&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17415message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17416header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17417&"see"& the added header lines.
17418
17419The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17420&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17421an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17422failures are treated as configuration errors.
17423
17424Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17425for a router; all listed headers are added.
17426
17427&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17428router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17429
17430.cindex "duplicate addresses"
17431.oindex "&%unseen%&"
17432&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17433additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17434For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17435address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17436modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17437circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17438which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17439avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17440
17441
17442
17443.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17444.cindex "header lines" "removing"
17445.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17446This option specifies a list of text headers,
17447colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17448that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17449Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17450option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17451the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17452section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17453the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17454to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17455&"see"& the original header lines.
17456
17457The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17458&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17459the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17460errors.
17461
17462Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17463for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17464
17465&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17466router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17467
17468&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17469removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17470routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17471warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17472
17473&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17474items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17475To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17476
17477
17478
17479.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17480.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17481.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17482Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17483entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17484IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17485address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17486like
17487.code
17488remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17489.endd
17490by setting
17491.code
17492ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17493.endd
17494on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17495discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17496attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17497domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17498Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17499router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17500
17501You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17502means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17503.code
17504ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17505ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17506.endd
17507The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17508in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17509
17510This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17511addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17512is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17513domain that is being routed.
17514
17515.vindex "&$host_address$&"
17516During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17517checked.
17518
17519.option initgroups routers boolean false
17520.cindex "additional groups"
17521.cindex "groups" "additional"
17522.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17523.cindex "transport" "local"
17524If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17525the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17526&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17527any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17528and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17529
17530
17531
17532.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17533.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17534.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17535If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17536one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17537section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17538evaluated.
17539
17540The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17541used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17542asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17543the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17544some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17545.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17546.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17547Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17548section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17549
17550.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17551.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17552During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17553running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17554expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17555the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17556a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17557command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17558This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17559the relevant transport.
17560
17561When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17562behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17563means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17564callout.
17565
17566The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17567&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17568&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17569to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17570immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17571.code
17572real_localuser:
17573 driver = accept
17574 local_part_prefix = real-
17575 check_local_user
17576 transport = local_delivery
17577.endd
17578For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17579router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17580.code
17581 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17582 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17583.endd
17584
17585If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17586both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17587are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17588separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17589
17590
17591.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17592See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17593
17594
17595
17596.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17597.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17598.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17599This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17600local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17601&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17602mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17603character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17604parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17605&%username-foo%&.
17606
17607
17608.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17609See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17610
17611
17612
17613.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17614.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17615.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17616The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17617See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17618are evaluated, and
17619section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17620string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17621example:
17622.code
17623local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17624.endd
17625.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17626If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17627for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17628expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17629example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17630send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17631each virtual domain:
17632.code
17633postmaster:
17634 driver = redirect
17635 local_parts = postmaster
17636 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17637.endd
17638
17639
17640.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17641.cindex "log" "delivery line"
17642.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17643Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17644deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17645recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17646this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17647router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17648router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17649redirect addresses.
17650
17651
17652
17653.option more routers boolean&!! true
17654The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17655that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17656result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17657fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17658delivery to be deferred.
17659
17660If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17661further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17662.oindex "&%self%&"
17663However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17664means of the setting
17665.code
17666self = pass
17667.endd
17668or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17669does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17670case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17671
17672Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17673expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17674controls what happens next.
17675
17676
17677.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17678.cindex "timeout" "of router"
17679.cindex "router" "timeout"
17680If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17681address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17682router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17683intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17684host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17685
17686There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17687lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17688applies to all of them.
17689
17690
17691
17692.option pass_router routers string unset
17693.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17694Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17695&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17696routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17697these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17698router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17699of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17700be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17701to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17702&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17703
17704
17705
17706.option redirect_router routers string unset
17707.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17708Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17709generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17710example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17711point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17712
17713The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17714It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17715instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17716which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17717
17718
17719
17720.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17721.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17722.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17723This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17724router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17725Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17726through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17727
17728Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17729be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17730If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17731failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17732
17733If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17734below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17735&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17736existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17737preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17738
17739.cindex "NFS"
17740If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17741the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17742unavailable.
17743
17744This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17745options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17746look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17747full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17748these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17749to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17750that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17751transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17752
17753During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17754facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17755This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17756operates as follows:
17757
17758If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17759characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17760comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17761but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17762used. For example:
17763.code
17764require_files = mail:/some/file
17765require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17766.endd
17767If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17768&%require_files%& condition fails.
17769
17770Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17771checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17772directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17773access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17774
17775&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17776incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17777may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17778may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17779user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17780
17781&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17782&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17783without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17784is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17785check again in that process.
17786
17787The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17788be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17789existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17790circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17791not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17792name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17793as if the file did not exist. For example:
17794.code
17795require_files = +/some/file
17796.endd
17797If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17798handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17799option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17800
17801
17802
17803.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17804.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17805.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17806When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17807in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17808domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17809other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17810Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17811latter kind.
17812
17813This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17814hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17815router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17816set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17817for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17818same name.
17819
17820The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17821appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17822independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17823
17824
17825
17826.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17827.cindex "router" "home directory for"
17828.cindex "home directory" "for router"
17829.vindex "&$home$&"
17830This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17831&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17832transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17833sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17834forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17835cause the router to defer.
17836
17837Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17838&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17839place.
17840(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17841are evaluated.)
17842While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17843&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17844
17845When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17846the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17847delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17848of these values that is set:
17849
17850.ilist
17851The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17852.next
17853The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17854.next
17855The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17856.next
17857The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17858.endlist
17859
17860In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17861router, but not for the transport.
17862
17863
17864
17865.option self routers string freeze
17866.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17867.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17868This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17869list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17870and &(manualroute)& routers.
17871Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17872of remote hosts.
17873Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17874&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17875host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17876The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17877&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17878
17879Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17880example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17881error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17882reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17883freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17884cases:
17885
17886.vlist
17887.vitem &%defer%&
17888Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17889
17890.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17891The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17892be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17893behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17894
17895.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17896The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17897reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17898rewritten.
17899
17900.vitem &%pass%&
17901.oindex "&%more%&"
17902.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17903The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17904&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17905subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17906name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17907distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17908combination
17909.code
17910self = pass
17911no_more
17912.endd
17913ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17914Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17915be passed to the next router.
17916
17917.vitem &%fail%&
17918Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17919
17920.vitem &%send%&
17921.cindex "local host" "sending to"
17922The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17923setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17924makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17925is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17926different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17927.endlist
17928
17929
17930
17931.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17932.cindex "router" "checking senders"
17933If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17934address matches something on the list.
17935See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17936are evaluated.
17937
17938There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17939dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17940setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17941to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17942set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17943verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17944SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17945matters.
17946
17947
17948.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17949.cindex "IP address" "translating"
17950.cindex "packet radio"
17951.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17952There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17953it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17954mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17955routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17956is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17957code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17958SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17959
17960.vindex "&$host_address$&"
17961The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17962by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17963expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17964For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17965If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17966address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17967up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17968produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17969addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17970.code
17971translate_ip_address = \
17972 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17973 {$value}fail}}
17974.endd
17975The file would contain lines like
17976.code
1797710.2.3.128/26 some.host
1797810.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17979.endd
17980You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17981are doing.
17982
17983
17984
17985.option transport routers string&!! unset
17986This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17987and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17988only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17989after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17990and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17991delivery is deferred.
17992
17993The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17994have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17995(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17996
17997
17998
17999.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18000.cindex "current directory for local transport"
18001This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18002to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18003explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18004file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18005option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18006overridden by a setting on the transport.
18007If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18008logged, and delivery is deferred.
18009See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18010environment.
18011
18012
18013
18014
18015.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18016.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18017This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18018local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18019configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18020pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18021string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18022setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18023If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18024logged, and delivery is deferred.
18025
18026If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18027&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18028the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18029the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18030is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18031
18032See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18033environment.
18034
18035
18036
18037
18038.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18039.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18040The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18041that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18042result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18043fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18044delivery to be deferred.
18045
18046When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18047address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18048overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18049&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18050the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18051sometimes true and sometimes false).
18052
18053.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18054Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18055qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18056delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18057In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18058&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18059to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18060&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18061
18062&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18063this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18064only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18065no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18066a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18067duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18068duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18069&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18070so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18071&%redirect%& router may be of help.
18072
18073Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18074&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18075subsequent routers.
18076
18077
18078.option user routers string&!! "see below"
18079.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18080.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18081.cindex "transport" "local"
18082.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18083.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18084When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18085specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18086The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18087error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18088This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18089The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18090the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18091a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18092See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18093&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18094
18095
18096
18097.option verify routers&!? boolean true
18098Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18099&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18100
18101
18102.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18103.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18104.oindex "&%-bv%&"
18105.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18106If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18107delivering in cutthrough mode or
18108testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18109with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18110restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18111&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18112
18113&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18114SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18115accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18116user or group.
18117
18118
18119.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18120If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18121addresses,
18122delivering in cutthrough mode
18123or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18124See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18125are evaluated.
18126See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18127
18128
18129.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18130If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18131or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18132See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18133are evaluated.
18134See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18135.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18136.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18137
18138
18139
18140
18141
18142
18143. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18144. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18145
18146.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18147.cindex "&(accept)& router"
18148.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18149The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18150used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18151be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18152specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18153it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18154up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18155.code
18156localusers:
18157 driver = accept
18158 domains = mydomain.example
18159 check_local_user
18160 transport = local_delivery
18161.endd
18162The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18163&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18164When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18165address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18166
18167
18168
18169
18170
18171
18172. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18173. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18174
18175.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18176.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18177.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18178The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18179recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18180unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18181
18182If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18183SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18184MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18185However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18186records.
18187
18188MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18189looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18190When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18191except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18192IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18193generic option, the router declines.
18194
18195Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18196to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18197are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18198
18199.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18200.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18201.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18202If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18203address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18204happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18205
18206
18207.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18208There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18209Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18210SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18211MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18212problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18213
18214For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18215&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18216&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18217an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18218domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18219such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18220proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18221look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18222case routing fails.
18223
18224
18225.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18226.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18227There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18228an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18229domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18230
18231The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18232is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18233
18234Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18235.ilist
18236The domain does not exist in DNS
18237.next
18238The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18239convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18240for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18241.next
18242Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18243.next
18244MX record points to a non-existent host.
18245.next
18246MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18247&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18248.next
18249MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18250addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18251.next
18252The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18253&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18254.next
18255&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18256not be found in the MX records (see below)
18257.endlist
18258
18259
18260
18261
18262.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18263.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18264The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18265
18266.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18267.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18268If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18269(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18270process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18271differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18272the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18273
18274
18275.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18276.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18277The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18278addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18279enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18280required. For example,
18281.code
18282check_srv = smtp
18283.endd
18284looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18285expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18286to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18287submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18288option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18289normal way.
18290
18291When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18292the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18293host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18294this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18295SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18296according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18297
18298When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18299the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18300records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18301this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18302defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18303and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18304have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18305trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18306
18307See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18308when there is a DNS lookup error.
18309
18310
18311
18312
18313.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18314.cindex "MX record" "not found"
18315DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18316which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18317rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18318This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18319domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18320However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18321also being queued.
18322
18323
18324.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18325.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18326.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18327A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18328record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18329For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18330records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18331setting:
18332.code
18333mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18334.endd
18335This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18336has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18337the address record.
18338
18339
18340.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18341If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18342DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18343&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18344
18345
18346
18347
18348.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18349.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18350.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18351When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18352lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18353single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18354called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18355&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18356resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18357&'resolv.conf'&.
18358
18359
18360
18361.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18362.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18363.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18364If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18365qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18366an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18367expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18368occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18369&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18370any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18371header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18372
18373This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18374ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18375sense.
18376
18377When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18378servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18379making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18380some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18381name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18382header rewriting.
18383
18384
18385.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18386.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18387Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18388to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18389options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18390default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18391servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18392any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18393
18394If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18395domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18396local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18397lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18398routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18399message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18400without processing them independently,
18401provided the following conditions are met:
18402
18403.ilist
18404No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18405&%headers_remove%&.
18406.next
18407The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18408the domain.
18409.endlist
18410
18411
18412
18413
18414.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18415.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18416When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18417lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18418applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18419the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18420domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18421up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18422&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18423actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18424
18425Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18426record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18427local wildcard.
18428
18429
18430
18431.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18432If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18433DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18434&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18435
18436
18437
18438
18439.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18440.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18441If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18442added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18443if
18444.code
18445widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18446.endd
18447is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18448&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18449&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18450and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18451the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18452when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18453
18454
18455.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18456When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18457of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18458corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18459is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18460
18461These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18462for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18463such as that implied by
18464.code
18465domains = @mx_any
18466.endd
18467that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18468entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18469.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18470.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18471
18472
18473
18474
18475
18476
18477
18478
18479
18480. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18481. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18482
18483.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18484.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18485.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18486.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18487This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18488verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18489generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18490takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18491router handles the address
18492.code
18493root@[192.168.1.1]
18494.endd
18495by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18496consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18497are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18498.code
18499postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18500.endd
18501Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18502grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18503
18504.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18505If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18506declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18507&%self%& option determines what happens.
18508
18509The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18510controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18511also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18512Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18513
18514
18515
18516. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18517. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18518
18519.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18520.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18521.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18522The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18523Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18524not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18525must set
18526.code
18527ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18528.endd
18529in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18530
18531The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18532connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18533a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18534message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18535this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18536can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18537must not be specified for it.
18538
18539.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18540.option hosts iplookup string unset
18541This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18542names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18543(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18544and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18545happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18546
18547
18548.option optional iplookup boolean false
18549If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18550is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18551delivery to the address is deferred.
18552
18553
18554.option port iplookup integer 0
18555.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18556This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18557call.
18558
18559
18560.option protocol iplookup string udp
18561This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18562protocols is to be used.
18563
18564
18565.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18566This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18567default value is:
18568.code
18569$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18570.endd
18571The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18572query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18573
18574
18575.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18576If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18577returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18578string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18579in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18580&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18581whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18582up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18583
18584
18585.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18586This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18587returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18588router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18589response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18590check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18591address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18592the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18593following could be used:
18594.code
18595response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18596reroute = $local_part@$1
18597.endd
18598
18599.option timeout iplookup time 5s
18600This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18601machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18602call. It does not apply to UDP.
18603
18604
18605
18606
18607. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18608. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18609
18610.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18611.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18612.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18613.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18614The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18615routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18616route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18617normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18618route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18619messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18620
18621The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18622it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18623has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18624include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18625&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18626generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18627being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18628
18629.vindex "&$host$&"
18630In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18631router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18632an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18633transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18634with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18635passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18636host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18637text string.
18638
18639The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18640&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18641or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18642any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18643below, following the list of private options.
18644
18645
18646.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18647
18648.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18649The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18650
18651.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18652See &%host_find_failed%&.
18653
18654.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18655This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18656address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18657of the following values:
18658.code
18659decline
18660defer
18661fail
18662freeze
18663ignore
18664pass
18665.endd
18666The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18667error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18668forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18669&%pass_router%&),
18670.oindex "&%more%&"
18671overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18672router only if &%more%& is true.
18673
18674The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18675cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18676controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18677as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18678
18679The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18680state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18681generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18682
18683
18684.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18685.cindex "randomized host list"
18686.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18687If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18688is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18689overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18690crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18691same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18692(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18693deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18694
18695When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18696into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18697set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18698item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18699.code
18700route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18701.endd
18702The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18703randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18704If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18705randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18706&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18707
18708
18709.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18710If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18711Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18712example:
18713.code
18714route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18715.endd
18716If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18717router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18718deferred.
18719
18720
18721.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18722This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18723unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18724that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18725
18726
18727.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18728.cindex "address" "copying routing"
18729Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18730router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18731router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18732default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18733servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18734any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18735
18736If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18737domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18738local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18739lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18740&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18741addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18742same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18743if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18744
18745
18746
18747
18748.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18749The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18750rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18751entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18752described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18753Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18754.display
18755<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18756.endd
18757The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18758no options:
18759.code
18760route_list = \
18761 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18762 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18763.endd
18764The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18765list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18766usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18767single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18768pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18769&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18770except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18771That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18772lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18773in a &%route_list%&).
18774
18775The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18776matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18777then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18778&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18779
18780
18781
18782.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18783The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18784routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18785hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18786The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18787Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18788expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18789like this:
18790.code
18791dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18792thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18793.endd
18794This data can be accessed by setting
18795.code
18796route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18797.endd
18798Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18799decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18800requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18801possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18802be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18803
18804
18805
18806
18807.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18808A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18809always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18810declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18811and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18812in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18813as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18814
18815If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18816variables are set during its expansion:
18817
18818.ilist
18819.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18820If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18821&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18822.code
18823route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18824.endd
18825.next
18826&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18827.next
18828&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18829
18830.next
18831.vindex "&$value$&"
18832If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18833looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18834.code
18835route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18836.endd
18837.endlist
18838
18839Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18840semicolon is the default route list separator.
18841
18842
18843
18844.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18845Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18846optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18847is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18848specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18849by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18850
18851.ilist
18852Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18853the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18854be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18855.code
18856route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18857route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18858.endd
18859.next
18860When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18861colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18862enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18863number follows. For example:
18864.code
18865route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18866.endd
18867.endlist
18868
18869.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18870When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18871the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18872delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18873option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18874transport.
18875
18876Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18877hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18878interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18879records in the DNS. For example:
18880.code
18881route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18882.endd
18883If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18884example:
18885.code
18886route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18887.endd
18888If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18889randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18890that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18891be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18892Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18893happens is controlled by the
18894.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18895&%self%& option of the router.
18896
18897A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18898hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18899lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18900below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18901preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18902randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18903defined by MX preferences.
18904
18905If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18906not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18907preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18908
18909If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18910depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18911is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18912Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18913
18914If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18915most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18916router.
18917
18918DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18919failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18920&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18921
18922The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18923whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18924
18925
18926
18927.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18928The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18929present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18930&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18931other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18932per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18933routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18934
18935.ilist
18936&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18937setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18938.next
18939&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18940overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18941.next
18942&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18943find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18944also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18945.next
18946&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18947no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18948timeout), delivery is deferred.
18949.endlist
18950
18951For example:
18952.code
18953route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18954 domain2 host4:host5
18955.endd
18956If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18957DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18958result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18959or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18960call.
18961
18962&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18963called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18964instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18965lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18966function called.
18967
18968
18969
18970If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18971&%host_find_failed%& option.
18972
18973.vindex "&$host$&"
18974When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18975The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18976
18977
18978
18979.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18980In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18981transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18982
18983.ilist
18984.cindex "smart host" "example router"
18985The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18986&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18987named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18988.code
18989domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18990.endd
18991You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18992your first router something like this:
18993.code
18994smart_route:
18995 driver = manualroute
18996 domains = !+local_domains
18997 transport = remote_smtp
18998 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18999.endd
19000This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19001&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19002they are tried in order
19003(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19004Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19005.code
19006smart_route:
19007 driver = manualroute
19008 transport = remote_smtp
19009 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19010.endd
19011There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19012However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19013example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19014precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19015always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19016would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19017always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19018&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19019
19020.next
19021.cindex "mail hub example"
19022A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19023records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19024the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19025machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19026&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19027to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19028using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19029lookup is easier to manage.
19030
19031If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19032to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19033example:
19034.code
19035hub_route:
19036 driver = manualroute
19037 transport = remote_smtp
19038 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19039.endd
19040This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19041whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19042if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19043that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19044domain can be used to find the host:
19045.code
19046through_firewall:
19047 driver = manualroute
19048 transport = remote_smtp
19049 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19050.endd
19051The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19052hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19053data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19054next router.
19055
19056.next
19057.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19058.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19059You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19060SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19061storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19062can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19063.code
19064save_in_file:
19065 driver = manualroute
19066 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19067 route_list = saved.domain.example
19068.endd
19069though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19070several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19071different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19072.code
19073save_in_file:
19074 driver = manualroute
19075 route_list = \
19076 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19077 *.saved.domain2.example \
19078 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19079 batch_pipe
19080.endd
19081.vindex "&$domain$&"
19082.vindex "&$host$&"
19083The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19084doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19085file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19086the address if the lookup fails.
19087
19088.next
19089.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19090Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19091&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19092one way it can be done:
19093.code
19094# Transport
19095uucp:
19096 driver = pipe
19097 user = nobody
19098 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19099 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19100 return_fail_output = true
19101
19102# Router
19103uucphost:
19104 transport = uucp
19105 driver = manualroute
19106 route_data = \
19107 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19108.endd
19109The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19110.code
19111darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19112.endd
19113It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19114makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19115&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19116.endlist
19117.ecindex IIDmanrou1
19118.ecindex IIDmanrou2
19119
19120
19121
19122
19123
19124
19125
19126
19127. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19128. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19129
19130.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19131.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19132.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19133.cindex "routing" "by external program"
19134The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19135and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19136mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19137However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19138&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19139be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19140options:
19141.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19142
19143.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19144This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19145command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19146expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19147&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19148
19149
19150.option command_group queryprogram string unset
19151.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19152This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19153address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19154uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19155gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19156
19157
19158.option command_user queryprogram string unset
19159.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19160This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19161command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19162it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19163using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19164not set, a value for the gid also.
19165
19166&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19167root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19168However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19169usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19170is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19171the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19172gid.
19173
19174
19175.option current_directory queryprogram string /
19176This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19177before running the command.
19178
19179
19180.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19181If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19182is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19183timeout.
19184
19185
19186The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19187the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19188containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19189the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19190field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19191
19192.ilist
19193&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19194below).
19195.next
19196&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19197&%no_more%& is set.
19198.next
19199&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19200subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19201of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19202included in the SMTP response.
19203.next
19204&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19205subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19206included in any SMTP response.
19207.next
19208&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19209.next
19210&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19211&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19212.next
19213&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19214new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19215or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19216.endlist
19217
19218When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19219number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19220the page):
19221.code
19222ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19223LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19224.endd
19225The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19226is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19227used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19228an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19229
19230The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19231As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19232in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19233&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19234(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19235
19236If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19237find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19238anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19239goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19240result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19241
19242.vindex "&$address_data$&"
19243If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19244variable. For example, this return line
19245.code
19246accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19247.endd
19248routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19249the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19250.ecindex IIDquerou1
19251.ecindex IIDquerou2
19252
19253
19254
19255
19256. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19257. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19258
19259.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19260.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19261.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19262.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19263.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19264The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19265common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19266(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19267files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19268redirected in several different ways:
19269
19270.ilist
19271It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19272independently.
19273.next
19274It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19275.next
19276It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19277.next
19278It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19279.next
19280It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19281.next
19282It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19283.next
19284It can be discarded.
19285.endlist
19286
19287The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19288However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19289files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19290&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19291
19292If success DSNs have been requested
19293.cindex "DSN" "success"
19294.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19295redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19296
19297
19298
19299.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19300The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19301expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19302contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19303options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19304aliases, in a configuration like this:
19305.code
19306system_aliases:
19307 driver = redirect
19308 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19309.endd
19310If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19311expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19312expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19313cause delivery to be deferred.
19314
19315A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19316&_.forward_& files, like this:
19317.code
19318userforward:
19319 driver = redirect
19320 check_local_user
19321 file = $home/.forward
19322 no_verify
19323.endd
19324If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19325empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19326is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19327yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19328comments.
19329
19330
19331
19332.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19333.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19334It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19335&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19336
19337.ilist
19338When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19339running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19340the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19341practice the router may not be able to operate.
19342.next
19343However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19344is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19345local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19346saves some resources.
19347.endlist
19348
19349
19350
19351
19352
19353
19354.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19355.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19356.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19357The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19358can be interpreted in two different ways:
19359
19360.ilist
19361If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19362&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19363&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19364respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19365in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19366document is intended for use by end users.
19367.next
19368Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19369described in the next section.
19370.endlist
19371
19372When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19373in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19374generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19375configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19376for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19377
19378
19379
19380.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19381.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19382When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19383comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19384addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19385&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19386disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19387depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19388commas or newlines.
19389If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19390quotes.
19391
19392Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19393also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19394next newline character is ignored.
19395
19396If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19397double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19398(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19399&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19400removed.
19401
19402.vindex "&$local_part$&"
19403&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19404and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19405of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19406special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19407&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19408setting:
19409.code
19410data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19411.endd
19412
19413
19414.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19415.cindex "routing" "loops in"
19416.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19417.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19418A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19419consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19420automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19421is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19422Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19423as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19424complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19425
19426.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19427Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19428filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19429mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19430&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19431.code
19432cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19433.endd
19434.cindex "backslash in alias file"
19435.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19436For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19437preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19438it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19439synonymously.
19440
19441If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
194422822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19443domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19444addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19445force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19446
19447Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19448Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19449contains:
19450.code
19451Sam.Reman: spqr
19452.endd
19453Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19454messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19455this forward file:
19456.code
19457Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19458.endd
19459With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19460&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19461second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19462and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19463should really contain
19464.code
19465spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19466.endd
19467but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19468below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19469&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19470
19471
19472
19473.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19474In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19475lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19476
19477.ilist
19478.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19479.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19480An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19481as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19482command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19483Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19484which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19485
19486Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19487the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19488the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19489in double quotes, for example:
19490.code
19491"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19492.endd
19493since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19494quote just the command. An item such as
19495.code
19496|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19497.endd
19498is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19499
19500Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19501of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19502redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19503quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19504string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19505are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19506data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19507transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19508an &%accept%& router.
19509
19510.next
19511.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19512.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19513An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19514parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19515.code
19516/home/world/minbari
19517.endd
19518is treated as a file name, but
19519.code
19520/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19521.endd
19522is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19523the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19524forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19525file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19526
19527Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19528which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19529
19530.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19531However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19532bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19533instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19534
19535.next
19536.cindex "included address list"
19537.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19538If an item is of the form
19539.code
19540:include:<path name>
19541.endd
19542a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19543point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19544out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19545by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19546item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19547the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19548.code
19549list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19550.endd
19551It must be given as
19552.code
19553list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19554.endd
19555.next
19556.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19557Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19558&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19559the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19560.cindex "black hole"
19561.cindex "abandoning mail"
19562&':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19563done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19564&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19565
19566&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19567delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19568are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19569database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19570&_/dev/null_&.
19571
19572.next
19573.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19574.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19575.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19576.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19577.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19578An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19579redirection items of the form
19580.code
19581:defer:
19582:fail:
19583.endd
19584respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19585to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19586text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19587associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19588.code
19589X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19590.endd
19591In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19592of a
19593.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19594VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19595default.
19596.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19597The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19598the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19599
19600.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19601By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19602&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19603space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19604followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19605code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19606incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19607suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19608&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19609ignored.
19610
19611.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19612In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19613default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19614therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19615
19616Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19617not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19618normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19619as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19620lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19621
19622During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19623containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19624whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19625subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19626deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19627rules still apply.
19628
19629.next
19630.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19631Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19632chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19633for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19634&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19635router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19636results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19637.endlist
19638
19639
19640.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19641.cindex "duplicate addresses"
19642.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19643.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19644Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19645to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19646routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19647aliasing scheme of the type
19648.code
19649pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19650localpart1: pipe
19651localpart2: pipe
19652.endd
19653does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19654when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19655discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19656such as
19657.code
19658localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19659localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19660.endd
19661does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19662the pipes are distinct.
19663
19664
19665
19666.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19667.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19668.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19669When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19670leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19671afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19672delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19673members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19674can be used to avoid this.
19675
19676
19677.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19678.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19679If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19680error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19681for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19682detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19683deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19684
19685
19686
19687.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19688
19689.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19690The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19691
19692
19693.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19694Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19695data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19696
19697
19698.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19699.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19700If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19701and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19702
19703
19704.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19705.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19706.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19707Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19708&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19709are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19710lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19711
19712It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19713the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19714
19715
19716The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19717&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19718&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19719files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19720true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19721
19722
19723
19724.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19725.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19726Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19727This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19728default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19729let ordinary users do.
19730
19731
19732
19733.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19734This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19735as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19736Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19737configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19738for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19739
19740When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19741is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19742the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19743and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19744domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19745&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19746.code
19747\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19748.endd
19749Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19750&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19751originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19752(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19753&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19754&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19755file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19756original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19757
19758
19759.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19760When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19761when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19762&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19763&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19764deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19765is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19766&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19767
19768
19769
19770.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19771When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19772this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19773permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19774option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19775&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19776
19777
19778.option data redirect string&!! unset
19779This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19780set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19781list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19782expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19783has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19784
19785When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19786filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19787terminated with newline characters. For example:
19788.code
19789data = #Exim filter\n\
19790 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19791.endd
19792If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19793you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19794choice into a newline.
19795
19796
19797.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19798A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19799ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19800specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19801configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19802
19803
19804.option file redirect string&!! unset
19805This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19806is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19807use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19808failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19809must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19810data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19811entirely of comments), the router declines.
19812
19813.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19814If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19815runs a check on the containing directory,
19816unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19817If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19818happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19819is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19820not, the router declines.
19821
19822
19823.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19824.vindex "&$address_file$&"
19825A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19826ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19827specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19828configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19829it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19830
19831
19832.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19833When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19834relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19835relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19836relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19837
19838
19839.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19840If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19841redirection list.
19842
19843
19844.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19845If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19846&%allow_filter%& is true.
19847
19848
19849
19850
19851.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19852.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19853.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19854.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19855If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19856specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19857conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19858set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19859locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19860
19861
19862.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19863.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19864If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19865make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19866functions.
19867
19868.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19869.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19870If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19871make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19872
19873.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19874If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19875permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19876under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19877&_.forward_& files).
19878
19879
19880.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19881If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19882to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19883
19884
19885.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19886This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19887it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19888of the embedded Perl support.
19889
19890
19891.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19892If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19893to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19894
19895
19896.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19897If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19898to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19899
19900
19901.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19902If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19903message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19904files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19905&%one_time%& is set.
19906
19907
19908.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19909If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19910to make use of &%run%& items.
19911
19912
19913.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19914If this option is true, items of the form
19915.code
19916:include:<path name>
19917.endd
19918are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19919
19920
19921.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19922.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19923If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19924specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19925forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19926
19927
19928.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19929If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19930&%allow_filter%& is true.
19931
19932
19933.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19934.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19935If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19936of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19937the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19938
19939
19940
19941
19942.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19943.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19944If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19945generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19946generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19947bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19948bounce may well quote the generated address.
19949
19950
19951.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19952.cindex "EACCES"
19953If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19954EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19955file did not exist.
19956
19957
19958.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19959.cindex "ENOTDIR"
19960If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19961ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19962router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19963
19964Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19965router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19966(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19967against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19968is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19969is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19970a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19971that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19972
19973
19974
19975.option include_directory redirect string unset
19976If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19977redirection list must start with this directory.
19978
19979
19980.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19981This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19982&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19983
19984
19985.option one_time redirect boolean false
19986.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19987.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19988.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19989.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19990.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19991Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19992files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19993of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19994is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19995but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19996message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19997lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19998before they subscribed.
19999
20000If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20001deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20002&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20003&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20004attempt.
20005
20006&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20007router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20008reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20009permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20010
20011&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20012to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20013and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20014
20015&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20016&%one_time%&.
20017
20018The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20019addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20020addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20021&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20022typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20023expansion.
20024
20025
20026.option owners redirect "string list" unset
20027.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20028.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20029.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20030.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20031This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20032This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20033See &%check_owner%& above.
20034
20035
20036.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20037This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20038The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20039&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20040
20041
20042.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20043.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20044A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20045starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20046transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20047name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20048When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20049
20050
20051.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20052.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20053If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20054generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20055in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20056expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20057to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20058&$qualify_recipient$&.
20059
20060This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20061but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20062not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20063addresses.
20064
20065.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20066.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20067.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20068.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20069If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20070set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20071without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20072address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20073&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20074this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20075
20076
20077.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20078If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20079any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20080the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20081only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20082&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20083
20084
20085.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20086A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20087&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20088by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20089transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20090are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20091
20092
20093.option rewrite redirect boolean true
20094.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20095If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20096subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20097and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20098
20099
20100.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20101The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20102:subaddress part of an address.
20103
20104.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20105The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20106of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20107(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20108
20109
20110.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20111.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20112To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20113&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20114(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20115&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20116needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20117
20118
20119
20120.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20121.cindex "forward file" "broken"
20122.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20123.cindex "alias file" "broken"
20124.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20125.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20126.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20127.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20128If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20129non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20130&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20131giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20132are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20133&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20134be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20135&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20136
20137If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20138errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20139the following routers.
20140
20141If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20142error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20143taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20144so it is passed to the following routers.
20145
20146.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20147Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20148action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20149&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20150
20151&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20152lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20153option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20154notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20155.code
20156userforward:
20157 driver = redirect
20158 allow_filter
20159 check_local_user
20160 file = $home/.forward
20161 file_transport = address_file
20162 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20163 reply_transport = address_reply
20164 no_verify
20165 skip_syntax_errors
20166 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20167 syntax_errors_text = \
20168 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20169 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20170 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20171 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20172 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20173 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20174 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20175 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20176 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20177 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20178.endd
20179You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20180&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20181put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20182.code
20183real_localuser:
20184 driver = accept
20185 check_local_user
20186 local_part_prefix = real-
20187 transport = local_delivery
20188.endd
20189For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20190router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20191.code
20192 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20193 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20194.endd
20195
20196
20197.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20198See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20199
20200
20201.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20202See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20203.ecindex IIDredrou1
20204.ecindex IIDredrou2
20205
20206
20207
20208
20209
20210
20211. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20212. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20213
20214.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20215 "Environment for local transports"
20216.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20217.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20218.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20219Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20220transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20221in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20222mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20223
20224Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20225some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20226transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20227&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20228
20229The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20230different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20231settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20232or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20233configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20234
20235
20236
20237.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20238.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20239.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20240If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20241simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20242the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20243rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20244time.
20245
20246However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20247locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20248.code
20249my_transport:
20250 driver = pipe
20251 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20252.endd
20253This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20254messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20255&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20256file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20257
20258
20259
20260
20261.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20262.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20263.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20264All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20265overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20266set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20267delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20268group (set by the transport). For example:
20269.code
20270# Routers ...
20271# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20272local_users:
20273 driver = accept
20274 check_local_user
20275 transport = group_delivery
20276
20277# Transports ...
20278# This transport overrides the group
20279group_delivery:
20280 driver = appendfile
20281 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20282 group = mail
20283.endd
20284If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20285address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20286gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20287set.
20288
20289.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20290When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20291function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20292&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20293by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20294for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20295
20296.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20297The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20298is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20299receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20300original gid is also used.
20301
20302This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20303following that is set is used:
20304
20305.ilist
20306A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20307.next
20308A &%group%& setting of the router;
20309.next
20310A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20311&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20312.next
20313The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20314.next
20315In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20316the uid is the creator's uid;
20317.next
20318The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20319.endlist
20320
20321If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20322no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20323This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20324The first of the following that is set is used:
20325
20326.ilist
20327A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20328.next
20329In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20330.next
20331A &%user%& setting of the router;
20332.next
20333A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20334.next
20335The Exim uid.
20336.endlist
20337
20338Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20339&%never_users%& list.
20340
20341
20342
20343
20344
20345.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20346.cindex "current directory for local transport"
20347.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20348.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20349.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20350Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20351the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20352However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20353are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20354for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20355
20356.ilist
20357The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20358.next
20359The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20360.next
20361The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20362.next
20363The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20364.endlist
20365
20366The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20367
20368.ilist
20369The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20370.next
20371The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20372.endlist
20373
20374
20375If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20376value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20377directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20378
20379
20380
20381.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20382.vindex "&$domain$&"
20383.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20384.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20385Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20386variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20387deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20388at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20389other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20390never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20391and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20392.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20393.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20394.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20395
20396
20397
20398
20399
20400
20401
20402. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20403. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20404
20405.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20406.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20407.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20408.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20409The following generic options apply to all transports:
20410
20411
20412.option body_only transports boolean false
20413.cindex "transport" "body only"
20414.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20415.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20416If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20417mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20418or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20419&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20420automatically suppress them.
20421
20422
20423.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20424.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20425This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20426transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20427If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20428logged, and delivery is deferred.
20429
20430
20431.option disable_logging transports boolean false
20432If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20433deliveries by the transport or for any
20434transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20435what you are doing.
20436
20437
20438.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20439.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20440If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20441option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20442transport is run.
20443If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20444output, and Exim carries on processing.
20445This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20446so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20447option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20448variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20449one.
20450The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20451transport and the router that called it.
20452
20453.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20454.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20455If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20456This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20457header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20458requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20459safely be resent to other recipients.
20460
20461
20462.option driver transports string unset
20463This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20464There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20465
20466
20467.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20468.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20469If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20470This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20471delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20472configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20473address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20474header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20475its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20476resent to other recipients.
20477
20478
20479.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20480.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20481This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20482value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20483&%user%& (see below).
20484
20485
20486.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20487.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20488.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20489This option specifies a list of text headers,
20490newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20491which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20492portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20493&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20494routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20495is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20496errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20497
20498Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20499for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20500
20501
20502.option headers_only transports boolean false
20503.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20504.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20505.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20506If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20507exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20508transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20509checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20510
20511
20512.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20513.cindex "header lines" "removing"
20514.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20515This option specifies a list of header names,
20516colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20517these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20518in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20519routers.
20520Each list item is separately expanded.
20521If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20522is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20523errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20524
20525Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20526for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20527
20528&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20529items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20530To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20531
20532
20533
20534.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20535.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20536.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20537This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20538that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20539option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20540the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20541message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20542example,
20543.code
20544headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20545 x@y w@z
20546.endd
20547changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20548&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20549header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20550only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20551the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20552filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20553affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20554envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20555change envelope recipients at this time.
20556
20557
20558.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20559.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20560.vindex "&$home$&"
20561This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20562overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20563placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20564used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20565&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20566&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20567for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20568deferred.
20569
20570
20571.option initgroups transports boolean false
20572.cindex "additional groups"
20573.cindex "groups" "additional"
20574.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20575If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20576transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20577to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20578
20579
20580.new
20581.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
20582.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
20583.cindex transport "parallel processes"
20584.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
20585.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
20586If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
20587it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
20588The control does not apply to shadow transports.
20589
20590.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
20591Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
20592incremented whenever a transport process is beaing created. The record
20593is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
20594Obviously there is scope for
20595records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
20596guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
20597
20598If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
20599relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
20600start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
20601may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
20602are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
20603.wen
20604
20605
20606.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20607.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20608.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20609.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20610This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20611expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20612digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20613including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20614delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20615message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20616the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20617ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20618&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20619delivered.
20620
20621
20622
20623.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20624.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20625.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20626.cindex "local part" "prefix"
20627.cindex "local part" "suffix"
20628When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20629affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20630form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20631that contains
20632.code
20633local_part_prefix = *-
20634.endd
20635routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20636is delivered with
20637.code
20638RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20639.endd
20640This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20641recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20642whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20643deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20644&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20645
20646
20647.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20648.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20649When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20650in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20651is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20652deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20653part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20654temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20655deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20656
20657However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20658as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20659(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20660this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20661
20662For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20663the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20664on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20665
20666
20667.option return_path transports string&!! unset
20668.cindex "envelope sender"
20669.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20670.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20671If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20672the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20673that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20674designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20675SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20676only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20677header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20678
20679&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20680&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20681
20682.vindex "&$return_path$&"
20683The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20684either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20685&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20686replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20687option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20688section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20689
20690&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20691remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20692the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20693This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20694&%errors_to%& in a router.
20695
20696
20697
20698.option return_path_add transports boolean false
20699.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20700If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20701Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20702mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20703have easy access to it.
20704
20705RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20706the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20707header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20708option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20709incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20710recipients.
20711
20712
20713.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20714See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20715
20716
20717.option shadow_transport transports string unset
20718.cindex "shadow transport"
20719.cindex "transport" "shadow"
20720A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20721another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20722
20723Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20724&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20725string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20726passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20727expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20728cause a log line to be written.
20729
20730The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20731subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20732provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20733is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20734ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20735of the form
20736.code
20737ST=<shadow transport name>
20738.endd
20739If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20740parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20741purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20742provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20743headers that some sites insist on.
20744
20745
20746.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20747.cindex "transport" "filter"
20748.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20749This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20750at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20751individual users or via a system filter.
20752.new
20753If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
20754.wen
20755
20756When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20757&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20758the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20759input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20760command must be specified as an absolute path.
20761
20762The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20763terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20764SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20765lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20766settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20767&(pipe)& transports.
20768
20769The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20770standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20771destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20772filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20773are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20774
20775The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20776care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20777test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20778SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20779
20780.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20781A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20782at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20783message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20784a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20785not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20786
20787.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20788A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20789being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20790support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20791at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20792more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20793the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20794additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20795
20796.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20797The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20798the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20799parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20800Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20801section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20802to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20803of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20804an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20805&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20806
20807.vindex "&$host$&"
20808.vindex "&$host_address$&"
20809The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20810transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20811which the message is being sent. For example:
20812.code
20813transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20814 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20815.endd
20816
20817Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20818generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20819command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20820.ilist
20821If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20822part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20823expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20824example:
20825.code
20826transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20827.endd
20828This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20829&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20830stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20831the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20832&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20833Exim tried to expand the first one.
20834.next
20835Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20836expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20837arguments. Consider this example:
20838.code
20839transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20840 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20841.endd
20842The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20843if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20844.code
20845transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20846 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20847.endd
20848.endlist
20849
20850The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20851For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20852normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20853A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20854serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20855the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20856bounced from a transport filter.
20857
20858If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20859passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20860message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20861
20862
20863.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20864.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20865When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20866that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20867temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20868&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20869way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20870error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20871becomes a temporary error.
20872
20873
20874.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20875.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20876.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20877This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20878run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20879given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20880associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20881option is not set.
20882
20883For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20884specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20885&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20886
20887.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20888For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20889sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20890to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20891retry data.
20892.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20893.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20894.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20895
20896
20897
20898
20899
20900
20901. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20902. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20903
20904.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20905 "Address batching"
20906.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20907The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20908one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20909remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20910normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20911transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20912copy of the message is delivered each time.
20913
20914.cindex "batched local delivery"
20915.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20916.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20917In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20918local transport, for example:
20919
20920.ilist
20921In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20922delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20923recipients saves space.
20924.next
20925In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20926a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20927.next
20928In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20929to a scanner program or
20930to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20931acceptable.
20932.endlist
20933
20934These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20935(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20936repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20937
20938The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20939delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20940(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20941&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20942(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20943to certain conditions:
20944
20945.ilist
20946.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20947If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20948batching is possible.
20949.next
20950.vindex "&$domain$&"
20951If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20952addresses with the same domain are batched.
20953.next
20954.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20955If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20956addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20957customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20958including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20959from taking place.
20960.next
20961Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20962delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20963group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20964be the same.
20965.endlist
20966
20967In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20968both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20969is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20970course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20971option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20972&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20973&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20974.code
20975check_string = "."
20976escape_string = ".."
20977.endd
20978when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20979given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20980&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20981
20982.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20983If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20984&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20985that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20986transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20987addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20988
20989.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20990.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20991If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20992transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20993the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20994of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20995argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20996delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20997are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20998
20999
21000
21001
21002. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21003. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21004
21005.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21006.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21007.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21008.cindex "directory creation"
21009.cindex "creating directories"
21010The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21011file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21012files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21013format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21014University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21015being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21016to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21017delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21018supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21019directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21020
21021The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21022default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21023SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21024included.
21025
21026.cindex "quota" "system"
21027Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21028also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21029system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21030
21031If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21032partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21033modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21034creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21035
21036Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21037file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21038private options.
21039
21040The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21041users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21042putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21043&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21044option).
21045
21046
21047
21048.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21049The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21050the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21051the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21052normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21053
21054.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21055.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21056However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21057directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21058forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21059user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21060the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21061name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21062operation. There are two cases:
21063
21064.ilist
21065If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21066must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21067common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21068different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21069default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21070name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21071&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21072.next
21073If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21074used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21075contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21076.endlist
21077
21078
21079.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21080.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21081As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21082have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21083form:
21084.code
21085save folder23
21086.endd
21087or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21088.code
21089require "fileinto";
21090fileinto "folder23";
21091.endd
21092In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21093must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21094case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21095is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21096way of handling this requirement:
21097.code
21098file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21099 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21100 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21101 {$address_file} \
21102 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21103 }} \
21104 }
21105.endd
21106With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21107location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21108&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21109
21110&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21111&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21112the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21113you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21114&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21115path to the transport.
21116
21117&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21118the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21119
21120
21121
21122
21123.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21124.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21125
21126
21127
21128.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21129.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21130.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21131.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21132Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21133regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21134delivery is deferred.
21135
21136
21137.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21138.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21139.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21140By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21141that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21142are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21143what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21144are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21145
21146
21147.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21148See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21149However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21150happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21151file.
21152
21153
21154.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21155See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21156
21157
21158.option check_group appendfile boolean false
21159When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21160option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21161delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21162file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21163
21164
21165.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21166When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21167is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21168process is running.
21169
21170
21171.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21172.cindex "&""From""& line"
21173As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21174matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21175replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21176a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21177contains is significant.
21178
21179If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21180are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21181configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21182&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21183&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21184
21185The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21186suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21187&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21188if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21189.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21190.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21191.code
21192check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21193escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21194message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21195message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21196.endd
21197.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21198.cindex "directory creation"
21199When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21200directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21201is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21202
21203The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21204operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21205example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21206is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21207in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21208
21209
21210
21211.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21212This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21213by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21214directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21215delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21216beneath.
21217
21218The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21219&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21220set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21221given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21222names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21223by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21224&%file_must_exist%&.
21225
21226
21227.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21228This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21229or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21230redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21231
21232When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21233into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21234appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21235(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21236&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21237
21238
21239.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21240.cindex "base62"
21241.vindex "&$inode$&"
21242When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21243&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21244whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21245.code
21246q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21247.endd
21248This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21249inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21250option.
21251
21252
21253.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21254If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21255&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21256
21257
21258.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21259See &%check_string%& above.
21260
21261
21262.option file appendfile string&!! unset
21263This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21264&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21265of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21266specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21267&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21268&%file%&.
21269
21270.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21271.cindex "locking files"
21272.cindex "lock files"
21273If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21274mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21275
21276The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21277path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21278examples:
21279.code
21280file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21281file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21282file = $home/inbox
21283.endd
21284.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21285In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21286is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21287create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21288deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21289run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21290
21291
21292
21293.option file_format appendfile string unset
21294.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21295This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21296before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21297start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21298colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21299second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21300string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21301transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21302this added to it:
21303.code
21304file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21305 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21306.endd
21307Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21308a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21309to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21310to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21311is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21312match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21313delivery is deferred.
21314
21315
21316.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21317If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21318A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21319If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21320
21321
21322.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21323.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21324.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21325.cindex "locking files"
21326By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21327when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21328sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21329Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21330for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21331deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21332mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21333misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21334
21335On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21336not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21337is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21338and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21339
21340If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21341timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21342retries is
21343.code
21344(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21345.endd
21346rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21347which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21348&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21349
21350You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21351local deliveries because of errors of the form
21352.code
21353failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21354.endd
21355
21356.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21357This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21358&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21359&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21360
21361
21362.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21363This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21364for details of locking.
21365
21366
21367.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21368This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21369is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21370
21371
21372.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21373This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21374used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21375
21376
21377.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21378.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21379When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21380exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21381accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21382
21383
21384.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21385.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21386.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21387If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21388number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21389followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21390external source that maintains the data.
21391
21392
21393.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21394.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21395.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21396If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21397size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21398This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21399maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21400it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21401
21402
21403
21404.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21405.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21406If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21407file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21408transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21409&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21410&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21411directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21412SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21413&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21414
21415
21416.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21417.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21418.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21419This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21420a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21421directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21422calculation. The default value is:
21423.code
21424maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21425.endd
21426This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21427(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21428&_Trash_&
21429folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21430.code
21431maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21432.endd
21433This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21434directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21435calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21436directly into that directory.
21437
21438
21439.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21440This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21441&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21442
21443
21444.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21445This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21446section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21447
21448
21449.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21450.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21451The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21452If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21453creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21454quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21455value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21456&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21457
21458.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21459.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21460.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21461The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21462effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21463matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21464containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21465delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21466&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21467See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21468
21469
21470.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21471.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21472If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21473new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21474SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21475below for further details.
21476
21477
21478.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21479This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21480section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21481
21482
21483.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21484This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21485section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21486
21487
21488.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21489.cindex "locking files"
21490.cindex "file" "locking"
21491.cindex "file" "MBX format"
21492.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21493This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21494set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21495the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21496traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21497IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21498
21499&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21500automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21501empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21502combination:
21503.code
21504mbx_format = true
21505message_prefix =
21506message_suffix =
21507.endd
21508If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21509&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21510is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21511&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21512interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21513should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21514going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21515mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21516
21517If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21518the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21519(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21520append messages to it.
21521
21522
21523.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21524.cindex "&""From""& line"
21525The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21526The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21527in which case it is:
21528.code
21529message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21530 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21531.endd
21532&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21533&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21534
21535.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21536The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21537The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21538in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21539setting
21540.code
21541message_suffix =
21542.endd
21543&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21544&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21545
21546.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21547If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21548has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21549permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21550if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21551a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21552value, and this option is ignored.
21553
21554
21555.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21556This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21557mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21558true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21559continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21560
21561
21562.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21563If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21564successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21565on users about incoming mail.
21566
21567
21568.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21569.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21570This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21571or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21572is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21573all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21574individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21575&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21576have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21577
21578As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21579multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21580For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21581
21582A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21583may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21584If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21585become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21586Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21587the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21588
21589The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21590(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21591for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21592large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21593be handled.
21594
21595&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21596
21597The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21598the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21599be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21600fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21601system quota failures.
21602
21603By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21604mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21605last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21606during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21607refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21608message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21609changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21610for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21611continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21612delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21613
21614
21615.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21616This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21617into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21618called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21619delivery directory.
21620
21621
21622.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21623This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21624number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21625can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21626failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21627&"no quota"&.
21628
21629
21630.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21631See &%quota%& above.
21632
21633
21634.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21635This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21636for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21637these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21638If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21639captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21640file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21641
21642This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21643&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21644facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21645the file length to the file name. For example:
21646.code
21647maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21648quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21649.endd
21650An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21651number of lines in the message.
21652
21653The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21654file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21655sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21656
21657Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21658
21659
21660.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21661See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21662&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21663.code
21664quota_warn_message = "\
21665 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21666 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21667 This message is automatically created \
21668 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21669 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21670 a warning threshold that is\n\
21671 set by the system administrator.\n"
21672.endd
21673
21674
21675.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21676.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21677.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21678.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21679This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21680resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21681size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21682threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21683may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21684sign. For example:
21685.code
21686quota = 10M
21687quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21688.endd
21689If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21690percent sign is ignored.
21691
21692The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21693and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21694warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21695the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21696can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21697&'From:'& line, the default is:
21698.code
21699From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21700.endd
21701.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21702If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21703option.
21704
21705The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21706are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21707percentage.
21708
21709
21710.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21711.cindex "envelope sender"
21712If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21713format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21714you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21715so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21716for details of batch SMTP.
21717
21718
21719.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21720.cindex "carriage return"
21721.cindex "linefeed"
21722This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21723(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21724of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21725of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21726
21727&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21728(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21729in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21730carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21731have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21732changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21733
21734
21735.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21736This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21737exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21738&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21739that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21740&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21741
21742
21743.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21744This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21745the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21746&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21747each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21748
21749This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21750&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21751where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21752both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21753
21754.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21755Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21756have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21757&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21758the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21759error.
21760
21761&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21762is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21763
21764
21765.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21766If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21767appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21768&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21769sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21770&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21771delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21772
21773.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21774In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21775necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21776achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21777file corruption.
21778
21779The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21780It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21781except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21782
21783
21784.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21785This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21786set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21787locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21788of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21789are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21790the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21791rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21792does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21793
21794You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21795&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21796MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21797without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21798
21799
21800
21801
21802.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21803.cindex "appending to a file"
21804.cindex "file" "appending"
21805Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21806
21807.ilist
21808If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21809return is given.
21810
21811.next
21812.cindex "directory creation"
21813If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21814&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21815&%directory_mode%& option.
21816
21817.next
21818If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21819indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21820transport.
21821
21822.next
21823.cindex "file" "locking"
21824.cindex "locking files"
21825.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21826If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21827reliably over NFS, as follows:
21828
21829.olist
21830Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21831current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21832as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21833.next
21834Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21835.next
21836If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21837Unlink the hitching post name.
21838.next
21839Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21840then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21841of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21842restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21843.next
21844If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21845up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21846mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21847lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21848existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21849it before trying again.
21850.endlist olist
21851
21852.next
21853A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21854so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21855than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21856
21857.next
21858.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21859.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21860If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21861&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21862checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21863is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21864ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21865directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21866idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21867checked.
21868
21869.next
21870If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21871and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21872different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21873delivery is deferred.
21874
21875.next
21876If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21877If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21878is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21879permissions.
21880
21881.next
21882The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21883If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21884hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21885
21886.next
21887If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21888changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21889have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21890
21891.next
21892If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21893option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21894directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21895open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21896except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21897set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21898the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21899that prevents link following.
21900
21901.next
21902.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21903If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21904existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21905being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21906after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21907
21908.next
21909If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21910
21911.next
21912.cindex "file" "locking"
21913.cindex "locking files"
21914Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21915are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21916&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21917However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21918file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21919.code
21920/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21921.endd
21922using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21923the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21924the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21925
21926If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21927depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21928&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21929
21930If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21931&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21932to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21933delivery is deferred.
21934
21935If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21936&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21937waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21938immediately. It retries up to
21939.code
21940(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21941.endd
21942times (rounded up).
21943.endlist
21944
21945At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21946and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21947
21948
21949.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21950.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21951.cindex "&""From""& line"
21952When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21953delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21954activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21955&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21956router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21957configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21958ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21959
21960No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21961locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21962separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21963of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21964newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21965&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21966any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21967
21968If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21969the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21970different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21971deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21972
21973
21974.cindex "maildir format"
21975.cindex "mailstore format"
21976There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21977done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21978&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21979formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21980SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21981
21982.cindex "directory creation"
21983In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21984sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21985option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21986constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21987the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21988&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21989deferred.
21990
21991
21992
21993.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21994.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21995If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21996it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21997directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21998directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21999&_new_& subdirectory.
22000
22001In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22002<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22003Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22004before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22005file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22006opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22007Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22008
22009Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22010called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22011do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22012path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22013&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22014contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22015&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22016&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22017
22018These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22019and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22020folders. Consider this example:
22021.code
22022maildir_format = true
22023directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22024 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22025 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22026maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22027.endd
22028If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22029delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22030the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22031not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22032&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22033&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22034
22035However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22036delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22037does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22038&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22039directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22040
22041&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22042not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22043&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22044
22045.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22046.cindex "maildir++"
22047If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22048&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22049the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22050Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22051down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22052the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22053amount of space used.
22054
22055One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22056computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22057checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22058needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22059use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22060of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22061
22062
22063
22064
22065.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22066If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22067When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22068tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22069name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22070the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22071
22072
22073.vindex "&$message_size$&"
22074Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22075&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22076happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22077variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22078forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22079be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22080Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22081empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22082colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22083maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22084backwards compatibility).
22085
22086For one common implementation, you might set:
22087.code
22088maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22089.endd
22090but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22091
22092It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22093as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22094&[stat()]& each message file.
22095
22096
22097.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22098.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22099.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22100If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22101storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22102within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22103creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22104the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22105to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22106
22107The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22108messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22109in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22110value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22111is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22112need to know the quota.
22113
22114If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22115file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22116
22117A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22118maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22119See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22120details.
22121
22122
22123.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22124.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22125If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22126files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22127message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22128this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22129contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22130itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22131
22132During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22133&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22134&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22135mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22136file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22137the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22138
22139The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22140option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22141the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22142There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22143greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22144appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22145
22146If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22147failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22148configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22149&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22150
22151
22152.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22153If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22154file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22155messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22156section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22157.code
22158directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22159.endd
22160might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22161then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22162expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22163.ecindex IIDapptra1
22164.ecindex IIDapptra2
22165
22166
22167
22168
22169
22170
22171. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22172. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22173
22174.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22175.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22176.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22177The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22178the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22179automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22180&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22181to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22182
22183If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22184&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22185delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22186that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22187another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22188
22189
22190The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22191&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22192directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22193message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22194empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22195
22196The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22197by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22198passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22199transport is run as a consequence of a
22200&%mail%&
22201or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22202supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22203that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22204case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22205is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22206&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22207
22208&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22209command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22210gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22211&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22212
22213There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22214that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22215&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22216address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22217separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22218the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22219message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22220
22221Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22222message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22223immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22224the transport defers.
22225Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22226controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22227
22228If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22229&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22230of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22231&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22232
22233.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22234If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22235the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22236as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22237is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22238problems. They are just discarded.
22239
22240
22241
22242.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22243.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22244
22245.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22246This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22247message when the message is specified by the transport.
22248
22249
22250.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22251This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22252when the message is specified by the transport.
22253
22254
22255.option file autoreply string&!! unset
22256The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22257is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22258string comes first.
22259
22260
22261.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22262If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22263subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22264
22265
22266.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22267If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22268option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22269
22270
22271.option from autoreply string&!! unset
22272This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22273specified by the transport.
22274
22275
22276.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22277This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22278when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22279&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22280
22281
22282.option log autoreply string&!! unset
22283This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22284the message is specified by the transport.
22285
22286
22287.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22288If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22289used.
22290
22291
22292.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22293If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22294item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22295discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22296generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22297
22298
22299
22300.option once autoreply string&!! unset
22301This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22302recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22303This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22304
22305If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22306By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22307is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22308However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22309message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22310this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22311prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22312infinity.
22313
22314If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22315and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22316greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22317Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22318regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22319
22320In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22321which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22322be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22323means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22324unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22325file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22326
22327
22328.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22329See &%once%& above.
22330
22331
22332.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22333See &%once%& above.
22334After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22335
22336
22337.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22338This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22339specified by the transport.
22340
22341
22342.option return_message autoreply boolean false
22343If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22344message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22345configuration option.
22346
22347
22348.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22349This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22350specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22351automatic responses. For example:
22352.code
22353subject = Re: $h_subject:
22354.endd
22355There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22356subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22357bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22358non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22359small.
22360
22361
22362
22363.option text autoreply string&!! unset
22364This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22365message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22366the text comes first.
22367
22368
22369.option to autoreply string&!! unset
22370This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22371when the message is specified by the transport.
22372.ecindex IIDauttra1
22373.ecindex IIDauttra2
22374
22375
22376
22377
22378. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22379. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22380
22381.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22382.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22383.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22384.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22385.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22386The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22387specified command
22388or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22389This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22390transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22391implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22392to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22393has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22394.code
22395TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22396.endd
22397.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22398is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22399included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22400as follows:
22401
22402.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22403See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22404
22405
22406.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22407This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22408Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22409good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22410batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22411
22412
22413.option command lmtp string&!! unset
22414This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22415is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22416arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22417number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22418is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22419LMTP protocol.
22420
22421.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22422.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22423If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22424commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22425in its response to the LHLO command.
22426
22427.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22428This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22429be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22430delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22431
22432
22433.option timeout lmtp time 5m
22434The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22435respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22436is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22437LMTP transport:
22438.code
22439lmtp:
22440 driver = lmtp
22441 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22442 batch_max = 20
22443 user = exim
22444.endd
22445This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22446necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22447
22448
22449
22450. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22451. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22452
22453.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22454.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22455.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22456The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22457running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22458pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22459(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22460their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22461following ways:
22462
22463.ilist
22464.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22465A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22466transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22467contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22468is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22469.next
22470.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22471If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22472transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22473more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22474(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22475(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22476that are routed to the transport.
22477.next
22478.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22479A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22480alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22481pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22482&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22483(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22484this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22485.endlist
22486
22487
22488The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22489deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22490implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22491
22492In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22493&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22494other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22495transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22496directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22497details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22498for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22499
22500
22501.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22502If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22503delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22504any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22505write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22506.new
22507Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
22508of "1" to enforce serialization.
22509.wen
22510
22511
22512
22513
22514.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22515.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22516If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22517have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22518the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22519in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22520later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22521logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22522&"local delivery failed"&.
22523
22524If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22525the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22526will be sent as normal.
22527
22528If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22529script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22530value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22531apply in this case.
22532
22533If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22534return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22535asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22536a non-existent command may be the problem.
22537
22538The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22539set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22540error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22541return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22542included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22543similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22544failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22545&%temp_errors%&.
22546
22547
22548
22549.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22550.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22551The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22552by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22553&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22554run.
22555
22556.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22557Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22558double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22559way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22560
22561String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22562traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22563expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22564For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22565quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22566.code
22567command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22568.endd
22569will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22570arguments. You have to write
22571.code
22572command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22573.endd
22574to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22575argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22576result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22577interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22578generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22579expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22580example:
22581.code
22582command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22583.endd
22584
22585.cindex "transport" "filter"
22586.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22587.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22588Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22589&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22590place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22591transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22592inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22593avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22594&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22595
22596If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22597for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22598is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22599argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22600&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22601the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22602should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22603run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22604
22605After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22606in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22607message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22608standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22609read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22610may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22611control what is done with it.
22612
22613Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22614in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22615taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22616explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22617where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22618under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22619an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22620works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22621as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22622&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22623with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22624
22625
22626
22627.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22628.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22629.cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22630The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22631This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22632the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22633environment.
22634.display
22635&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22636&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22637&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22638&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22639&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22640&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22641&`LOGNAME `& see below
22642&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22643&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22644&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22645&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22646&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22647&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22648&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22649&`USER `& see below
22650.endd
22651When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22652router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22653called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22654the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22655removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22656LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22657same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22658
22659.cindex "HOST"
22660HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22661associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22662pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22663the router.
22664
22665.cindex "HOME"
22666If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22667for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22668by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22669user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22670
22671
22672.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22673.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22674
22675
22676
22677.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22678.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22679The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22680permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22681permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22682paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22683&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22684in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22685the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22686&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22687otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22688example, if
22689.code
22690allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22691.endd
22692and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22693&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22694&%use_shell%& is set.
22695
22696
22697.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22698See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22699
22700
22701.option batch_max pipe integer 1
22702This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22703See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22704
22705
22706.option check_string pipe string unset
22707As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22708&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22709by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22710&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22711any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22712of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22713the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22714ignored.
22715
22716
22717.option command pipe string&!! unset
22718This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22719obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22720set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22721the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22722Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22723&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22724
22725
22726.option environment pipe string&!! unset
22727.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22728.cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22729This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22730command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22731a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22732environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22733
22734
22735.option escape_string pipe string unset
22736See &%check_string%& above.
22737
22738
22739.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22740.cindex "exec failure"
22741.cindex "failure of exec"
22742.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22743Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22744any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22745is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22746frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22747
22748
22749.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22750.cindex "signal exit"
22751.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22752Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22753a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22754frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22755
22756
22757.option force_command pipe boolean false
22758.cindex "force command"
22759.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22760Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22761the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22762is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22763useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22764command. For example:
22765.code
22766command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22767force_command
22768.endd
22769
22770Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22771&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22772separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22773
22774
22775.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22776If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22777run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22778Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22779from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22780&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22781
22782&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22783See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22784
22785
22786.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22787.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22788If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22789one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22790and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
22791written to the main log.
22792
22793
22794.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22795If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
22796stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
22797the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
22798failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
22799option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
22800be set.
22801
22802
22803.option log_output pipe boolean false
22804If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
22805stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
22806the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
22807exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22808
22809
22810.option max_output pipe integer 20K
22811This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22812standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22813process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22814catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22815the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22816&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22817exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22818
22819
22820.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22821The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22822The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22823.code
22824message_prefix = \
22825 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22826 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22827.endd
22828.cindex "Cyrus"
22829.cindex "&%tmail%&"
22830.cindex "&""From""& line"
22831This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22832However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22833or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22834setting
22835.code
22836message_prefix =
22837.endd
22838&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22839&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22840
22841
22842.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22843The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22844The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22845The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22846.code
22847message_suffix =
22848.endd
22849&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22850&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22851
22852
22853.option path pipe string "see below"
22854This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22855variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22856.code
22857/bin:/usr/bin
22858.endd
22859If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22860sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22861apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22862
22863
22864.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22865Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22866a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22867during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22868It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22869for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22870resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22871installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22872of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22873
22874
22875.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22876.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22877If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22878process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22879to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22880&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22881accept the message is used.
22882
22883
22884.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22885When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22886contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22887in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22888command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22889handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22890
22891
22892.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22893If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22894return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22895is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22896However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22897message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22898&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22899
22900
22901
22902.option return_output pipe boolean false
22903If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22904deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22905is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22906However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22907output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22908option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22909of them may be set.
22910
22911
22912
22913.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22914.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22915This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22916asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22917and &%return_output%& is not set,
22918and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22919temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22920numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22921codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22922defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22923compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22924and 73, respectively.
22925
22926
22927.option timeout pipe time 1h
22928If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22929causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22930specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22931command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22932and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22933if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22934
22935.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22936A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22937runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22938treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22939is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22940delivery to be deferred.
22941
22942.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22943This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22944
22945
22946.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22947.cindex "envelope sender"
22948If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22949SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22950commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22951you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22952&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22953
22954.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22955.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22956This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22957BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22958resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22959limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22960class database.
22961
22962
22963.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22964.cindex "carriage return"
22965.cindex "linefeed"
22966This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22967(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22968of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22969of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22970
22971The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22972written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22973are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22974&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22975values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22976
22977
22978.option use_shell pipe boolean false
22979.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22980If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22981instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22982&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22983where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22984modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22985&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22986command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22987its &%-c%& option.
22988
22989
22990
22991.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22992.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22993.cindex "&'procmail'&"
22994.cindex "external local delivery"
22995.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22996.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22997The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22998delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22999this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23000uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23001by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23002necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23003appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23004configuration for &%procmail%&:
23005.code
23006# transport
23007procmail_pipe:
23008 driver = pipe
23009 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23010 return_path_add
23011 delivery_date_add
23012 envelope_to_add
23013 check_string = "From "
23014 escape_string = ">From "
23015 umask = 077
23016 user = $local_part
23017 group = mail
23018
23019# router
23020procmail:
23021 driver = accept
23022 check_local_user
23023 transport = procmail_pipe
23024.endd
23025In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23026&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23027or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23028user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23029&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23030home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23031
23032&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23033.code
23034IFS=" "
23035.endd
23036as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23037use a shell to run pipe commands.
23038
23039.cindex "Cyrus"
23040The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23041deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23042.code
23043# transport
23044local_delivery_cyrus:
23045 driver = pipe
23046 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23047 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23048 user = cyrus
23049 group = mail
23050 return_output
23051 log_output
23052 message_prefix =
23053 message_suffix =
23054
23055# router
23056local_user_cyrus:
23057 driver = accept
23058 check_local_user
23059 local_part_suffix = .*
23060 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23061.endd
23062Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23063&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23064sender.
23065.ecindex IIDpiptra1
23066.ecindex IIDpiptra2
23067
23068
23069. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23070. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23071
23072.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23073.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23074.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23075The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23076or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23077that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23078explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23079&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23080
23081
23082.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23083The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23084two ways:
23085
23086.ilist
23087If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23088routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23089that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23090the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23091does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23092value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23093section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23094.next
23095.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23096When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23097looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23098connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23099for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23100process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23101process.
23102.endlist
23103
23104
23105For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23106incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23107no further messages are sent over that connection.
23108
23109
23110
23111.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23112.vindex "&$host$&"
23113.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23114At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23115&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23116passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23117specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23118&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23119that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23120&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23121
23122
23123.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23124.vindex &$tls_bits$&
23125.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23126.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23127.vindex &$tls_sni$&
23128At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23129&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23130are the values that were set when the message was received.
23131These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23132SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23133variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23134appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23135are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23136&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23137
23138These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23139and will be removed in a future release.
23140
23141
23142.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23143.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23144The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23145
23146
23147.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23148.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23149When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23150is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23151runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23152reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23153setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23154problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23155
23156.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23157.cindex "local host" "sending to"
23158.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23159When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23160to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23161deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23162the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23163configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23164configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23165
23166
23167.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23168.cindex "Cyrus"
23169When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23170is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23171overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23172forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23173to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23174ignored.
23175
23176The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23177started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23178&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23179particular connection.
23180
23181If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23182&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23183deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23184unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23185
23186This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23187deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23188&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23189.code
23190authenticated_sender = $local_part
23191.endd
23192This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23193allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23194
23195Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23196domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23197value.
23198
23199
23200.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23201If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23202is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23203authenticated as a client.
23204
23205
23206.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23207This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23208sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23209remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23210
23211
23212.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23213This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23214to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23215several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23216less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23217systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23218option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23219
23220
23221.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23222.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23223.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23224.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23225This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23226over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23227For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23228option.
23229
23230
23231.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23232This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23233the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23234of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23235
23236
23237.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23238This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23239domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23240cutoff times.
23241
23242In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23243them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23244Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23245retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23246a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23247unhappy at this prospect, so...
23248
23249If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23250addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23251IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23252none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23253delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23254addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23255continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23256&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23257to them.
23258
23259
23260.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23261If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23262and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23263the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23264in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23265
23266
23267.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23268If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23269&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23270See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23271details.
23272
23273
23274.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23275.cindex "MX record" "security"
23276.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23277.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23278.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23279DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23280the dnssec request bit set.
23281This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23282
23283
23284
23285.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23286.cindex "MX record" "security"
23287.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23288.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23289.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23290DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23291the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23292(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23293This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23294
23295
23296
23297.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23298.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23299This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23300of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23301The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23302Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23303&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23304
23305The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23306(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23307that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23308equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23309Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23310
23311
23312.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23313.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23314String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23315colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23316port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23317&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23318item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23319in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23320
23321Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23322addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23323&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23324not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23325&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23326However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23327
23328If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23329the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23330transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23331address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23332list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23333
23334Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23335re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23336addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23337copy of the message is sent.
23338
23339The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23340&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23341both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23342from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23343fails"& facility.
23344
23345
23346.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23347This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23348line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23349zero.
23350
23351.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23352If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23353being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23354(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23355instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23356it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23357
23358.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23359This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23360server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23361implementations of TLS.
23362
23363.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23364.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23365.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23366.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23367The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23368been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23369command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23370option is:
23371.code
23372$primary_hostname
23373.endd
23374During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23375the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23376&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23377used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23378servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23379that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23380interface address, you could use this:
23381.code
23382helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23383 {$primary_hostname}}
23384.endd
23385The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23386callouts.
23387
23388.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23389Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23390finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23391&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23392email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23393all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23394
23395The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23396processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23397&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23398&%hosts_override%& is set.
23399
23400The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23401list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23402separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23403&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23404item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23405in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23406of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23407
23408If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23409the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23410well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23411address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23412&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23413&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23414that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23415address are used.
23416
23417During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23418unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23419
23420
23421.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23422.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23423.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23424.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23425.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23426This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23427example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23428matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23429start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23430facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23431
23432
23433.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23434.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23435Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23436that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23437
23438
23439.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23440.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23441Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23442matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23443
23444.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23445.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23446Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23447or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23448to any host that matches this list.
23449
23450
23451.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23452.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23453.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23454.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23455.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23456This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23457delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23458&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23459
23460
23461.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23462This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23463tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23464why it exists.
23465
23466
23467
23468.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23469.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23470.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23471.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23472For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23473been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23474message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23475explanation of when this might be needed.
23476
23477
23478.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23479If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23480attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23481&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23482&%fallback_hosts%&.
23483
23484
23485.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23486.cindex "randomized host list"
23487.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23488.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23489If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23490&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23491were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23492router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23493is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23494list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23495
23496When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23497order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23498behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23499&`+`& in the host list. For example:
23500.code
23501hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23502.endd
23503The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23504randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23505If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23506
23507.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23508.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23509This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23510before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23511servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23512authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23513temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23514hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23515&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23516
23517
23518.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23519.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23520Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23521TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23522&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23523
23524.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23525.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23526Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23527TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23528&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23529
23530.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23531.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23532Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23533matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23534&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23535incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23536
23537.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23538.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23539This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23540authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23541connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23542unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23543&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23544
23545.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23546.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23547This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23548PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23549for multi-recipient messages.
23550The option can usually be left as default.
23551
23552.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23553.cindex "bind IP address"
23554.cindex "IP address" "binding"
23555.vindex "&$host$&"
23556.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23557This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23558call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23559&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23560message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23561&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23562outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23563interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23564unknown.
23565
23566During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23567&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23568during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23569string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23570string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23571separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23572.code
23573interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23574.endd
23575The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23576connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23577&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23578interface to use if the host has more than one.
23579
23580
23581.option keepalive smtp boolean true
23582.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23583This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23584connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23585periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23586of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23587or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23588that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23589that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23590TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23591unreachable hosts.
23592
23593
23594.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23595.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23596If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23597string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23598has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23599
23600.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23601.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23602This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23603SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23604so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23605permits this.
23606
23607
23608.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23609.vindex "&$domain$&"
23610When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23611addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23612to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23613handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23614&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23615is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23616
23617It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23618&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23619&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23620
23621.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23622.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23623.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23624This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23625&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23626received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23627The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23628variable that contains an outgoing port.
23629
23630If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23631otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23632normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23633&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23634is deferred.
23635
23636
23637
23638.option protocol smtp string smtp
23639.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23640.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23641.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23642.vindex "&$port$&"
23643If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23644the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23645protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23646deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23647over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23648
23649If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23650changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23651connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23652The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23653
23654
23655.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23656Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23657constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23658means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23659tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23660addresses is not affected.
23661
23662However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23663each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23664the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23665Exim to use only the host name.
23666Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23667
23668
23669.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23670.cindex "serializing connections"
23671.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23672Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23673host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23674the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23675slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23676Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23677&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23678
23679.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23680Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23681written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23682is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23683records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23684guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23685
23686If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23687relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23688start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23689may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23690are used for ETRN serialization.
23691
23692.new
23693See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
23694.wen
23695
23696
23697.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23698.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23699.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23700.cindex "size" "of message"
23701.cindex "transport" "filter"
23702.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23703If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23704MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23705an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23706sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23707configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23708this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23709
23710Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23711the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23712
23713
23714.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23715.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23716.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23717.vindex "&$host$&"
23718.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23719The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23720client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23721connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23722address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23723details of TLS.
23724
23725&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23726certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23727name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23728assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23729client.
23730
23731
23732.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23733.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23734.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23735This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23736be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23737
23738
23739.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23740.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23741When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23742key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23743for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23744If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23745will fail.
23746
23747Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23748
23749
23750.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23751.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23752.vindex "&$host$&"
23753.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23754The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23755client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23756connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23757&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23758expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23759result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23760the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23761
23762
23763.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23764.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23765.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23766.vindex "&$host$&"
23767.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23768The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23769when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23770the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23771&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23772expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23773is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23774&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23775ciphers is a preference order.
23776
23777
23778
23779.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23780.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23781.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23782If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23783TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23784the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23785certificate and private key for the session.
23786
23787See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23788
23789Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23790TLS extensions.
23791
23792
23793
23794
23795.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23796.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23797When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23798setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23799to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23800current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23801option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23802response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23803TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23804unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23805in clear.
23806
23807
23808.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23809.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23810.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23811This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23812certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23813The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23814Note that unless the host is in this list
23815TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23816when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23817The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23818certificate verification succeeds.
23819
23820
23821.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23822.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23823.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23824This option give a list of hosts for which,
23825while verifying the server certificate,
23826checks will be included on the host name
23827(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23828versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23829limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23830
23831There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23832
23833
23834.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23835.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23836.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23837.vindex "&$host$&"
23838.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23839The value of this option must be either the
23840word "system"
23841or the absolute path to
23842a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23843for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23844
23845The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23846This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23847is taken as empty and an explicit location
23848must be specified.
23849
23850The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
23851preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23852
23853With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23854explicitly
23855either by file or directory
23856are added to those given by the system default location.
23857
23858The values of &$host$& and
23859&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23860expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23861
23862For back-compatibility,
23863if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23864(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23865and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23866
23867
23868.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23869.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23870.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23871This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23872certificate verification must succeed.
23873The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23874If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23875operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23876
23877
23878
23879
23880.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23881 "SECTvalhosmax"
23882.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23883.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23884There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23885tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23886&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23887
23888
23889The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23890for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23891option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23892multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23893retrying.
23894
23895Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23896multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23897created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23898
23899Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23900several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23901problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23902&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23903delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23904
23905Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23906arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23907limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23908some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23909&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23910that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23911see below for an exception).
23912
23913Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23914list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23915If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23916but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23917that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23918
23919Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23920higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23921hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23922which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23923tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23924reached their retry times.
23925
23926However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23927large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23928Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23929of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23930time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23931without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23932all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23933there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23934the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23935every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23936reached.
23937
23938The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23939particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23940out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23941reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23942been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23943take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23944
23945The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23946Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23947and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23948possible IP addresses have been tried.
23949.ecindex IIDsmttra1
23950.ecindex IIDsmttra2
23951
23952
23953
23954
23955
23956. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23957. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23958
23959.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23960.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23961There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23962addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23963(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23964abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23965
23966Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23967messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23968&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23969appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23970locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23971unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23972lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23973
23974One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23975when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23976such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23977do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23978
23979
23980.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23981This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23982main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23983&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23984
23985Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23986Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23987facility; you do not have to use it.
23988
23989The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23990configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23991addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23992address to which it applies.
23993
23994Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23995the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23996rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23997those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23998by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23999are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24000rules.
24001
24002Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24003applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24004well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24005headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24006
24007
24008In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24009legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24010in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24011used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24012Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24013discouraged.
24014
24015There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24016illustrated by these examples:
24017
24018.ilist
24019The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24020exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24021gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24022&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24023.next
24024A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24025&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24026.endlist
24027
24028
24029
24030.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24031.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24032.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24033Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24034message's processing.
24035
24036.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24037At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24038by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24039ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24040is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24041rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24042rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24043RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24044rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24045
24046.vindex "&$domain$&"
24047.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24048Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24049may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24050rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24051from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24052for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24053value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24054as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24055SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24056
24057As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24058recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24059the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24060any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24061.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24062before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24063
24064When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24065rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24066redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24067
24068.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24069.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24070.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24071At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24072specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24073This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24074section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24075header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24076applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24077
24078The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24079transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24080transport time.
24081
24082
24083
24084
24085.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24086.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24087.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24088Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24089configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
24090&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
240912822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
24092transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
24093appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
24094envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
24095.code
24096exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
24097.endd
24098might produce the output
24099.code
24100sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24101from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24102to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24103cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24104bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24105reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24106env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24107env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24108.endd
24109which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24110the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24111present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24112set for a particular transport.
24113
24114
24115.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24116.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24117The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24118rules in the form
24119.display
24120<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24121.endd
24122Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24123transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24124takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24125any colons must be doubled, of course).
24126
24127The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24128Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24129case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24130characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24131ignored.
24132
24133For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24134order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24135replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24136
24137The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24138releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24139received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24140lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24141address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24142(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24143that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24144
24145.vindex "&$domain$&"
24146.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24147The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24148string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24149rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24150.code
24151*@* ${lookup ...
24152.endd
24153where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24154refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24155
24156
24157.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24158.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24159.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24160The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24161address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24162single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24163against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24164you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24165facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24166
24167Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24168case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24169can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24170
24171.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24172After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24173depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24174replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24175refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24176numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24177of pattern they are set as follows:
24178
24179.ilist
24180If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24181refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24182the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24183pattern
24184.code
24185*queen@*.fict.example
24186.endd
24187is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24188.code
24189$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24190$1 = hearts-
24191$2 = wonderland
24192.endd
24193Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24194does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24195
24196.next
24197If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24198of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24199for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24200rewriting rule of the form
24201.display
24202&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24203.endd
24204and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24205.code
24206$1 = foo
24207$2 = bar
24208$3 = baz.example
24209.endd
24210If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24211wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24212&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24213partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24214whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24215.endlist
24216
24217
24218.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24219.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24220If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24221match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24222rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24223.code
24224hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24225.endd
24226specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24227&'From:'& headers.
24228
24229.vindex "&$domain$&"
24230.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24231If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24232yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24233&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24234Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24235cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24236matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24237the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24238current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24239expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24240entry written to the panic log.
24241
24242
24243
24244.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24245There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24246
24247.ilist
24248Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24249c, f, h, r, s, t.
24250.next
24251A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24252.next
24253Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24254.endlist
24255
24256For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24257E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24258
24259
24260
24261.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24262 "SECID154"
24263.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24264If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24265&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24266and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24267transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24268rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24269.display
24270&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24271&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24272&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24273&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24274&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24275&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24276&`h`& rewrite all headers
24277&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24278&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24279&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24280.endd
24281"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24282individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24283other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24284
24285You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24286restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24287
24288
24289.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24290.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24291.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24292.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24293The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24294SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24295before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24296required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24297data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24298
24299.vindex "&$domain$&"
24300.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24301This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24302compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24303input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24304the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24305expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24306original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24307
24308
24309.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24310There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24311take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24312correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24313
24314.ilist
24315If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24316unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24317absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24318.next
24319If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24320even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24321expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24322(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24323.next
24324The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24325address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24326rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24327.next
24328.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24329When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24330to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24331left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24332.code
24333From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24334.endd
24335into
24336.code
24337From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24338.endd
24339.cindex "RFC 2047"
24340Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24341done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24342causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24343replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
243442822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24345brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24346(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24347is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24348
24349When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24350rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24351.endlist
24352
24353
24354.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24355Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24356.code
24357*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24358*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24359 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24360.endd
24361Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24362the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24363has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24364consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24365present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24366explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24367at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24368error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24369
24370The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24371domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24372.code
24373root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24374.endd
24375were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24376local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24377
24378Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24379&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24380messages that originate outside the local host:
24381.code
24382*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24383 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24384.endd
24385The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24386space.
24387
24388.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24389.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24390Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24391an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24392the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24393remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24394sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24395components. For example, the rule
24396.code
24397\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24398.endd
24399rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24400&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24401a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24402method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24403to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24404use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24405can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24406.ecindex IIDaddrew
24407
24408
24409
24410
24411
24412. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24413. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24414
24415.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24416.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24417.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24418The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24419retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24420be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24421empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24422errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24423general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24424line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24425address, domain and error.
24426
24427The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24428host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24429Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24430address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24431been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24432tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24433log selector is set, the message
24434.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24435&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24436skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24437the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24438
24439Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24440in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24441actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24442failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24443the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24444added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24445same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24446domain are maintained independently.
24447
24448When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24449receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24450always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24451behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24452quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24453suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24454subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24455the local address is reached.
24456
24457.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24458If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24459whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24460files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24461always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24462
24463The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24464rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24465record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24466timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24467and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24468messages that it should now be retaining.
24469
24470
24471
24472.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24473.cindex "retry" "rules"
24474Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24475separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24476addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24477enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24478in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24479present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24480message's sender, respectively.
24481
24482
24483The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24484&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24485which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24486has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24487list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24488which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24489example,
24490.code
24491lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24492.endd
24493provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24494whereas
24495.code
24496alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24497.endd
24498applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24499In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24500part.
24501
24502.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24503&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24504must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24505expressions work in address lists.
24506.display
24507&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24508&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24509.endd
24510
24511
24512.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24513When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24514example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24515against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24516router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24517regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24518A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24519&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24520&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24521
24522Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24523failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24524configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24525&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24526local transports).
24527
24528.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24529However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24530suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24531whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24532rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24533failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24534recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24535reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24536&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24537lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24538commands.
24539
24540
24541
24542.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24543 "SECID160"
24544For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24545example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24546twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24547&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24548the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24549suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24550.code
24551a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24552 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24553 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24554.endd
24555and the retry rules are
24556.code
24557p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24558a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24559.endd
24560and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24561first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24562rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24563to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24564tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24565first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24566
24567In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24568first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24569&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24570routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24571
24572&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24573However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24574host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24575.code
24576route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24577.endd
24578then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24579textual form of the IP address.
24580
24581.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24582.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24583The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24584asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24585
24586.vlist
24587.vitem &%auth_failed%&
24588Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24589&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24590
24591.vitem &%data_4xx%&
24592A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24593after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24594
24595.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24596A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24597
24598.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24599A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24600.endlist
24601
24602For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24603as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24604recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24605and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24606retry rule of this form:
24607.code
24608the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24609.endd
24610These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24611LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24612
24613.vlist
24614.vitem &%lost_connection%&
24615A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24616legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24617for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24618
24619.vitem &%lookup%&
24620A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24621Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24622its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24623Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24624its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24625
24626.vitem &%refused_MX%&
24627A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24628
24629.vitem &%refused_A%&
24630A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24631
24632.vitem &%refused%&
24633A connection was refused.
24634
24635.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24636A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24637
24638.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24639A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24640
24641.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24642A connection attempt timed out.
24643
24644.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24645There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24646obtained from an MX record.
24647
24648.vitem &%timeout_A%&
24649There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24650obtained from an MX record.
24651
24652.vitem &%timeout%&
24653There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24654
24655.vitem &%tls_required%&
24656The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24657&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24658to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24659
24660.vitem &%quota%&
24661A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24662transport.
24663
24664.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24665.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24666.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24667A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24668transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24669&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24670for four days.
24671.endlist
24672
24673.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24674The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24675timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24676it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24677However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24678heuristic rules:
24679
24680.ilist
24681If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24682used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24683quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24684.next
24685.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24686For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24687subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24688the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24689change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24690MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24691time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24692.next
24693For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24694obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24695.endlist
24696
24697The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24698mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24699when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24700error).
24701
24702
24703
24704.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24705.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24706You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24707specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24708apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24709form:
24710.display
24711&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24712.endd
24713The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24714.code
24715* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24716.endd
24717matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24718host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24719For example:
24720.code
24721a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24722.endd
24723&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24724(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24725only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24726its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24727all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24728
24729When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24730&%-f%& command line option, like this:
24731.code
24732exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24733.endd
24734If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24735list is never matched.
24736
24737
24738
24739
24740
24741.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24742.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24743The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24744sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24745.display
24746<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24747.endd
24748The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24749time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24750arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24751time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24752relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24753
24754.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24755.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24756.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24757.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24758The available algorithms are:
24759
24760.ilist
24761&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24762the interval.
24763.next
24764&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24765specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24766is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24767.next
24768&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24769retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24770maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24771the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24772rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24773members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24774queue processing times.
24775.endlist
24776
24777When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24778order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24779used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24780case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24781current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24782computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24783interval is found. The main configuration variable
24784.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24785.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24786.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24787&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24788cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24789
24790A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24791host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24792basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24793for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24794generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24795time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24796time.
24797
24798.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24799Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24800run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24801starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24802new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24803If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24804occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24805messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24806processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24807your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24808number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24809sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24810
24811The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24812&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24813&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24814&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24815are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24816deliveries that have been deferred.
24817
24818
24819.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24820Here are some example retry rules:
24821.code
24822alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24823wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24824wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24825lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24826* refused_A F,2h,20m;
24827* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24828.endd
24829The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24830&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24831mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24832hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24833parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24834effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24835fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24836days.
24837
24838The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24839happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24840intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24841first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24842so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24843
24844The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24845They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24846all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24847were not obtained from an MX record.
24848
24849The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24850first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24851not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24852hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
248531.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24854
24855
24856
24857.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24858.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24859.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24860.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24861.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24862Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24863consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24864set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24865been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24866arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24867failing for the first time.
24868
24869This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24870backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24871Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24872down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24873
24874If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24875every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24876message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24877
24878
24879
24880
24881.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24882.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24883.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24884Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24885that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24886default retry rule:
24887.code
24888* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24889.endd
24890the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24891long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24892failure for the recipient address that counts.
24893
24894When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24895addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24896causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24897In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24898time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24899
24900For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24901messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24902post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24903
24904If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24905.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24906&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24907default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24908reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24909attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24910those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24911the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24912
24913In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24914for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24915times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24916behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24917to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24918notice.
24919
24920If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24921addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24922addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24923no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24924words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24925addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24926If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24927&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24928deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24929true.
24930
24931.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24932.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24933Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24934intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24935its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24936because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24937host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24938failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24939reached.
24940
24941Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24942applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24943Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24944examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24945commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24946time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24947is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24948time out the address.
24949
24950The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24951the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24952given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24953time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24954not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24955considered immediately.
24956.ecindex IIDretconf1
24957.ecindex IIDregconf2
24958
24959
24960
24961
24962
24963
24964. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24965. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24966
24967.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24968.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24969.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24970The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24971with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24972described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24973to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24974permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24975transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24976other.
24977
24978.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24979Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24980
24981.ilist
24982The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24983the client's EHLO command.
24984.next
24985The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24986may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24987.next
24988The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24989appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24990just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24991any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24992with the AUTH command.
24993.next
24994The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24995.next
24996If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24997option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24998mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24999connection.
25000.next
25001If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25002authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25003unauthenticated connection.
25004.endlist
25005
25006If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25007mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25008SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25009includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25010.display
25011&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25012&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25013&`Connected to server.example.`&
25014&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25015&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25016&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25017&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25018&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25019&`250-PIPELINING`&
25020&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25021&`250 HELP`&
25022.endd
25023The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25024authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25025mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25026routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25027controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25028included by setting
25029.code
25030AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25031AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25032AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25033AUTH_GSASL=yes
25034AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25035AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25036AUTH_SPA=yes
25037AUTH_TLS=yes
25038.endd
25039in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25040authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25041the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25042The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25043work via a socket interface.
25044The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25045provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25046The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25047supporting setting a server keytab.
25048The sixth can be configured to support
25049the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25050not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25051supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25052The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25053instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25054
25055The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25056section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25057authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25058authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25059is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25060messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25061options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25062
25063To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25064&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25065either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25066functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25067to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25068both sets of options, is required. For example:
25069.code
25070cram:
25071 driver = cram_md5
25072 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25073 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25074 client_name = ph10
25075 client_secret = secret2
25076.endd
25077The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25078&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25079
25080Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25081The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25082authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25083in Exim.
25084
25085&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25086per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25087account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25088authenticating data.
25089
25090Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
25091&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
25092and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
25093Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
25094used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
25095second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
25096user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
25097configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
25098&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
25099as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
25100choose to honour.
25101
25102A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25103to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25104mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25105typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25106
25107
25108
25109.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25110.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25111.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25112
25113.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25114When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25115&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25116used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25117encrypted by a setting such as:
25118.code
25119client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25120.endd
25121
25122
25123.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25124When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25125result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25126Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25127
25128
25129.option driver authenticators string unset
25130This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25131authenticators is to be used.
25132
25133
25134.option public_name authenticators string unset
25135This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25136implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25137contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25138but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25139defaults to the driver's instance name.
25140
25141
25142.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25143When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25144is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25145mechanism is not advertised.
25146If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25147forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25148See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25149
25150
25151.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25152This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25153is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25154for details.
25155
25156For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25157mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25158
25159For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25160authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25161authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25162authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25163to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25164error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25165string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25166expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25167other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25168the error text.
25169
25170
25171.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25172If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25173command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25174output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25175out the values of variables.
25176If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25177output, and Exim carries on processing.
25178
25179
25180.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25181.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25182When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25183expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25184messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25185lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25186configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25187refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25188If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25189
25190
25191.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25192This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25193as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25194driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25195as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25196remembered for later use.
25197How it is used is described in the following section.
25198
25199
25200
25201
25202
25203.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25204.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25205.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25206When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25207the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25208message:
25209
25210.ilist
25211If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25212than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25213.next
25214If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25215.next
25216.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25217If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25218running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25219from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25220&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25221return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25222given for the MAIL command.
25223.next
25224If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25225is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25226authenticated.
25227.next
25228If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25229the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25230&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25231valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25232fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25233&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25234the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25235message.
25236.endlist
25237
25238
25239When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25240hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25241&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25242process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25243
25244.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25245Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25246MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25247therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25248value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25249ACL is run.
25250
25251
25252
25253.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25254.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25255When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25256authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25257conditions:
25258
25259.ilist
25260The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25261.next
25262It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25263yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25264.endlist
25265
25266The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25267the mechanisms are advertised.
25268
25269Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25270provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25271even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25272set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25273You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25274For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25275that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25276.code
25277auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25278.endd
25279so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25280
25281The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25282authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25283advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25284such as:
25285.code
25286server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25287.endd
25288.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25289If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25290yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25291
25292When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25293immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25294command. This is the case if
25295
25296.ilist
25297The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25298.next
25299No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25300.next
25301Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25302server authenticators.
25303.endlist
25304
25305
25306Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25307to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25308AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25309
25310If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25311server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25312that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25313the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25314fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25315rejected with a 504 error.
25316
25317.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25318.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25319When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25320&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25321or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25322public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25323client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25324no successful authentication.
25325
25326
25327
25328
25329.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25330.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25331.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25332.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25333Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25334configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25335encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25336script:
25337.code
25338use MIME::Base64;
25339printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25340.endd
25341.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25342This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25343interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25344some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25345command line to run this script on such data might be
25346.code
25347encode '\0user\0password'
25348.endd
25349Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25350backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25351whose code value is zero.
25352
25353&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25354digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25355you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25356interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25357
25358&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25359specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25360example, a command such as
25361.code
25362encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25363.endd
25364gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25365
25366If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25367base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25368.code
25369echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25370.endd
25371The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25372in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25373output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25374should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25375
25376
25377
25378.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25379.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25380The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25381&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25382announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25383of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25384
25385.ilist
25386For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25387they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25388mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25389of the authenticator.
25390.next
25391.vindex "&$host$&"
25392.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25393When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25394variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25395that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25396any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25397Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25398delivery to be deferred.
25399.next
25400If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25401Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25402try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25403usual way.
25404.next
25405If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25406carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25407possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25408no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25409what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25410&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25411delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25412turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25413deliver the message unauthenticated.
25414.endlist
25415
25416.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25417When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25418parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25419the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25420is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25421incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25422allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25423to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25424&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25425&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25426the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25427.ecindex IIDauthconf1
25428.ecindex IIDauthconf2
25429
25430
25431
25432
25433
25434
25435. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25436. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25437
25438.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25439.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25440.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25441The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25442LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25443plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25444security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25445(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25446use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25447connections as you do for login accounts.
25448
25449.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25450.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25451When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25452
25453.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25454This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25455configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25456
25457.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25458The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25459prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25460given.
25461
25462.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25463.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25464.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25465.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25466 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25467.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25468.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25469
25470When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25471expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25472response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25473values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25474a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25475are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25476(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25477
25478For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25479the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25480variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25481string expansions that also use them for other things.
25482
25483If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25484supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25485data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25486
25487.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25488Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25489&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25490authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25491to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25492&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25493expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25494generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25495For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25496string as the error text
25497
25498&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25499password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25500There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25501
25502
25503
25504.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25505.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25506.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25507.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25508The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25509sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25510separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25511subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25512
25513The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25514Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25515configured as follows:
25516.code
25517fixed_plain:
25518 driver = plaintext
25519 public_name = PLAIN
25520 server_prompts = :
25521 server_condition = \
25522 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25523 server_set_id = $auth2
25524.endd
25525Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25526are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25527password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25528or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25529
25530The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25531the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25532AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25533authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25534.code
25535250-AUTH PLAIN
25536.endd
25537and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25538.code
25539AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25540.endd
25541As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25542data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25543.code
25544AUTH PLAIN
25545.endd
25546to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25547prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25548
25549The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25550when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25551represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25552is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25553second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25554
25555Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25556realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25557authenticating clients it could make sense.
25558
25559A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25560&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25561comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25562this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25563This is an incorrect example:
25564.code
25565server_condition = \
25566 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25567.endd
25568The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25569which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25570incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25571non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25572strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25573the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25574name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25575.code
25576server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25577 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25578.endd
25579In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25580fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25581used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25582always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25583writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25584
25585
25586.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25587.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25588.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25589The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25590in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25591user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25592plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25593.code
25594fixed_login:
25595 driver = plaintext
25596 public_name = LOGIN
25597 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25598 server_condition = \
25599 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25600 server_set_id = $auth1
25601.endd
25602Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25603with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25604if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25605strings are used to obtain two data items.
25606
25607Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25608example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25609&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25610strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25611name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25612.code
25613login:
25614 driver = plaintext
25615 public_name = LOGIN
25616 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25617 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25618 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25619 ldapauth{\
25620 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25621 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25622 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25623 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25624.endd
25625We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25626does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25627operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25628&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25629correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25630the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25631uninterpreted string.
25632
25633
25634.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25635A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25636interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25637traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25638Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25639&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25640
25641
25642
25643
25644.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25645.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25646The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25647
25648.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25649If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25650authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25651the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25652usual.
25653
25654.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25655The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25656string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25657string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25658to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25659most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25660with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25661way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25662(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25663so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25664&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25665&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25666
25667&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25668splitting takes priority and happens first.
25669
25670Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25671the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25672there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25673NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25674the string.
25675
25676This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25677authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25678.code
25679fixed_plain:
25680 driver = plaintext
25681 public_name = PLAIN
25682 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25683.endd
25684The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25685command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25686that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25687.code
25688fixed_login:
25689 driver = plaintext
25690 public_name = LOGIN
25691 client_send = : username : mysecret
25692.endd
25693The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25694the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25695prompts.
25696.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25697.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25698
25699
25700
25701
25702. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25703. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25704
25705.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25706.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25707.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25708.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25709.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25710The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25711sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25712name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25713string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25714is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25715secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25716available in plain text at either end.
25717
25718
25719.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25720.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25721This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25722authenticator as a server:
25723
25724.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25725.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25726When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25727the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25728obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25729that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25730string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25731fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25732returned to the client.
25733
25734For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25735in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25736deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25737numeric variables for other things.
25738
25739For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25740client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25741user name, authentication fails.
25742.code
25743fixed_cram:
25744 driver = cram_md5
25745 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25746 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25747 server_set_id = $auth1
25748.endd
25749.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25750If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25751name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25752secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25753.code
25754lookup_cram:
25755 driver = cram_md5
25756 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25757 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25758 {$value}fail}
25759 server_set_id = $auth1
25760.endd
25761Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25762because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25763
25764As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25765using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25766lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25767realm, with:
25768.code
25769cyrusless_crammd5:
25770 driver = cram_md5
25771 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25772 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25773 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25774 server_set_id = $auth1
25775.endd
25776
25777.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25778.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25779When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25780
25781
25782
25783.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25784This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25785computing the response to the server's challenge.
25786
25787
25788.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25789This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25790expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25791
25792
25793.vindex "&$host$&"
25794.vindex "&$host_address$&"
25795Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25796to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25797expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25798prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25799authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25800send the message to the current server.
25801
25802A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25803strings, is:
25804.code
25805fixed_cram:
25806 driver = cram_md5
25807 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25808 client_name = ph10
25809 client_secret = secret
25810.endd
25811.ecindex IIDcramauth1
25812.ecindex IIDcramauth2
25813
25814
25815
25816. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25817. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25818
25819.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25820.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25821.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25822.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25823.cindex "Kerberos"
25824The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25825Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25826
25827The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25828library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25829Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25830including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25831directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25832
25833The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25834the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25835then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25836name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25837
25838Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25839or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25840user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25841by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25842depending on the driver you are using.
25843
25844The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25845be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25846Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25847changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25848layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25849implementation.
25850
25851For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25852may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25853variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25854Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25855With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25856environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25857is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25858the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25859
25860
25861.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25862The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25863(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25864previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25865use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25866confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25867things.
25868
25869
25870.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25871This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25872library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25873SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25874
25875
25876.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25877This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25878default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25879you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25880example:
25881.code
25882sasl:
25883 driver = cyrus_sasl
25884 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25885 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25886 server_set_id = $auth1
25887.endd
25888
25889.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25890This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25891
25892
25893.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25894This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25895
25896
25897For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25898private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25899the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25900PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25901.code
25902sasl_cram_md5:
25903 driver = cyrus_sasl
25904 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25905 server_set_id = $auth1
25906
25907sasl_plain:
25908 driver = cyrus_sasl
25909 public_name = PLAIN
25910 server_set_id = $auth2
25911.endd
25912Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25913not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25914but it is present in many binary distributions.
25915.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25916.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25917
25918
25919
25920
25921. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25922. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25923.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25924.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25925.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25926This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25927Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25928Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25929If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25930to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25931authenticator only. There is only one option:
25932
25933.option server_socket dovecot string unset
25934
25935This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25936authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25937mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25938authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25939.code
25940dovecot_plain:
25941 driver = dovecot
25942 public_name = PLAIN
25943 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25944 server_set_id = $auth1
25945
25946dovecot_ntlm:
25947 driver = dovecot
25948 public_name = NTLM
25949 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25950 server_set_id = $auth1
25951.endd
25952If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25953&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25954option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25955connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25956option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25957who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25958.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25959.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25960
25961
25962. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25963. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25964.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25965.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25966.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25967.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25968.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25969.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25970.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25971.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25972.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25973.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25974.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25975.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25976The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25977library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25978and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25979scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25980made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25981without code changes in Exim.
25982
25983
25984.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25985Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25986of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25987authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25988ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25989context.
25990
25991This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25992as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25993see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25994
25995This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25996only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25997writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25998
25999This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26000this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26001of Exim may switch the default to be true.
26002
26003
26004.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26005This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26006library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26007Some mechanisms will use this data.
26008
26009
26010.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26011This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26012default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26013you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26014example:
26015.code
26016sasl:
26017 driver = gsasl
26018 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26019 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26020 server_set_id = $auth1
26021.endd
26022
26023
26024.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26025Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26026that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26027the password itself.
26028
26029The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26030In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26031The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26032if available, else the empty string.
26033The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26034else the empty string.
26035
26036A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26037
26038If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26039option to be simply "true".
26040
26041
26042.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26043This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26044Some mechanisms will use this data.
26045
26046
26047.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26048This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26049&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26050(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26051
26052
26053.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26054This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26055&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26056(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26057
26058
26059.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26060This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26061Some mechanisms will use this data.
26062
26063
26064.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26065.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26066These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26067They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26068
26069Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
26070meanings for these variables:
26071
26072.ilist
26073.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26074&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
26075.next
26076.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26077&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
26078.next
26079.vindex "&$auth3$&"
26080&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
26081.endlist
26082
26083On a per-mechanism basis:
26084
26085.ilist
26086.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26087EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
26088the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26089.next
26090.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26091ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
26092the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26093.next
26094.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26095GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
26096&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
26097the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
26098.endlist
26099
26100An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
26101identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26102email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26103
26104
26105An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26106and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26107.code
26108gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26109 driver = gsasl
26110 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26111 server_realm = imap.example.org
26112 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26113 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26114 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26115 server_condition = yes
26116.endd
26117
26118
26119. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26120. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26121
26122.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26123.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26124.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26125.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26126.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26127The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26128Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26129reliably.
26130
26131.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26132This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26133for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26134identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26135
26136.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26137If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26138&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26139The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26140
26141.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26142This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26143&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26144from the keytab.
26145
26146
26147.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26148Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26149to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26150not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26151
26152The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26153Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26154Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26155role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26156
26157.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26158.ilist
26159.vindex "&$auth1$&"
26160&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26161.next
26162.vindex "&$auth2$&"
26163&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26164authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26165GSS Display Name.
26166.endlist
26167
26168
26169. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26171
26172.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26173.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26174.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26175.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26176.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26177.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26178.cindex "NTLM authentication"
26179The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26180Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26181which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26182this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26183taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26184server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26185follows:
26186
26187.ilist
26188After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26189authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26190.next
26191The server sends back a challenge.
26192.next
26193The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26194and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26195.endlist
26196
26197Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26198
26199
26200
26201.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26202.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26203The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26204
26205.option server_password spa string&!! unset
26206.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26207This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26208authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26209compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26210&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26211it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26212for other things. For example:
26213.code
26214spa:
26215 driver = spa
26216 public_name = NTLM
26217 server_password = \
26218 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26219.endd
26220If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26221failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26222
26223
26224
26225
26226
26227.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26228.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26229The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26230
26231
26232
26233.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26234This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26235
26236
26237.option client_password spa string&!! unset
26238This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26239
26240
26241.option client_username spa string&!! unset
26242This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26243configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26244&'msn.com'&:
26245.code
26246msn:
26247 driver = spa
26248 public_name = MSN
26249 client_username = msn/msn_username
26250 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26251 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26252.endd
26253.ecindex IIDspaauth1
26254.ecindex IIDspaauth2
26255
26256
26257
26258
26259
26260. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26261. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26262
26263.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26264.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26265.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26266.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26267.cindex "authentication" "X509"
26268.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26269The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26270authentication based on client certificates.
26271
26272It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26273advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26274It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26275the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26276by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26277the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26278
26279The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26280for which it must have been requested via the
26281&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26282(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26283
26284If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26285run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26286and can authenticate the connection.
26287If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26288
26289A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26290
26291
26292.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26293The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26294
26295.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26296.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26297This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26298the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26299If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26300failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26301
26302.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26303.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26304As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26305
26306&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26307
26308
26309Example:
26310.code
26311tls:
26312 driver = tls
26313 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26314 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26315 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26316 {!= {0} \
26317 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26318 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26319 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26320 } } } }
26321 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26322.endd
26323.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26324.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26325
26326
26327Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26328the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26329a connect- or helo-ACL.
26330
26331
26332
26333. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26334. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26335
26336.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26337 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26338.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26339.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26340.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26341.cindex "OpenSSL"
26342.cindex "GnuTLS"
26343Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26344Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26345GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26346cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26347order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26348version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26349You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26350level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26351certificates are used.
26352
26353RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26354connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26355server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26356mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26357between them is encrypted.
26358
26359Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26360and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26361certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26362possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26363encryption state.
26364
26365&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26366disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26367in order to get TLS to work.
26368
26369
26370
26371.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26372 "SECID284"
26373.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26374.cindex "smtps protocol"
26375.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26376.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26377Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26378SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26379waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26380port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26381allocated for this purpose.
26382
26383This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26384still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26385the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26386numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26387.code
26388tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26389.endd
26390The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26391via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26392the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26393the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26394an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26395defined elsewhere.
26396
26397There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26398&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26399
26400
26401
26402
26403
26404
26405.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26406.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26407The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26408followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26409to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26410.code
26411USE_GNUTLS=yes
26412.endd
26413in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26414.code
26415SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26416.endd
26417You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26418include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26419
26420There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26421
26422.ilist
26423The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26424cannot be the path of a directory
26425for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26426(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26427.next
26428The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26429.next
26430.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26431.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26432Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26433separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26434affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26435.next
26436OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26437DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26438RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26439in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26440for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26441to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26442&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26443option).
26444.next
26445The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26446sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26447.next
26448The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26449When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26450(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26451let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26452.next
26453Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26454This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26455explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26456implementation, then patches are welcome.
26457.endlist
26458
26459
26460.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26461This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26462an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26463but not the chosen filename.
26464By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26465See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26466
26467GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26468to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26469Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26470&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26471of bits requested.
26472The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26473its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26474parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26475that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26476renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26477this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26478place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26479
26480For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26481recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26482If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26483are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26484not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26485
26486Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26487values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26488parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26489If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26490until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26491a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26492
26493The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26494in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26495generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26496
26497To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26498and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26499&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26500renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26501.code
26502# ls
26503[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26504# rm -f new-params
26505# touch new-params
26506# chown exim:exim new-params
26507# chmod 0600 new-params
26508# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26509# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26510[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26511 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26512 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26513# chmod 0400 new-params
26514# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26515.endd
26516If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26517stalling is removed.
26518
26519The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26520Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26521the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26522a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26523and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26524failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26525of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26526which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26527GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26528to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26529limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26530
26531The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26532value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26533&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
265342432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26535
26536In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26537increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26538bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26539procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26540the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26541
26542
26543.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26544.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26545.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26546There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26547suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26548are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26549DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26550directly to this function call.
26551Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26552&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26553The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26554documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26555
26556.ilist
26557It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26558.next
26559It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26560or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26561ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26562SSL v3 algorithms.
26563.next
26564Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26565the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26566SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26567algorithms.
26568.endlist
26569
26570Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26571&`-`& or &`+`&.
26572.ilist
26573If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26574ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26575stated.
26576.next
26577If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26578of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26579.next
26580If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26581option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26582.endlist
26583
26584If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26585a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26586includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26587not be moved to the end of the list.
26588.endlist
26589
26590The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26591string:
26592.code
26593# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26594$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26595.endd
26596
26597This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26598there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26599submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26600choice of clients used:
26601.code
26602# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26603tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26604 {DEFAULT}\
26605 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26606.endd
26607
26608
26609
26610.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26611 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26612.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26613.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26614.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26615.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26616.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26617.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26618.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26619The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26620as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26621ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26622
26623The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26624and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26625
26626The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26627controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26628&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26629the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26630the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26631aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26632
26633Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26634"Priority strings". This is online as
26635&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26636but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26637installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26638&url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26639on that site can be used to test a given string.
26640
26641For example:
26642.code
26643# Disable older versions of protocols
26644tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26645.endd
26646
26647Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26648additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26649"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26650
26651This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26652there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26653by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26654where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26655used:
26656.code
26657# GnuTLS variant
26658tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26659 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26660 {SECURE128}}
26661.endd
26662
26663
26664.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26665.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26666When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26667the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26668but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26669that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26670need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26671sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26672
26673If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26674problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26675persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26676with the error
26677.code
26678554 Security failure
26679.endd
26680If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26681rejected with a 554 error code.
26682
26683To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26684match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26685However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26686without some further configuration at the server end.
26687
26688It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26689encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26690.code
26691tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26692tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26693.endd
26694These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26695the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26696contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26697that goes with it. These files need to be
26698PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26699always be given as full path names.
26700The key must not be password-protected.
26701They can be the same file if both the
26702certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26703set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26704is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26705certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26706the server's certificate.
26707
26708If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26709source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26710few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26711
26712&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26713they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26714Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26715transport.
26716
26717With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26718require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26719this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26720.code
26721tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26722.endd
26723is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26724with the parameters contained in the file.
26725Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26726available:
26727.code
26728tls_dhparam = none
26729.endd
26730This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26731DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26732used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26733documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26734
26735See the command
26736.code
26737openssl dhparam
26738.endd
26739for a way of generating file data.
26740
26741The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26742host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26743for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26744in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26745forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26746
26747.cindex "cipher" "logging"
26748.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26749.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26750The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26751an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26752incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26753also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26754&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26755condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26756
26757Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26758can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26759cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26760example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26761contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26762documentation for more details.
26763
26764For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26765(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26766
26767
26768.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26769.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26770.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26771If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26772session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26773&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26774apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26775Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26776contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26777expected certificates.
26778These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26779an explicit file or,
26780depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26781&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26782
26783A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26784directory is used
26785(OpenSSL only),
26786each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26787of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26788certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26789.code
26790openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26791.endd
26792where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26793
26794The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26795what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26796does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26797&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26798attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26799dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26800session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26801fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26802example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26803relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26804
26805.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26806When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26807the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26808&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26809
26810.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26811Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26812&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26813&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26814&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26815certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26816
26817
26818.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26819.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26820.cindex "revocation list"
26821.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26822.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26823Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26824certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26825server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26826an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26827of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26828CRL in PEM format.
26829The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26830file from every certificate authority they know of.
26831
26832The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26833Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26834against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26835usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26836private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26837is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26838
26839The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26840comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26841connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26842re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26843
26844The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26845issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26846the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26847negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26848CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26849resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26850starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26851proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26852
26853Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26854.new
26855or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
26856.wen
26857support for OCSP stapling is included.
26858
26859There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26860The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26861an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26862option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26863contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26864
26865Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26866proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26867Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26868contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26869on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26870next connection.
26871
26872When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26873in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26874ignored.
26875
26876For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26877also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26878certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26879of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26880intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26881file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26882
26883Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26884not any of the chain from CA to it.
26885
26886There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26887
26888.code
26889 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26890 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26891 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26892
26893 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26894 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26895 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26896.endd
26897
26898
26899
26900
26901.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26902.cindex "cipher" "logging"
26903.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26904.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26905.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26906The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26907deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26908server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26909within the &(smtp)& transport.
26910
26911It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26912transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26913server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26914this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26915transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26916
26917If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26918to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26919&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26920those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26921set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26922usual way.
26923
26924When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26925the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26926a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26927session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26928&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26929delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26930it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26931STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26932negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26933unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26934unencrypted.
26935
26936The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26937transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26938if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26939&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26940
26941If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26942specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26943These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26944a file or,
26945depending on library version, a directory,
26946must name a file or,
26947for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26948The client verifies the server's certificate
26949against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26950in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26951Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26952&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26953
26954The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26955certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26956or need not succeed respectively.
26957
26958The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26959&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26960is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26961value is empty.
26962&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26963a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26964value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26965otherwise.
26966
26967The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26968&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26969for OCSP to be relevant.
26970
26971If
26972&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26973list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26974the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26975alternative hosts, if any.
26976
26977 &*Note*&:
26978These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26979is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26980by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26981client.
26982
26983.vindex "&$host$&"
26984.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26985All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26986&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26987which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26988behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26989
26990.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26991.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26992.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26993.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26994Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26995&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26996variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26997that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26998successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26999outgoing connection.
27000
27001
27002
27003.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
27004.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
27005.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
27006.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
27007With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
27008information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
27009extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
27010&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
27011client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
27012within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
27013for this session.
27014
27015This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
27016which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
27017address.
27018
27019With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
27020against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
27021provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
27022be of limited use in that environment.
27023
27024With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
27025connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
27026choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
27027wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
27028different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
27029
27030The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
27031if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
27032nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
27033only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
27034for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
27035
27036Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
27037received from a client.
27038It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
27039
27040If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
27041option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
27042during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
27043
27044.ilist
27045.vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
27046&%tls_certificate%&
27047.next
27048.vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
27049&%tls_crl%&
27050.next
27051.vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
27052&%tls_privatekey%&
27053.next
27054.vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
27055&%tls_verify_certificates%&
27056.next
27057.vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
27058&%tls_ocsp_file%&
27059.endlist
27060
27061Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
27062attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
27063can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
27064arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
27065
27066The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
27067are re-expanded.
27068
27069When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
27070for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
27071enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
27072see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
27073
27074When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
270750.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
27076built, then you have SNI support).
27077
27078
27079
27080.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
27081 "SECTmulmessam"
27082.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
27083.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
27084Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
27085an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
27086one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
27087of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
27088connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
27089to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
27090session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
27091try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
27092if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
27093
27094The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
27095after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
27096just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
27097reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
27098successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
27099SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
27100should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
27101subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
27102and delay other deliveries to that host.
27103
27104To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27105closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27106closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27107information is recorded.
27108
27109There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27110&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27111connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27112
27113
27114
27115
27116.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27117.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27118In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27119certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27120place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27121myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27122to Apache, currently at
27123.display
27124&url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27125.endd
27126Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27127links to further files.
27128Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
271290-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27130Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27131.display
27132&url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27133.endd
27134
27135
27136.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27137The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27138certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27139sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27140not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27141First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27142certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27143intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27144certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27145The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27146validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27147root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27148install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27149
27150Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27151even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27152server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27153diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27154
27155
27156
27157.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27158.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27159You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27160with OpenSSL, like this:
27161. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27162. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27163.code
27164openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27165 -days 9999 -nodes
27166.endd
27167&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27168delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27169specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27170important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27171that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27172prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27173this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27174
27175. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27176. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27177. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27178. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27179. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27180. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27181. ==== -pdp, 2012
27182NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27183epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27184the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27185the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27186of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27187writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27188progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27189be a sensible resolution).
27190
27191A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27192may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27193encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27194
27195However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27196user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27197certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27198must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27199authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27200signed with that self-signed certificate.
27201
27202For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27203user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27204Open-source PKI book, available online at
27205&url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27206.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27207.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27208
27209
27210
27211. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27212. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27213
27214.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27215.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27216.cindex "control of incoming mail"
27217.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27218.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27219Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27220configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27221name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27222one very small ACL:
27223.code
27224begin acl
27225small_acl:
27226 accept hosts = one.host.only
27227.endd
27228You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27229which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27230
27231The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27232certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27233when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27234option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27235in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27236local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27237a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27238&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27239
27240
27241.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27242The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27243configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27244The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27245relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27246
27247
27248
27249.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27250.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27251In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27252options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27253.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27254.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27255.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27256.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27257.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27258.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27259.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27260.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27261.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27262.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27263.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27264.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27265.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27266.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27267.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27268.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27269
27270.table2 140pt
27271.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27272.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27273.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27274.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27275.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27276.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27277.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27278.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27279.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27280.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27281.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27282.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27283.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27284.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27285.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27286.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27287.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27288.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27289.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27290.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27291.endtable
27292
27293For example, if you set
27294.code
27295acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27296.endd
27297the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27298in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27299done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27300sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27301command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27302trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27303testing as possible at RCPT time.
27304
27305
27306.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27307.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27308The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27309apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27310really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27311the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27312relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27313are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27314&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27315&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27316in any of these ACLs.
27317
27318The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27319non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27320analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27321batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27322result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27323really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27324on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27325controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27326.code
27327control = suppress_local_fixups
27328.endd
27329This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27330run, it is too late.
27331
27332The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27333content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27334
27335The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27336kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27337temporary error for these kinds of message.
27338
27339
27340.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27341.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27342.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27343The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27344session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27345an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27346accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27347the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27348&%smtp_banner%& option.
27349
27350
27351.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27352.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27353.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27354The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27355EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27356&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27357Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27358session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27359setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27360
27361If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27362modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27363at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27364affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27365an EHLO response.
27366
27367
27368.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27369.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27370Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27371command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27372When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27373is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27374the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27375response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27376added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27377are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27378
27379You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27380in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27381tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27382received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27383the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27384associated with the DATA command.
27385
27386For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27387error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27388MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27389before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27390and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27391your resources.
27392
27393The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27394the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27395the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27396and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27397
27398.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27399The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27400enabled (which is the default).
27401
27402The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27403received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27404otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27405
27406This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27407
27408For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27409
27410
27411.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27412The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27413content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27414
27415This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27416
27417
27418.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27419.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27420.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27421The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27422with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27423It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27424client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27425has been accepted.
27426
27427The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27428has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27429with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27430The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27431The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27432can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27433for some or all recipients.
27434
27435PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27436one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27437content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27438.new
27439.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
27440for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
27441is &"yes"&.
27442.wen
27443Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27444ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27445will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27446
27447See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27448and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27449
27450This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27451If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27452the feature was not requested by the client.
27453
27454.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27455.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27456The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27457does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27458does not in fact control any access.
27459For this reason, it may only accept
27460or warn as its final result.
27461
27462This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27463session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27464messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27465more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27466
27467&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27468the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27469
27470You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27471&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27472response to QUIT.
27473
27474This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27475failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27476because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27477client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27478connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27479
27480
27481.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27482.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27483The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27484an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27485trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27486because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27487situation even worse.
27488
27489Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27490logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27491modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27492and &%warn%&.
27493
27494.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27495When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27496to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27497connection. The possible values are:
27498.table2
27499.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27500.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27501.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27502.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27503.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27504.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27505.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27506.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27507.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27508.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27509.endtable
27510In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27511Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27512With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27513overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27514&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27515used.
27516
27517
27518.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27519.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27520The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27521you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27522.code
27523acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27524 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27525.endd
27526In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27527providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27528non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27529expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27530more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27531
27532The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27533configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27534string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27535
27536.ilist
27537If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27538contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27539Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27540lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27541If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27542causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27543.code
27544acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27545 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27546 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27547.endd
27548This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27549back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27550file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27551can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27552.next
27553If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27554Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27555matches the string.
27556.next
27557If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27558the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27559want to have something like
27560.code
27561acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27562.endd
27563in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27564newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27565.endlist
27566
27567
27568
27569
27570.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27571.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27572Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27573section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27574&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27575database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27576return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27577&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27578This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27579
27580For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27581&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27582submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27583
27584
27585ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27586has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27587individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27588blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27589
27590If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27591ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27592RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27593recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27594run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27595remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27596&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27597
27598
27599.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27600The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27601recipients; it may create new recipients.
27602
27603
27604
27605.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27606.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27607The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27608all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27609not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27610reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27611
27612For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27613these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27614used to accept or reject anything.
27615
27616For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27617&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27618&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27619when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27620
27621For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27622&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27623This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27624messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27625configuration file.
27626
27627
27628
27629
27630.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27631.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27632.vindex &$domain$&
27633.vindex &$local_part$&
27634.vindex &$sender_address$&
27635.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27636.vindex &$smtp_command$&
27637When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27638that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27639&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27640statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27641&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27642is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27643
27644When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27645contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27646set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27647how it is used.
27648
27649.vindex "&$message_size$&"
27650The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27651the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27652that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27653the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27654received).
27655
27656.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27657.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27658The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27659The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27660accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27661of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27662&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27663&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27664
27665
27666
27667
27668
27669.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27670.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27671.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27672.vindex &$smtp_command$&
27673When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27674the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27675and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27676These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27677here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27678encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27679does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27680unencrypted connections.
27681.code
27682acl_check_auth:
27683 accept encrypted = *
27684 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27685 {CRAM-MD5}}
27686 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27687.endd
27688(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27689that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27690encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27691option to do this.)
27692
27693
27694
27695.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27696.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27697.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27698An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27699with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27700Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27701set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27702
27703If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27704used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27705provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27706example:
27707.code
27708deny dnslists = list1.example
27709dnslists = list2.example
27710.endd
27711If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27712the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27713happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27714all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27715test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27716
27717
27718.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27719The ACL verbs are as follows:
27720
27721.ilist
27722.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27723&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27724of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27725appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27726is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27727after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27728check a RCPT command:
27729.code
27730accept domains = +local_domains
27731endpass
27732verify = recipient
27733.endd
27734If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27735passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27736the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27737fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27738&%endpass%&.
27739
27740The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27741use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27742that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27743configuration.
27744
27745.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27746If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27747depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27748(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27749statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27750SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27751.display
27752&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27753&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27754.endd
27755You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27756response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27757same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27758
27759If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27760an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27761for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27762of &%endpass%&.
27763
27764
27765.next
27766.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27767&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27768an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27769&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27770temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27771&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27772be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27773
27774
27775.next
27776.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27777&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27778the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27779example,
27780.code
27781deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27782.endd
27783rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27784
27785
27786.next
27787.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27788&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27789&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27790that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27791the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27792recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27793recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27794message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27795do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27796
27797If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27798its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27799The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27800
27801
27802.next
27803.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27804&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27805forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27806.code
27807drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27808 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27809.endd
27810There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27811The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27812
27813.next
27814.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27815&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27816statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27817example, when checking a RCPT command,
27818.code
27819require message = Sender did not verify
27820 verify = sender
27821.endd
27822passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27823verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27824&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27825discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27826
27827.next
27828.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27829&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27830&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27831to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27832written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27833message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27834duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27835
27836If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27837and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27838&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27839first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27840&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27841
27842If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27843some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27844This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27845is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27846conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27847is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27848onwards.
27849
27850
27851.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27852When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27853text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27854want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27855.code
27856warn !verify = sender
27857 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27858.endd
27859.endlist
27860
27861At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27862
27863As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27864written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27865subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27866continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27867mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27868
27869
27870
27871.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27872.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27873There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27874can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27875of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27876transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27877variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27878an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27879alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27880the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27881.ilist
27882The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27883throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27884while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27885on the same SMTP connection.
27886.next
27887The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27888while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27889reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27890.endlist
27891
27892When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27893preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27894time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27895.code
27896accept hosts = whatever
27897 set acl_m4 = some value
27898accept authenticated = *
27899 set acl_c_auth = yes
27900.endd
27901&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27902be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27903&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27904
27905.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27906What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27907referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27908false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27909error is generated.
27910
27911Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27912their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27913
27914
27915.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27916.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27917.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27918An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27919.code
27920deny domains = *.dom.example
27921 !verify = recipient
27922.endd
27923causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27924&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27925negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27926two statements are equivalent:
27927.code
27928deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27929deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27930.endd
27931However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27932side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27933
27934The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27935of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27936condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27937.code
27938accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27939 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27940accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27941 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27942.endd
27943Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27944the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27945different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27946condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27947therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27948the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27949and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27950
27951ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27952specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27953others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27954warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27955message is handled.
27956
27957The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27958processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27959modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27960consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27961.code
27962require message = Can't verify sender
27963 verify = sender
27964 message = Can't verify recipient
27965 verify = recipient
27966 message = This message cannot be used
27967.endd
27968If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27969&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27970so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27971recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27972verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27973because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27974
27975For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27976modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27977happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27978the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27979.code
27980deny hosts = ...
27981 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27982 message = Invalid sender from client host
27983.endd
27984The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27985by which time Exim has set up the message.
27986
27987
27988
27989.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27990.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27991The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27992
27993.vlist
27994.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27995This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27996incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27997accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27998
27999.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28000.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
28001.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
28002This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
28003continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
28004the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
28005update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
28006write rather ugly lines like this:
28007.display
28008&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
28009.endd
28010Instead, all you need is
28011.display
28012&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
28013.endd
28014
28015.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28016.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28017This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
28018incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
28019lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
28020lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
28021controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
28022even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
28023
28024As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
28025separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
28026in several different ways. For example:
28027
28028. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
28029. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
28030. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
28031. ==== way.
28032
28033.ilist
28034It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
28035.code
28036 accept ...some conditions
28037 control = queue_only
28038.endd
28039In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
28040other words, when the conditions are all true.
28041
28042.next
28043It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
28044.code
28045 accept ...some conditions...
28046 control = queue_only
28047 ...some more conditions...
28048.endd
28049If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
28050statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
28051In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
28052to be relevant.
28053
28054.next
28055It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
28056decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
28057example:
28058.code
28059 warn ...some conditions...
28060 control = freeze
28061 accept ...
28062.endd
28063This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
28064&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
28065log entry.
28066
28067.next
28068If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
28069&%require%& verb. For example:
28070.code
28071 require control = no_multiline_responses
28072.endd
28073.endlist
28074
28075.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
28076.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
28077.oindex "&%-bh%&"
28078This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
28079the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
28080&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
28081output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
28082happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
28083output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
28084
28085Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
28086example:
28087.code
28088deny ...some conditions...
28089 delay = 30s
28090.endd
28091The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
28092&"deny"&. Compare this with:
28093.code
28094deny delay = 30s
28095 ...some conditions...
28096.endd
28097which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
28098can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
28099.code
28100warn ...some conditions...
28101 delay = 2m
28102 control = freeze
28103accept ...
28104.endd
28105
28106If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
28107responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28108they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28109delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28110appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28111unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28112using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28113
28114
28115.vitem &*endpass*&
28116.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28117This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28118&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28119failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28120failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28121confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28122&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28123
28124
28125.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28126.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28127This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28128ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28129.code
28130require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28131 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28132.endd
28133&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28134example:
28135.display
28136&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28137&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28138.endd
28139When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28140that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28141recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28142message.
28143
28144The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28145the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28146denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28147available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28148variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28149&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28150ignored.
28151
28152.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28153If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28154verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28155error message.
28156
28157If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28158the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28159more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28160actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28161of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28162is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28163
28164If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28165example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28166the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28167logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28168both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28169logging rejections.
28170
28171
28172.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28173.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28174.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28175This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28176about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28177be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28178may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28179ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28180.display
28181&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28182&` log_reject_target =`&
28183.endd
28184This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28185permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28186current ACL.
28187
28188
28189.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28190.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28191.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28192This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28193processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28194&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28195access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28196ACLs. For example:
28197.display
28198&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28199&` control = freeze`&
28200&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28201.endd
28202By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28203with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28204another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28205example:
28206.code
28207logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28208logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28209.endd
28210
28211
28212.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28213.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28214This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28215message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28216or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28217there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28218&%accept%& for details.)
28219
28220The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28221to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28222generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28223&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28224the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28225.code
28226require message = Host not recognized
28227 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28228.endd
28229(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28230processed.)
28231
28232.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28233.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28234For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28235of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28236is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28237is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28238overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28239accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28240truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28241EHLO options.
28242
28243When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28244consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28245of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28246.code
28247deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28248 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28249.endd
28250The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28251by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28252access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
282532&'xx'&.
28254
28255Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28256the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28257
28258The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28259literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28260anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28261response.
28262
28263.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28264For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28265stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28266
28267If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28268specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28269However, the original message is available in the variable
28270&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28271wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28272routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28273use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28274
28275For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28276is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28277modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28278all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28279&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28280&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28281effect.
28282
28283
28284.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28285This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28286 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28287the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28288
28289
28290.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28291.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28292This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28293&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28294
28295
28296.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28297This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28298collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28299the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28300of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28301server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28302separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28303example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28304when:
28305.code
28306udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28307 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28308.endd
28309.endlist
28310
28311
28312
28313
28314.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28315.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28316The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28317
28318.vlist
28319.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28320This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28321has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28322apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28323HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28324really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28325not work without it. For example:
28326.code
28327warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28328 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28329.endd
28330Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28331the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28332matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28333mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28334by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28335
28336
28337.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28338 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28339.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28340.cindex "case of local parts"
28341.vindex "&$local_part$&"
28342These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28343(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28344are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28345any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28346for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28347is encountered.
28348
28349These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28350local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28351in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28352handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28353configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28354
28355This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28356containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28357spam score:
28358.code
28359warn control = caseful_local_part
28360 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28361 $acl_m4 + \
28362 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28363 }
28364 control = caselower_local_part
28365.endd
28366Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28367is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28368
28369
28370.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28371.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28372.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28373This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28374
28375The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28376If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28377and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28378is used for all recipients of the message,
28379then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28380and data is copied from one to the other.
28381
28382An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28383for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28384If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28385requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28386any subsequent recipients and the data,
28387otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28388
28389Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28390and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28391Note also that headers cannot be
28392modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28393Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28394
28395Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28396of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28397before the entire message has been received from the source.
28398It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28399
28400Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28401a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28402If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28403usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28404the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28405before the acceptance "<=" line.
28406
28407Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28408(possibly faked)
28409sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28410
28411
28412.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28413.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28414.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28415This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28416with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28417&'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28418may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28419the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28420option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28421contexts):
28422.code
28423 control = debug
28424 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28425 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28426 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28427.endd
28428
28429
28430.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28431.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28432.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28433This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28434the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28435
28436
28437.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28438.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28439.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28440This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28441connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28442strings or to numeric value.
28443The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28444Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28445&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28446
28447The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28448(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28449that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28450equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28451Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28452
28453
28454.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28455 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28456.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28457.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28458These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28459is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28460state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28461in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28462
28463The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28464connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28465messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28466&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28467before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28468synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28469work with.
28470
28471
28472.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28473.cindex "fake defer"
28474.cindex "defer, fake"
28475This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28476except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28477550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28478messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28479use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28480
28481.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28482.cindex "fake rejection"
28483.cindex "rejection, fake"
28484This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28485words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28486message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28487However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28488only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28489the same SMTP connection.
28490
28491The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28492message is supplied, the following is used:
28493.code
28494550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28495550-kept for evaluation.
28496550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28497550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28498.endd
28499This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28500
28501.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28502.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28503This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28504other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28505it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28506current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28507SMTP connection.
28508
28509This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28510&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28511is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28512are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28513
28514.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28515.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28516Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28517avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28518use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28519disables such output flushing.
28520
28521.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28522.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28523Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28524avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28525use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28526that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28527
28528.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28529This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28530extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28531of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28532or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28533needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28534only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28535the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28536to be useful in production.
28537
28538.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28539.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28540This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28541It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28542SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28543
28544If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28545suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28546one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28547(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28548responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28549sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28550
28551.ilist
28552Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28553sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28554verification failed"&) is sent.
28555.next
28556If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28557line is output.
28558.endlist
28559
28560The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28561calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28562
28563.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28564.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28565This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28566the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28567response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28568controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28569&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28570
28571.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28572.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28573.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28574This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28575other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28576it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28577runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28578effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28579to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28580same SMTP connection.
28581
28582.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28583.cindex "message" "submission"
28584.cindex "submission mode"
28585This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28586latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28587the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28588operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28589necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28590This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28591late (the message has already been created).
28592
28593Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28594messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28595submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28596The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28597that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28598
28599.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28600.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28601This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28602complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28603normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28604
28605.ilist
28606Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28607dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28608.next
28609No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28610.next
28611There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28612.endlist ilist
28613
28614This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28615passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28616used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28617and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28618data is read.
28619
28620&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28621that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28622.endlist vlist
28623
28624
28625.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28626All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28627
28628.ilist
28629Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28630.next
28631Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28632&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28633.next
28634Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28635.next
28636Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28637.endlist
28638
28639
28640
28641.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28642.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28643.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28644.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28645The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28646to an incoming message, as in this example:
28647.code
28648warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28649 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28650 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28651.endd
28652The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28653MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28654receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28655&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28656any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28657RCPT ACL).
28658
28659Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28660DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28661
28662Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28663the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28664contains one or more newlines that
28665are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28666lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28667front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28668
28669Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28670They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28671However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28672is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28673during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28674with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28675lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28676In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28677non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28678message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28679are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28680
28681.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28682Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28683of message headers
28684until they are added to the
28685message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28686ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28687header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28688ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28689passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28690this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28691&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28692
28693The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28694
28695The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28696processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28697.display
28698&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28699&` `&<&'some condition'&>
28700
28701&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28702&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28703.endd
28704In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28705condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28706condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28707ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28708honoured.
28709
28710.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28711For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28712&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28713effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28714them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28715usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28716are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28717specifications.
28718
28719By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28720header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28721be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28722after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28723that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28724
28725This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28726&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28727header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28728to be a header name first.) For example:
28729.code
28730warn add_header = \
28731 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28732.endd
28733If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28734each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28735you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28736up in reverse order.
28737
28738&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28739added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28740system filter or in a router or transport.
28741
28742
28743
28744.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28745.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28746.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28747.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28748The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28749from an incoming message, as in this example:
28750.code
28751warn message = Remove internal headers
28752 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28753.endd
28754The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28755MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28756receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28757&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28758with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28759any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28760
28761Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28762DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28763
28764More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28765list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28766not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28767create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28768are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28769.code
28770warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28771 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28772warn message = Remove internal headers
28773 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28774.endd
28775Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28776They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28777There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28778a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28779during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28780if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28781accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28782all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28783ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28784would have been removed.
28785
28786.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28787Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28788is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28789not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28790removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28791this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28792passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28793you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28794&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28795
28796The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28797processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28798.display
28799&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28800&` `&<&'some condition'&>
28801
28802&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28803&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28804.endd
28805In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28806condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28807condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28808same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28809are honoured.
28810
28811&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28812present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28813in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28814
28815
28816
28817
28818.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28819.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28820Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28821compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28822for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28823content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28824
28825Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28826senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28827result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28828done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28829can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28830same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28831The conditions are as follows:
28832
28833
28834.vlist
28835.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28836.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28837.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28838.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28839.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28840The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28841&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28842&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28843false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28844condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28845condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28846ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28847
28848If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28849can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28850and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28851Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28852The name and values are expanded separately.
28853Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28854will act as argument separators.
28855
28856If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28857the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28858&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28859conditions are tested.
28860
28861ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28862loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28863circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28864for different local users or different local domains.
28865
28866.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28867.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28868.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28869.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28870If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28871the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28872authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28873.code
28874authenticated = *
28875.endd
28876
28877.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28878.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28879.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28880.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28881.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28882This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28883expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28884&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28885number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28886any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28887&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28888ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28889negative.
28890
28891.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28892.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28893This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28894content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28895&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28896If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28897problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28898chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28899
28900.vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28901.cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28902This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28903content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28904&<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28905
28906.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28907.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28908.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28909.cindex "black list (DNS)"
28910.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28911This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28912&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28913use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28914different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28915&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28916
28917.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28918.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28919.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28920.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28921.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28922This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28923of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28924enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28925lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28926&%domains%& test.
28927
28928&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28929use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28930
28931
28932.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28933.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28934.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28935.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28936If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28937name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28938encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28939.code
28940encrypted = *
28941.endd
28942
28943
28944.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28945.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28946.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28947.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28948This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28949name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28950you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28951.code
28952accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28953.endd
28954The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28955the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28956and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28957
28958The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28959Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28960but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28961find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28962opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28963found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28964
28965If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28966address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28967.code
28968accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28969accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28970.endd
28971The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28972is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28973statement can then check the IP address.
28974
28975.vindex "&$host_data$&"
28976If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28977of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28978allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28979.code
28980deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28981message = $host_data
28982.endd
28983which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28984
28985.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28986.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28987.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28988.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28989.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28990This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28991part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28992enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28993result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28994the next &%local_parts%& test.
28995
28996.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28997.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28998.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28999.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
29000This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29001content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
29002viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29003
29004.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29005.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
29006.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29007This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29008content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
29009&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
29010with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
29011&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29012
29013.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
29014.cindex "rate limiting"
29015This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
29016messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
29017
29018.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29019.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
29020.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
29021.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
29022This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
29023recipient address against a list of recipients.
29024
29025.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
29026.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
29027.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
29028This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29029content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
29030non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
29031any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29032
29033.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
29034.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
29035.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29036.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
29037.vindex "&$domain$&"
29038.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
29039This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
29040domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
29041&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
29042of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
29043lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
29044RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
29045influence the sender checking.
29046
29047&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29048relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29049
29050.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
29051.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
29052.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
29053.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
29054This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
29055for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
29056.code
29057senders = :
29058.endd
29059&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
29060relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
29061
29062.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
29063.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
29064.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
29065This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29066content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
29067SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29068
29069.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
29070.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29071.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29072.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29073.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
29074.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
29075This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
29076certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
29077server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
29078or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29079
29080.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
29081.cindex "CSA verification"
29082This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
29083send email. Details of how this works are given in section
29084&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
29085
29086.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
29087.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29088.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29089.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
29090.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
29091This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29092received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29093&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
29094there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
29095allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
29096
29097Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
29098problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
29099detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
29100
29101.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
29102.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29103.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
29104.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
29105.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
29106.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
29107This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29108received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29109&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29110of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29111is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29112However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29113that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29114to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29115might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29116
29117Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29118section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29119&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29120condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29121.code
29122deny senders = :
29123 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29124 !verify = header_sender
29125.endd
29126
29127.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29128.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29129.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29130.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29131.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29132This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29133received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29134&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29135lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29136and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
29137Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29138permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29139&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29140appropriate.
29141
29142Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29143ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29144.code
29145To: @
29146.endd
29147and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29148common as they used to be.
29149
29150.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29151.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29152.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29153.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29154.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29155.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29156.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29157This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29158client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29159attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29160condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29161&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29162independently of this condition.
29163
29164For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29165option), this condition is always true.
29166
29167
29168.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29169.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29170.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29171This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29172Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29173&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29174case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29175&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29176used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29177
29178There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29179recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29180
29181
29182.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29183.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29184.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29185.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29186.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29187.vindex "&$address_data$&"
29188This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29189recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29190&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29191of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29192This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29193verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29194address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29195value for the child address.
29196
29197.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29198.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29199.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29200.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29201This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29202address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29203was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29204Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29205one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29206original IP address.
29207
29208There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29209DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29210
29211If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29212is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29213
29214.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29215.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29216.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29217.cindex "sender" "verifying"
29218.cindex "verifying" "sender"
29219This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29220message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29221the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29222condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29223
29224.vindex "&$address_data$&"
29225.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29226If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29227value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29228value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29229statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29230want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29231
29232Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29233&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29234to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29235
29236.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29237.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29238This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29239verified as a sender.
29240.endlist
29241
29242
29243
29244.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29245.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29246.cindex "black list (DNS)"
29247.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29248In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29249is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29250address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29251domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29252special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29253address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29254.code
29255deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29256 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29257.endd
29258the following records are looked up:
29259.code
2926043.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
2926143.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29262.endd
29263As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29264Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29265to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29266use two separate conditions:
29267.code
29268deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29269 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29270.endd
29271If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29272behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29273record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29274processed.
29275
29276This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29277(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29278blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29279following special items in the list:
29280.display
29281&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29282&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29283&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29284.endd
29285.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29286.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29287.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29288Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29289.code
29290deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29291.endd
29292Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29293warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29294.code
29295deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29296warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29297 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29298.endd
29299.cindex cacheing "of dns lookup"
29300.cindex DNS TTL
29301DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
29302.new
29303(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
29304.wen
29305so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29306connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
29307Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29308connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29309
29310
29311
29312.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29313.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29314By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29315of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29316after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29317.code
29318deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29319.endd
29320This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29321use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29322MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29323&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29324
29325
29326
29327
29328.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29329.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29330There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29331addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29332&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29333with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29334listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29335.code
29336deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29337 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29338.endd
29339This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29340RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29341example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29342up by this example is
29343.code
29344tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29345.endd
29346A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29347addresses. For example:
29348.code
29349deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29350 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29351.endd
29352The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29353name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29354
29355
29356
29357
29358.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29359.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29360The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29361names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29362name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29363As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29364this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29365either to double the separators like this:
29366.code
29367dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29368.endd
29369or to change the separator character, like this:
29370.code
29371dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29372.endd
29373If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29374blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29375occurs. Consider this condition:
29376.code
29377dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29378.endd
29379The DNS lookups that occur are:
29380.code
293812.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29382a.domain.black.list.tld
29383.endd
29384Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29385address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29386are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29387or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29388only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29389successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29390error for a previous item.
29391
29392The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29393syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29394.code
29395dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29396dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29397.endd
29398However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29399is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29400.code
29401deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29402 $sender_address_domain \
29403 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29404 see $dnslist_text.
29405 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29406 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29407 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29408.endd
29409Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29410multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29411and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29412of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29413.code
29414dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29415.endd
29416Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29417domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29418
29419The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29420&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29421
29422
29423
29424
29425.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29426.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29427DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29428just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29429RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29430The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29431.display
29432127.1.0.1 RBL
29433127.1.0.2 DUL
29434127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29435127.1.0.4 RSS
29436127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29437127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29438127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29439.endd
29440Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29441different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29442see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29443
29444
29445.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29446.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29447.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29448.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29449.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29450.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29451.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29452When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29453the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29454&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29455(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29456the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29457&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29458cases, for example:
29459.code
29460deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29461.endd
29462the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29463&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29464For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29465might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29466.code
29467deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29468.endd
29469If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29470&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29471
29472If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29473addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29474The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29475record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29476very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29477information.
29478
29479You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29480&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29481expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29482.code
29483deny hosts = !+local_networks
29484 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29485 at $dnslist_domain
29486 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29487.endd
29488
29489
29490
29491.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29492.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29493You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29494in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29495For example,
29496.code
29497deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29498.endd
29499rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29500any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29501that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29502describes how multiple records are handled.
29503
29504More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29505separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29506&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29507.code
29508deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29509.endd
29510If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29511addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29512first. For example:
29513.code
29514deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29515 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29516.endd
29517
29518If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29519listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29520In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29521true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29522tested. For example:
29523.code
29524dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29525.endd
29526matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29527want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29528being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29529.code
29530dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29531.endd
29532matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29533an odd number.
29534
29535
29536
29537.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29538You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29539condition. Whereas
29540.code
29541deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29542.endd
29543means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29544IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29545.code
29546deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29547.endd
29548means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29549IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29550words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29551the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29552
29553&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29554host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29555
29556If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29557previous example is precisely equivalent to
29558.code
29559deny dnslists = a.b.c
29560 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29561.endd
29562However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29563Consider this example:
29564.code
29565deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29566 list.dsbl.org : \
29567 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29568 relays.ordb.org
29569.endd
29570Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29571.code
29572deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29573 list.dsbl.org
29574deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29575 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29576deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29577.endd
29578which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29579
29580
29581
29582
29583.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29584A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29585thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29586is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29587the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29588the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29589.code
29590dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29591.endd
29592What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29593127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29594condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29595because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29596affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29597additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29598
29599.ilist
29600If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29601IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29602condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29603.next
29604If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29605looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29606changed to:
29607.code
29608dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29609.endd
29610and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29611false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29612.code
29613dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29614.endd
29615for the condition to be true.
29616.endlist
29617
29618When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29619the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29620.ilist
29621If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29622addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29623.code
29624dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29625.endd
29626If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29627false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29628.next
29629If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29630looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29631.code
29632dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29633.endd
29634If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29635true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29636.code
29637dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29638.endd
29639for the condition to be false.
29640.endlist
29641When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29642between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29643
29644
29645
29646
29647.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29648.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29649When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29650the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29651the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29652address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29653only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29654can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29655in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29656lists.
29657
29658A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29659two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29660do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29661If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29662restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29663a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29664domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29665.code
29666reject message = \
29667 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29668 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29669 dnslists = \
29670 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29671 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29672.endd
29673For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29674&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29675match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29676value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29677record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29678The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29679
29680If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29681given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29682the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29683.code
29684reject dnslists = \
29685 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29686 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29687 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29688 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29689.endd
29690In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29691values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29692done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29693
29694
29695
29696.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29697.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29698.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29699If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29700nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
297013ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29702.code
297031.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29704 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29705.endd
29706(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29707lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29708IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29709.code
29710*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29711.endd
29712is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29713Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29714
29715You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29716&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29717.code
29718deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29719 dnslists = some.list.example
29720.endd
29721
29722If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29723address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29724(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29725.code
29726 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29727.endd
29728
29729.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29730.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29731.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29732.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29733The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29734which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29735&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29736commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29737works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29738host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29739.display
29740&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29741.endd
29742If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29743period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29744
29745As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29746&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29747configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29748of &'p'&.
29749
29750The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29751time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29752means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29753parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29754send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29755in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29756constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29757changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29758both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29759
29760There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29761log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29762when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29763instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29764
29765The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29766sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29767retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29768which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29769By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29770of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29771user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29772&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29773example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29774authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29775
29776The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29777rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29778&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29779ACL.
29780
29781Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29782specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29783or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29784&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29785using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29786separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29787
29788Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29789any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29790stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29791remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29792remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29793behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29794the &%count=%& option.
29795
29796
29797.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29798.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29799The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29800normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29801&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29802
29803The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29804the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29805&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29806&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29807
29808The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29809the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29810in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29811used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29812in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29813follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29814in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29815
29816The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29817accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29818&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29819&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29820ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29821in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29822recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29823
29824The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29825number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29826last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29827recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29828&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29829
29830The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29831condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29832command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29833multiple different commands.
29834
29835The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29836measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29837&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29838increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29839other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29840
29841The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29842
29843
29844.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29845.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29846You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29847control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29848mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29849
29850If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29851previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29852
29853For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29854it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29855can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29856in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29857new rate.
29858.code
29859acl_check_connect:
29860 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29861 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29862 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29863# ...
29864acl_check_mail:
29865 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29866 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29867 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29868.endd
29869
29870If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29871processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29872it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29873in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29874same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29875multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29876checks.
29877
29878The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29879use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29880update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29881&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29882next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29883
29884
29885.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29886.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29887If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29888engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29889&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29890counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29891rest of the ACL.
29892
29893The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29894updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29895client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29896the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29897counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29898email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29899is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29900For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29901from getting any email through.
29902
29903The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29904updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29905of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29906actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29907counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29908pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29909again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29910attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29911.code
29912 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29913.endd
29914
29915
29916.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29917.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29918The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29919rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29920mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29921sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29922&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29923measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29924options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29925
29926For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29927has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29928rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29929per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29930go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29931recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29932
29933When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29934&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29935rate.
29936
29937The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29938other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29939unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29940required increases with larger limits.
29941
29942The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29943will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29944the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29945the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29946events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29947times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29948throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29949limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29950are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29951as intended.
29952
29953
29954.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29955Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29956when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29957(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29958policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29959message. For example:
29960.code
29961# Log all senders' rates
29962warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29963 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29964
29965# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29966# at the decimal point.
29967warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29968 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29969 $sender_rate_limit }s
29970
29971# Keep authenticated users under control
29972deny authenticated = *
29973 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29974
29975# System-wide rate limit
29976defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29977 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29978
29979# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29980# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29981defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29982 messages per $sender_rate_period
29983 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29984 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29985 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29986.endd
29987&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29988especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29989bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29990making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29991RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29992this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29993hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29994
29995
29996
29997.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29998.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29999.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
30000Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
30001&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
30002&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
30003The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
30004verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
30005other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
30006.code
30007verify = sender/callout
30008verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
30009.endd
30010The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
30011address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
30012difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
30013be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
30014(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
30015The available options are as follows:
30016
30017.ilist
30018If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
30019remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
30020check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
30021.next
30022If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
30023normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
30024options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
30025verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
30026.next
30027The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
30028discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
30029.next
30030The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
30031immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
30032generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
30033discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
30034.endlist
30035
30036.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
30037.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
30038.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
30039.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30040After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
30041error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
30042coding like this:
30043.code
30044warn !verify = sender
30045 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
30046.endd
30047If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
30048denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
30049verification failure.
30050
30051In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
30052appropriate) contains one of the following words:
30053
30054.ilist
30055&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
30056was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
30057.next
30058&%route%&: Routing failed.
30059.next
30060&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
30061occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
30062connection, HELO, or MAIL).
30063.next
30064&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
30065.next
30066&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
30067.endlist
30068
30069The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
30070rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
30071
30072
30073
30074
30075.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
30076.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
30077.cindex "callout" "verification"
30078.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
30079For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
30080checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
30081the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
30082&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
30083a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
30084address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
30085sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
30086deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
30087sender's domain.
30088
30089Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
30090request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
30091described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
30092lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
30093cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
30094caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
30095
30096Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
30097the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
30098callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
30099callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
30100on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
30101
30102If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
30103second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
30104one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
30105&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
30106router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
30107&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
30108&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
30109supplies a host list.
30110Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
30111
30112The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
30113remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
30114specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30115specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30116specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30117the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30118&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30119
30120For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30121test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30122following SMTP commands are sent:
30123.display
30124&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30125&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30126&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30127&`QUIT`&
30128.endd
30129LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30130set to &"lmtp"&.
30131
30132The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30133settings.
30134
30135A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30136for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30137the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30138that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30139do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30140&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30141
30142If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30143succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30144Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30145hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30146&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30147
30148.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30149A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30150output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30151clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30152disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30153
30154
30155
30156
30157.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30158.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30159The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30160optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30161.code
30162verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30163.endd
30164The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30165separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30166deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30167
30168
30169.vlist
30170.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30171.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30172This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30173For example:
30174.code
30175verify = sender/callout=5s
30176.endd
30177The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30178remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30179the &%connect%& parameter.
30180
30181
30182.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30183.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30184This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30185for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30186.code
30187verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30188.endd
30189If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30190
30191.vitem &*defer_ok*&
30192.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30193When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30194of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30195updated in this circumstance.
30196
30197.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30198.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30199This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30200&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30201accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30202unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30203
30204
30205.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30206.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30207When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30208verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30209sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30210whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30211MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30212as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30213(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30214address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30215.code
30216require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30217.endd
30218This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30219
30220
30221.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30222.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30223This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30224For example:
30225.code
30226verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30227.endd
30228This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30229commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30230be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30231very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30232(for example, when network connections are timing out).
30233
30234
30235.vitem &*no_cache*&
30236.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30237.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30238When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30239
30240.vitem &*postmaster*&
30241.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30242When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30243check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30244rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30245the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30246used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30247made, until the cache record expires.
30248
30249.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30250The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30251You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30252For example:
30253.code
30254require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30255.endd
30256If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30257one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30258.code
30259require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30260.endd
30261&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30262account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30263a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30264postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30265
30266
30267.vitem &*random*&
30268.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30269When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30270check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30271really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30272&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30273.code
30274$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30275.endd
30276The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30277parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30278specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30279a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30280succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30281
30282.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30283.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30284This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30285.code
30286deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30287.endd
30288.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30289It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30290performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30291that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30292domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30293
30294.vitem &*use_sender*&
30295This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30296.code
30297require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30298.endd
30299It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30300command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30301need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30302sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30303usefulness of callout caching.
30304.endlist
30305
30306If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30307command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30308&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30309usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30310that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30311Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30312these circumstances.
30313
30314However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30315host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30316callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30317sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30318callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30319own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30320is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30321
30322Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30323caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30324by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30325actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30326
30327
30328
30329
30330.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30331.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30332.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30333.cindex "caching" "callout"
30334Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30335used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30336option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30337different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30338a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30339entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30340
30341When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30342the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30343is not available.
30344
30345The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30346independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30347(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30348
30349If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30350commands up to and including
30351.code
30352MAIL FROM:<>
30353.endd
30354(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30355any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30356domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30357making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30358separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30359&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30360&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30361
30362Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30363cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30364Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30365ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30366will eventually be noticed.
30367
30368The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30369being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30370behaviour will be the same.
30371
30372
30373
30374.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30375.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30376See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30377verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30378failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30379relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30380you might see:
30381.code
30382MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30383250 OK
30384RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30385550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30386550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30387550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30388550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30389550 Sender verification failed
30390.endd
30391If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30392only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30393out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30394&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30395example:
30396.code
30397verify = sender/no_details
30398.endd
30399
30400.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30401.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30402.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30403A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30404during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30405or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30406it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30407
30408.ilist
30409When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30410continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30411verification also fails.
30412.next
30413When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30414verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30415.endlist
30416
30417This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30418way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30419example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30420.code
30421A.Wol: aw123
30422aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30423.endd
30424work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30425redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30426mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30427verification to succeed.
30428
30429It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30430redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30431generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30432option. For example:
30433.code
30434require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30435.endd
30436In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30437the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30438
30439When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30440redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30441also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30442address and a report is output for each of them.
30443
30444
30445
30446.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30447.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30448Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30449which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30450special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30451domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30452Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30453.code
30454verify = csa
30455.endd
30456This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30457valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30458succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30459&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30460&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30461be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30462
30463The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30464detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30465looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30466address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30467
30468.ilist
30469The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30470.next
30471The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30472.next
30473The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30474(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30475.next
30476The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30477that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30478.endlist
30479
30480The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30481use for the DNS query. The default is:
30482.code
30483verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30484.endd
30485This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30486is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30487address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30488the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30489meaningful to say:
30490.code
30491verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30492.endd
30493In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30494This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30495&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30496
30497If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30498is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30499making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30500using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30501default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30502default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30503(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30504of legitimate HELO domains.
30505
30506The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30507direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30508search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30509addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30510lookup such as:
30511.code
30512${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30513.endd
30514has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30515The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30516authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30517
30518
30519
30520
30521.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30522.cindex "BATV, verifying"
30523Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30524of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30525Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30526recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30527bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30528spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30529
30530There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30531&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30532the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30533address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30534item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30535The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30536&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30537
30538As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30539database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30540like this:
30541.code
30542PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30543 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30544 }{$value}}
30545.endd
30546Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30547list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30548use this:
30549.code
30550# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30551deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30552 senders = :
30553 recipients = +batv_senders
30554
30555# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30556deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30557 senders = :
30558 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30559 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30560 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30561.endd
30562The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30563to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30564send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30565recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30566the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30567
30568A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30569&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30570prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30571the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30572the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30573timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30574of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30575
30576There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30577you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30578deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30579router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30580.code
30581batv_redirect:
30582 driver = redirect
30583 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30584.endd
30585This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30586of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30587address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30588local addresses.
30589
30590To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30591can be used:
30592.code
30593external_smtp_batv:
30594 driver = smtp
30595 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30596 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30597 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30598 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30599 {$value}fail}}}
30600.endd
30601If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30602
30603
30604
30605.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30606.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30607.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30608.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30609An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30610delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30611within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30612passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30613.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30614but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30615
30616Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30617A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30618relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30619a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30620with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30621same host is fulfilling both functions,
30622. ///
30623. as illustrated in the diagram below,
30624. ///
30625but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30626not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30627system to arbitrary domains.
30628
30629
30630You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30631runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30632Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30633example, suppose you want to do the following:
30634
30635.ilist
30636Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30637locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30638&'my.dom2.example'&.
30639.next
30640Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30641These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30642.next
30643Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30644Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30645.endlist
30646
30647
30648In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30649.code
30650domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30651domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30652hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30653.endd
30654Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30655command:
30656.code
30657acl_check_rcpt:
30658 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30659 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30660.endd
30661The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30662the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30663statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30664hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30665than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30666default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30667in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30668
30669
30670
30671.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30672.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30673You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30674that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30675the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30676
30677For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30678&'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30679host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30680will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30681patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30682trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30683results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30684.ecindex IIDacl
30685
30686
30687
30688. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30689. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30690
30691.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30692.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30693The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30694as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30695was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30696maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30697specification.
30698
30699It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30700&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30701scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30702messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30703chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30704
30705If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30706Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30707&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30708
30709.ilist
30710Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30711for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30712.next
30713Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30714&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30715run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30716.next
30717An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30718of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30719.next
30720Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30721conditions.
30722.next
30723Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30724.endlist
30725
30726There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30727called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30728condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30729
30730Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30731added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30732changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30733EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30734this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30735&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30736
30737All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30738temporarily created in a file called:
30739.display
30740<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30741.endd
30742The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30743expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30744first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30745scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30746removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30747.code
30748control = no_mbox_unspool
30749.endd
30750has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30751same directory by default.
30752
30753
30754
30755.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30756.cindex "virus scanning"
30757.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30758.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30759The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30760It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30761specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30762in memory and thus are much faster.
30763
30764A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30765if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30766
30767.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30768You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30769to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30770are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30771.display
30772&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30773.endd
30774If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30775.code
30776av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30777.endd
30778If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30779before use.
30780The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30781The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30782
30783.vlist
30784.vitem &%avast%&
30785.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30786This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30787Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
30788You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30789at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30790This scanner type takes one option,
30791which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30792or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30793The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30794single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30795Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30796to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30797For example:
30798.code
30799av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30800av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30801.endd
30802If you omit the argument, the default path
30803&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30804is used.
30805If you use a remote host,
30806you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30807as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30808For information about available commands and their options you may use
30809.code
30810$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30811 FLAGS
30812 SENSITIVITY
30813 PACK
30814.endd
30815
30816
30817.vitem &%aveserver%&
30818.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30819This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30820at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30821which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30822example:
30823.code
30824av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30825.endd
30826
30827
30828.vitem &%clamd%&
30829.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30830This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30831&url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30832unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30833in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30834
30835The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30836a UNIX socket specification,
30837a TCP socket specification,
30838or a (global) option.
30839
30840A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30841For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30842for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30843and the second a port number,
30844Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30845These per-server options are supported:
30846.code
30847retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30848.endd
30849
30850The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30851a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30852
30853If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30854
30855Examples:
30856.code
30857av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30858av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30859av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30860av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30861av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30862.endd
30863If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30864&`local`&
30865option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30866to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30867more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30868Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30869There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30870you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30871
30872The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30873randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30874that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30875socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30876unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30877When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30878not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30879selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30880email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30881.code
308822013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30883 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30884 (Connection refused)
30885.endd
30886
30887If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30888contributing the code for this scanner.
30889
30890.vitem &%cmdline%&
30891.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30892This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30893used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30894type takes 3 mandatory options:
30895
30896.olist
30897The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30898and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30899
30900.next
30901A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30902virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30903absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30904the &"trigger"& expression.
30905
30906.next
30907Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30908match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30909&"name"& expression.
30910.endlist olist
30911
30912For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30913.code
30914Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30915.endd
30916For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30917name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30918for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30919configuration setting:
30920.code
30921av_scanner = cmdline:\
30922 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30923 found in file:'(.+)'
30924.endd
30925.vitem &%drweb%&
30926.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30927The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30928takes one option,
30929either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30930or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30931The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30932single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30933For example:
30934.code
30935av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30936av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30937.endd
30938If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30939is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30940
30941.vitem &%f-protd%&
30942.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30943The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30944One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30945(or port-range).
30946For example:
30947.code
30948av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30949.endd
30950If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30951
30952.vitem &%fsecure%&
30953.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30954The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30955argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30956.code
30957av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30958.endd
30959If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30960Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30961
30962.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30963.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30964This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30965Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30966scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30967For example:
30968.code
30969av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30970.endd
30971The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30972
30973.vitem &%mksd%&
30974.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30975This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30976parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30977&url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30978the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30979provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30980been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30981.code
30982av_scanner = mksd:2
30983.endd
30984You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30985
30986.vitem &%sock%&
30987.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30988This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30989running on the local machine.
30990There are four options:
30991an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30992a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30993the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30994an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30995an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30996For example:
30997.code
30998av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30999.endd
31000Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
31001Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
31002Both regular-expressions are required.
31003
31004.vitem &%sophie%&
31005.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
31006Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
31007You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
31008for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
31009client communication. For example:
31010.code
31011av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
31012.endd
31013The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
31014the option.
31015.endlist
31016
31017When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
31018the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
31019ACL.
31020
31021The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
31022makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
31023The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
31024for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
31025However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
31026which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
31027message.
31028
31029The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
31030use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
31031The first element can then be one of
31032
31033.ilist
31034&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
31035The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
31036recommended usage.
31037.next
31038&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
31039the condition fails immediately.
31040.next
31041A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
31042condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
31043expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
31044Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
31045unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
31046.endlist
31047
31048You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
31049messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
31050Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
31051
31052You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
31053specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
31054For example:
31055.code
31056malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
31057.endd
31058A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
31059
31060.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31061When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31062is set to record the actual address used.
31063
31064.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
31065When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
31066&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
31067&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
31068logging data.
31069
31070If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
31071use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
31072&%malware%& condition.
31073
31074Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
31075imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
31076
31077Here is a very simple scanning example:
31078.code
31079deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31080 demime = *
31081 malware = *
31082.endd
31083The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
31084.code
31085deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31086 demime = *
31087 malware = */defer_ok
31088.endd
31089The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
31090aveserver. It assumes you have set:
31091.code
31092av_scanner = $acl_m0
31093.endd
31094in the main Exim configuration.
31095.code
31096deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31097 set acl_m0 = sophie
31098 malware = *
31099
31100deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
31101 set acl_m0 = aveserver
31102 malware = *
31103.endd
31104
31105
31106.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
31107.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
31108.cindex "spam scanning"
31109.cindex "SpamAssassin"
31110.cindex "Rspamd"
31111The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
31112score and a report for the message.
31113Support is also provided for Rspamd.
31114
31115For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
31116Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
31117&url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
31118
31119SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31120.code
31121perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31122.endd
31123SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31124documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31125nicely, however.
31126
31127.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31128By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31129intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31130&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31131you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31132configuration as follows (example):
31133.code
31134spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31135.endd
31136
31137To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31138on TCP port 11333)
31139you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31140.code
31141spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31142.endd
31143
31144As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31145sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31146file name instead of an address/port pair:
31147.code
31148spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31149.endd
31150You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31151reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31152&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31153option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31154.code
31155spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31156 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31157 192.168.2.12 783
31158.endd
31159Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31160When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31161servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31162condition defers.
31163
31164Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31165Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31166and changeable in the usual way.
31167
31168For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31169subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31170and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31171In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31172
31173Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31174are options.
31175The supported options are:
31176.code
31177pri=<priority> Selection priority
31178weight=<value> Selection bias
31179time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31180retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31181tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31182variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31183.endd
31184
31185The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31186higher values being tried first.
31187The default priority is 1.
31188
31189The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31190Within a priority set
31191servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31192The default value for selection bias is 1.
31193
31194Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31195in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31196Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31197characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31198
31199Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31200are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31201
31202The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31203The default value is two minutes.
31204
31205The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31206a failed connect is made.
31207The default is to not retry.
31208
31209The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31210a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31211used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31212expansion.
31213
31214.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
31215When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
31216is set to record the actual address used.
31217
31218.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31219Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31220.code
31221deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31222 spam = joe
31223.endd
31224The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31225relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31226to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31227default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31228Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31229right-hand side.
31230
31231The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31232principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31233have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31234&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31235read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31236are not set.
31237Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31238(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31239after the first),
31240or the use of PRDR,
31241.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31242are needed to use this feature.
31243
31244The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31245you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31246&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31247
31248
31249Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31250large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31251are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31252example:
31253.code
31254deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31255 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31256 spam = nobody
31257.endd
31258
31259The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31260SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31261&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31262it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31263
31264.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31265When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31266variables.
31267Except for &$spam_report$&,
31268these variables are saved with the received message so are
31269available for use at delivery time.
31270
31271.vlist
31272.vitem &$spam_score$&
31273The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31274for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31275
31276.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31277The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31278example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31279because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31280The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31281
31282.vitem &$spam_bar$&
31283A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31284integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31285&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31286headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
31287spam bar is 50 characters.
31288
31289.vitem &$spam_report$&
31290A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31291message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31292This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31293
31294.vitem &$spam_action$&
31295For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31296spam score versus threshold.
31297For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31298
31299.endlist
31300
31301The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31302spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31303does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31304
31305The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31306the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31307failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31308statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31309spam condition, like this:
31310.code
31311deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31312 spam = joe/defer_ok
31313.endd
31314This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31315
31316Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31317condition:
31318.code
31319# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31320warn spam = nobody:true
31321 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31322 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31323
31324# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31325# is over threshold
31326warn spam = nobody
31327 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31328
31329# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31330deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31331 spam = nobody:true
31332 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31333.endd
31334
31335
31336
31337.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31338.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31339.cindex "MIME content scanning"
31340.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31341.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31342The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31343each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31344of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31345specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31346options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31347cases.
31348
31349These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31350ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31351the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31352message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31353ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31354result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31355&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31356
31357You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31358only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31359condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31360&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31361&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31362
31363At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31364information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31365of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31366parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31367part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31368syntax is:
31369.display
31370&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31371.endd
31372The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31373the value can be:
31374
31375.olist
31376&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31377.next
31378The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31379&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31380a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31381full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31382.next
31383A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31384directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31385is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31386the full path and file name.
31387.next
31388If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31389filename, and the default path is then used.
31390.endlist
31391The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31392errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31393a file with its original, proposed filename using
31394.code
31395decode = $mime_filename
31396.endd
31397However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31398anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31399automatically unlinked.
31400
31401For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31402content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31403as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31404variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31405before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31406
31407The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31408used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31409respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31410
31411.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31412The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31413available in the MIME ACL:
31414
31415.vlist
31416.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31417If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31418have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31419has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31420contains the empty string.
31421
31422.vitem &$mime_charset$&
31423This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31424&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31425.code
31426us-ascii
31427gb2312 (Chinese)
31428iso-8859-1
31429.endd
31430Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31431case-insensitively.
31432
31433.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31434This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31435header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31436implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31437only used for display purposes.
31438
31439.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31440This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31441header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31442
31443.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31444This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31445This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31446
31447.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31448This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31449successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31450size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31451has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31452
31453.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31454This variable contains the normalized content of the
31455&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31456type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31457
31458.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31459If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31460value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31461are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31462.code
31463text/plain
31464text/html
31465application/octet-stream
31466image/jpeg
31467audio/midi
31468.endd
31469If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31470empty string.
31471
31472.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31473This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31474successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31475containing the decoded data.
31476.endlist
31477
31478.cindex "RFC 2047"
31479.vlist
31480.vitem &$mime_filename$&
31481This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31482proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31483&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31484RFC2047
31485or RFC2231
31486decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31487 If no filename was
31488found, this variable contains the empty string.
31489
31490.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31491This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31492attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31493content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31494
31495The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31496cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31497follows:
31498
31499.olist
31500The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31501
31502.next
31503If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31504so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31505
31506.next
31507If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31508and the rest are attachments.
31509
31510.next
31511All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31512.endlist olist
31513
31514As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31515alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31516coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31517.code
31518deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31519!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31520condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31521condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31522.endd
31523.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31524This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31525&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31526Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31527want to carry out specific actions on them.
31528
31529.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31530This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31531checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31532decoding is fully recursive.
31533
31534.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31535This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31536starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31537counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31538&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31539complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31540parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31541.endlist
31542
31543
31544
31545.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31546.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31547.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31548You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31549the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31550
31551The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31552matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31553MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31554linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31555have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31556
31557The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31558to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31559part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31560is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31561and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3156232K characters are checked.
31563
31564The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31565literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31566expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31567with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31568Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31569.code
31570deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31571 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31572.endd
31573The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31574&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31575matching regular expression.
31576The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
31577are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
31578
31579&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31580CPU-intensive.
31581
31582
31583
31584
31585.section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31586.cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31587.cindex "MIME content scanning"
31588The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31589extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31590&%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31591ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31592condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31593the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31594use the &%demime%& condition.
31595
31596The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31597errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31598against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31599parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31600scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31601antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31602
31603On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31604colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31605example:
31606.code
31607deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31608 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31609.endd
31610If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31611false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31612full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31613the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31614
31615The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31616conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31617zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31618
31619The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31620
31621.vlist
31622.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31623.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31624When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31625severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31626severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31627zero, no error occurred.
31628
31629.vitem &$demime_reason$&
31630.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31631When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31632human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31633.endlist
31634
31635.vlist
31636.vitem &$found_extension$&
31637.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31638When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31639extension it found.
31640.endlist
31641
31642Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31643the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31644
31645If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31646condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31647right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31648facility:
31649.code
31650# Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31651deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31652 demime = *
31653 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31654
31655# Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31656# Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31657deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31658 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31659
31660# Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31661# examine them and eventually thaw them.
31662deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31663 demime = exe:doc
31664 control = freeze
31665.endd
31666.ecindex IIDcosca
31667
31668
31669
31670
31671. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31672. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31673
31674.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31675 "Local scan function"
31676.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31677.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31678.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31679In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31680want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31681
31682The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31683passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31684a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31685condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31686non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31687
31688To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31689possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31690in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31691can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31692
31693The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31694when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31695It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31696well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31697
31698Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31699option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31700Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31701Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31702before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31703are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31704incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31705For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31706code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31707
31708
31709
31710.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31711.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31712To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31713function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31714&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31715directory, so you might set
31716.code
31717LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31718.endd
31719for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31720Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31721be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31722function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31723commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31724_src/local_scan.c_.
31725
31726If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31727for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31728.code
31729LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31730.endd
31731in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31732
31733
31734
31735
31736.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31737.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31738You must include this line near the start of your code:
31739.code
31740#include "local_scan.h"
31741.endd
31742This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31743prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31744almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31745for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31746It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31747strings and pointers to character strings:
31748.code
31749#define CS (char *)
31750#define CCS (const char *)
31751#define CSS (char **)
31752#define US (unsigned char *)
31753#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31754#define USS (unsigned char **)
31755.endd
31756The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31757.code
31758extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31759.endd
31760The arguments are as follows:
31761
31762.ilist
31763&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31764(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31765recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31766
31767The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31768character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31769id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31770macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31771case this changes in some future version.
31772.next
31773&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31774string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31775.endlist
31776
31777The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31778
31779.vlist
31780.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31781.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31782The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31783the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31784newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31785maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31786
31787.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31788This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31789queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31790
31791.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31792This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31793queued without immediate delivery.
31794
31795.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31796The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31797passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31798they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31799&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31800used.
31801
31802.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31803The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31804message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31805problem"& is used.
31806
31807.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31808This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31809message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31810&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31811&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31812&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31813same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31814
31815.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31816This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31817LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31818.endlist
31819
31820If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31821reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31822&%-oe%& command line options.
31823
31824
31825
31826.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31827.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31828It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31829that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31830want to do this, you must have the line
31831.code
31832LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31833.endd
31834in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31835&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31836file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31837to define them.
31838
31839The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31840&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31841and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31842alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31843variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31844entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31845.code
31846static int my_integer_option = 42;
31847static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31848
31849optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31850 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31851 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31852};
31853
31854int local_scan_options_count =
31855 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31856.endd
31857The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31858configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31859.code
31860begin local_scan
31861my_integer = 99
31862my_string = some string of text...
31863.endd
31864The available types of option data are as follows:
31865
31866.vlist
31867.vitem &*opt_bool*&
31868This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31869variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31870that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31871whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31872TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31873values.)
31874
31875.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31876This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31877The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31878multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31879
31880.vitem &*opt_int*&
31881This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31882&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31883Exim.
31884
31885.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31886This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31887&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31888printed with the suffix K or M.
31889
31890.vitem &*opt_octint*&
31891This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31892octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31893always output in octal.
31894
31895.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31896This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31897variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31898
31899.vitem &*opt_time*&
31900This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31901type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31902.endlist
31903
31904If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31905out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31906
31907
31908
31909.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31910.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31911The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31912are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31913Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31914including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31915C variables are as follows:
31916
31917.vlist
31918.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31919This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31920
31921.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31922This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31923
31924.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31925This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31926is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31927&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31928
31929.ilist
31930The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31931testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31932other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31933
31934.next
31935The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31936by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31937of debugging bits.
31938.endlist ilist
31939
31940Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31941selected, you should use code like this:
31942.code
31943if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31944 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31945.endd
31946.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31947After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31948variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31949
31950.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31951A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31952discussed below.
31953
31954.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31955A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31956
31957.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31958The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31959
31960.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31961This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31962&%-bh%& command line option.
31963
31964.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31965The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31966is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31967
31968.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31969The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31970command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31971specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31972
31973.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31974This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31975&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31976
31977.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31978The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31979
31980.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31981The number of accepted recipients.
31982
31983.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31984.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31985.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31986The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31987&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31988can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31989below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31990adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31991&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31992value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31993blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31994and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31995
31996.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31997The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31998
31999.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
32000The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
32001locally-submitted messages.
32002
32003.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
32004The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
32005was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
32006
32007.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
32008The name of the sending host, if known.
32009
32010.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
32011The port on the sending host.
32012
32013.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
32014This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
32015
32016.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
32017This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
32018
32019.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
32020The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
32021requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
32022.endlist
32023
32024
32025.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
32026The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
32027You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
32028(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
32029their type to *.
32030
32031
32032.vlist
32033.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
32034A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
32035
32036.vitem &*int&~type*&
32037A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
32038characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
32039Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
32040with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
32041rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
32042lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
32043
32044.vitem &*int&~slen*&
32045The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
32046internal newlines.
32047
32048.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
32049A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
32050a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
32051.endlist
32052
32053
32054
32055.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
32056The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
32057
32058.vlist
32059.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
32060This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
32061
32062.vitem &*int&~pno*&
32063This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
32064the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
32065and must always contain -1 at this stage.
32066
32067.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
32068If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
32069recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
32070envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
32071router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
32072an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
32073&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
32074is NULL for all recipients.
32075.endlist
32076
32077
32078
32079.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
32080.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
32081The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
32082These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
32083release:
32084
32085.vlist
32086.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
32087 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
32088
32089This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
32090&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
32091be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
32092for the process in &%newumask%&.
32093
32094Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
32095and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
32096standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
32097descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
32098argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
32099
32100The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
32101
32102.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
32103This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
32104seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
32105return value is as follows:
32106
32107.ilist
32108>= 0
32109
32110The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
32111ending status.
32112
32113.next
32114< 0 and > &--256
32115
32116The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
32117signal number.
32118
32119.next
32120&--256
32121
32122The process timed out.
32123.next
32124&--257
32125
32126The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32127.endlist
32128
32129.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32130This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32131Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32132want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32133forks a subprocess that is running
32134.code
32135exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32136.endd
32137and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32138that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32139of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32140recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32141
32142When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32143finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32144fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32145addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32146
32147
32148.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32149 *sender_authentication)*&
32150This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32151that it runs is:
32152.display
32153&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32154.endd
32155The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32156
32157
32158.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32159This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32160output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32161calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32162conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32163.code
32164if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32165 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32166.endd
32167
32168.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32169This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32170expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32171The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32172expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32173the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32174block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32175&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32176
32177.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32178This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32179existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32180character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32181substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32182if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32183
32184.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32185 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32186This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32187chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32188
32189If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32190&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32191NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32192matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32193&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32194found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32195marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32196option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32197top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32198headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32199.code
32200header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32201 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32202.endd
32203Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32204there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32205
32206
32207.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32208This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32209occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32210particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32211match the specification, the function does nothing.
32212
32213
32214.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32215 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32216This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32217a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32218colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32219&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32220.code
32221if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32222.endd
32223.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32224.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32225This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32226The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32227back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32228zero-terminated.
32229
32230.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32231This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32232zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32233to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32234string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32235yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32236easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32237added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32238
32239.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32240This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32241matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32242.display
32243&`OK `& match succeeded
32244&`FAIL `& match failed
32245&`DEFER `& match deferred
32246.endd
32247DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32248inability to contact a database.
32249
32250.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32251 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32252This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32253controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32254&'lss_match_domain()'&.
32255
32256.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32257 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32258This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32259controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32260matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32261
32262.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32263 uschar&~*list)*&"
32264This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32265expected to be
32266.code
32267lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32268.endd
32269.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32270An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32271is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32272looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32273values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32274returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32275failed.
32276
32277.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32278 *format,&~...)*&"
32279This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32280is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32281&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32282them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32283arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32284contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32285
32286
32287.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32288This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32289is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32290with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32291
32292This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32293described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32294the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32295value afterwards. For example:
32296.code
32297 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32298 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32299 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32300.endd
32301
32302.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32303This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32304recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32305matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32306address.
32307.endlist
32308
32309
32310.cindex "RFC 2047"
32311.vlist
32312.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32313 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32314This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32315these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32316from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32317a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32318made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32319binary string is returned with an error message.
32320
32321The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32322maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32323encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32324
32325.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32326.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32327If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32328contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32329not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32330
32331The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32332&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32333which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32334
32335If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32336argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32337set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32338returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32339with translation.
32340
32341
32342.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32343This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32344below.
32345
32346.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32347The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32348output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32349stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32350SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32351is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32352opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32353test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32354is involved.
32355
32356If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32357output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32358
32359Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32360must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32361LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32362LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32363initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32364to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32365that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32366.code
32367smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32368return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32369.endd
32370Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32371the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32372&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32373multiple output lines.
32374
32375The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32376does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32377the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32378detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32379you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32380dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32381arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32382is an error.
32383
32384.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32385This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32386chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32387runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32388
32389.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32390This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32391permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32392
32393.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32394See below.
32395
32396.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32397See below.
32398
32399.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32400These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32401The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32402number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32403and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32404pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32405more discussion.
32406.endlist
32407
32408
32409
32410.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32411.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32412No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32413The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32414recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32415to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32416message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32417terminates.
32418
32419Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32420data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32421connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32422one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32423
32424If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32425in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32426.code
32427store_pool = POOL_PERM
32428.endd
32429before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32430restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32431the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32432set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32433
32434The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32435&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32436There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32437block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32438&%store_pool%&.
32439.ecindex IIDlosca
32440
32441
32442
32443
32444. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32445. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32446
32447.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32448.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32449.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32450.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32451The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32452that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32453also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32454they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32455
32456The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32457is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32458It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32459commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32460The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32461
32462The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32463is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32464the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32465If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32466of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32467prevent it happening on retries.
32468
32469.vindex "&$domain$&"
32470.vindex "&$local_part$&"
32471&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32472specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32473&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32474you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32475independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32476described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32477
32478
32479.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32480.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32481.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32482The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32483setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32484other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32485&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32486.code
32487system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32488system_filter_user = exim
32489.endd
32490If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32491&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32492specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32493&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32494&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32495by the &%reply%& command.
32496
32497
32498.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32499You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32500filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32501are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32502
32503If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32504you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32505
32506
32507
32508.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32509The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32510files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32511mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32512available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32513If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32514they cause errors.
32515
32516.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32517There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32518files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32519is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32520&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32521subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32522manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32523
32524&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32525specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32526succeed, it will not be tried again.
32527If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32528arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32529
32530When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32531&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32532users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32533to which users' filter files can refer.
32534
32535
32536
32537.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32538.vindex "&$recipients$&"
32539The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32540of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32541filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32542
32543
32544
32545.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32546.cindex "freezing messages"
32547.cindex "message" "freezing"
32548.cindex "message" "forced failure"
32549.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32550.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32551.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32552There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32553always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32554filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32555for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32556word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32557.code
32558fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32559.endd
32560The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32561
32562The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32563message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32564and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32565delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32566that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32567run.
32568
32569The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32570not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32571filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32572is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32573
32574.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32575.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32576The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32577well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32578up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32579log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32580two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32581strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32582message. For example:
32583.code
32584fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32585 because it contains attachments that we are \
32586 not prepared to receive."
32587.endd
32588
32589.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32590Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32591the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32592the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32593command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32594Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32595use, for example
32596.code
32597if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32598then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32599.endd
32600though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32601alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32602generated by the filter.
32603
32604The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32605&%defer%&,
32606&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32607set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32608as
32609.code
32610mail ...
32611freeze
32612.endd
32613to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32614failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32615take place.
32616
32617
32618
32619.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32620.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32621.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32622.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32623Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32624.code
32625headers add <string>
32626headers remove <string>
32627.endd
32628The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32629added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32630filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32631space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32632forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32633
32634You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32635continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32636including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32637example:
32638.code
32639headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32640 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32641 X-header-2: ...."
32642.endd
32643Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32644be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32645space after input continuations is ignored.
32646
32647The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32648This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32649those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32650&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32651header with the same name, they are all removed.
32652
32653The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32654of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32655from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32656modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32657Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32658used for all recipients of the message.
32659
32660During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32661header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32662that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32663routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32664routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32665until the message is actually being written (see section
32666&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32667
32668If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32669added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32670present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32671present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32672message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32673conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32674modified more than once.
32675
32676Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32677use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32678For example:
32679.code
32680headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32681headers remove "Subject"
32682headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32683headers remove "Old-Subject"
32684.endd
32685
32686
32687
32688.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32689.cindex "envelope sender"
32690In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32691.code
32692errors_to <some address>
32693.endd
32694in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32695delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32696user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32697might use
32698.code
32699unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32700.endd
32701to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32702address if its delivery failed.
32703
32704
32705
32706.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32707.vindex "&$domain$&"
32708.vindex "&$local_part$&"
32709In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32710delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32711operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32712such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32713filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32714which implements such a filter:
32715.code
32716central_filter:
32717 check_local_user
32718 driver = redirect
32719 domains = +local_domains
32720 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32721 no_verify
32722 allow_filter
32723 allow_freeze
32724.endd
32725The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32726&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32727the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32728use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32729
32730Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32731specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32732its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32733address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32734normal way.
32735.ecindex IIDsysfil1
32736.ecindex IIDsysfil2
32737.ecindex IIDsysfil3
32738
32739
32740
32741
32742
32743
32744. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32745. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32746
32747.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32748.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32749Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32750all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32751these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32752this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32753removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32754before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32755
32756Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32757&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32758that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32759its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32760set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32761
32762&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32763or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32764loopback interface specially in any way.
32765
32766If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32767that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32768
32769
32770
32771
32772.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32773.cindex "message" "submission"
32774.cindex "submission mode"
32775Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32776&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32777received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32778state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32779.code
32780control = submission
32781.endd
32782in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32783&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32784a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32785known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32786example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32787interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32788.code
32789warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32790 control = submission
32791.endd
32792.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32793There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32794is used to separate options. For example:
32795.code
32796control = submission/sender_retain
32797.endd
32798Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32799true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32800of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32801the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32802authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32803&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32804attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32805
32806When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32807domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32808example:
32809.code
32810control = submission/domain=some.domain
32811.endd
32812The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32813&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32814that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32815&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32816.code
32817accept authenticated = *
32818 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32819 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32820 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32821.endd
32822Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32823option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32824the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32825.code
32826bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32827.endd
32828then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32829line would be:
32830.code
32831Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32832.endd
32833.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32834By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32835used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32836specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32837
32838&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32839ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32840untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32841specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32842does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32843spoof another's address.
32844
32845.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32846.cindex "line endings"
32847.cindex "carriage return"
32848.cindex "linefeed"
32849RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32850linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32851SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32852conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32853use CRLF or just CR.
32854
32855Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32856using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32857receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32858Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32859MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32860has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32861that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32862other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32863follows:
32864
32865.ilist
32866LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32867.next
32868CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32869is ignored.
32870.next
32871The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32872nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32873terminator.
32874.next
32875If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32876the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32877is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32878people trying to play silly games.
32879.next
32880If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32881bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32882line.
32883.endlist
32884
32885
32886
32887
32888
32889.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32890.cindex "unqualified addresses"
32891.cindex "address" "qualification"
32892By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32893host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32894SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32895messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32896requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32897
32898Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32899sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32900&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32901cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32902value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32903
32904.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32905.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32906Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32907that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32908line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32909are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32910other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32911&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32912
32913
32914
32915
32916.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32917.cindex "&""From""& line"
32918.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32919.cindex "sender" "address"
32920.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32921.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32922.cindex "envelope sender"
32923.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32924Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32925with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32926&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32927.code
32928From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32929From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32930.endd
32931This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32932Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32933via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32934such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32935&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32936and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32937regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32938default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32939that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32940
32941.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32942When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32943a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32944contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32945then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32946qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32947the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32948
32949If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32950sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32951that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32952
32953Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32954treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32955as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32956incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32957
32958
32959
32960.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32961.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32962RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32963&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32964recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32965&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32966&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32967
32968.blockquote
32969&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32970processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32971.endblockquote
32972
32973This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32974address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32975follows:
32976
32977.ilist
32978A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32979is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32980.next
32981If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32982&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32983&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32984.next
32985For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32986also removed.
32987.next
32988For a locally-submitted message,
32989if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32990&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32991the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32992included in log lines in this case.
32993.next
32994The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32995&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32996.endlist
32997
32998
32999
33000
33001.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
33002Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
33003includes the header line:
33004.code
33005Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
33006.endd
33007
33008.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
33009.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
33010If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
33011message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
33012extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
33013existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
33014
33015
33016.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
33017.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
33018If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
33019Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
33020&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
33021
33022.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
33023.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
33024.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
33025&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
33026set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
33027the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
33028in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
33029set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
33030messages.
33031
33032
33033.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
33034.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
33035.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
33036&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
33037Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
33038generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
33039messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
33040(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
33041messages.
33042
33043
33044.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
33045.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
33046.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
33047.cindex "message" "submission"
33048.cindex "submission mode"
33049If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
33050adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
33051
33052.ilist
33053The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
33054message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
33055.next
33056.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33057The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
33058.olist
33059.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33060If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33061&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33062.next
33063If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
33064part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33065.next
33066If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33067&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33068.endlist
33069.endlist
33070
33071A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
33072
33073If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
33074line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
33075containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
33076are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33077They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
33078&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
33079&%qualify_domain%&.
33080
33081For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
33082&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
33083user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
33084name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
33085
33086
33087.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
33088.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
33089.cindex "message" "submission"
33090.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
33091If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
33092&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
33093&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
33094to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
33095creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
33096message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
33097followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
33098in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
33099&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
33100
33101
33102.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
33103.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
33104A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
33105contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
33106Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
33107
33108The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
33109have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
33110line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
33111that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
33112
33113Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
33114changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
33115-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
33116
33117
33118.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
33119.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
33120Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
33121header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
33122section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
33123header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
33124responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
33125processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33126than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33127incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3312811 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33129
33130
33131
33132.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33133.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33134.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33135&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33136it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33137transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33138transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33139default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33140
33141
33142
33143.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33144.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33145.cindex "message" "submission"
33146For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33147existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33148these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33149&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33150control setting.
33151
33152When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33153&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33154control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33155&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33156that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33157&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33158be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33159appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33160line is added to the message.
33161
33162If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33163the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33164&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33165options true at the same time.
33166
33167.cindex "submission mode"
33168By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33169received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33170a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33171not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33172
33173.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33174First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33175authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33176created as follows:
33177
33178.ilist
33179.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33180If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33181&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33182.next
33183If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33184is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33185.next
33186If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33187&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33188.endlist
33189
33190This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33191are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33192added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33193by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33194
33195.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33196&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33197the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33198except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33199
33200
33201
33202.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33203 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33204.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33205.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33206When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33207specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33208process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33209modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33210as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33211
33212In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33213specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33214addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33215changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33216transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33217they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33218
33219&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33220the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33221expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33222
33223For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33224option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33225newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33226.code
33227headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33228 X-added-second: another added header line
33229.endd
33230Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33231
33232Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33233specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33234Each header-line is separately expanded.
33235
33236The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33237list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33238often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33239not part of the names. For example:
33240.code
33241headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33242.endd
33243
33244Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33245specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33246Each item is separately expanded.
33247Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33248form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33249will act as list separators.
33250
33251When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33252items are expanded at routing time,
33253and then associated with all addresses that are
33254accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33255an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33256forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33257
33258.oindex "&%unseen%&"
33259However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33260the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33261&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33262
33263Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33264settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33265dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33266requirements.
33267
33268The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33269with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33270these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33271recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33272consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33273names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33274instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33275
33276After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33277lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33278the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33279header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33280
33281This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33282the following consequences:
33283
33284.ilist
33285The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33286remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33287to it, at all times.
33288.next
33289Header lines that are added by a router's
33290&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33291expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33292.next
33293Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33294in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33295.next
33296Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33297a later router or by a transport.
33298.next
33299An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33300removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33301.code
33302headers_remove = subject
33303headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33304.endd
33305.endlist
33306
33307&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33308for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33309
33310
33311
33312
33313
33314.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33315.cindex "address" "constructed"
33316.cindex "constructed address"
33317When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33318the form
33319.display
33320<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33321.endd
33322For example:
33323.code
33324Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33325.endd
33326The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33327otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33328&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33329ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33330upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33331&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33332The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33333there is no password file entry.
33334
33335.cindex "RFC 2047"
33336In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33337parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33338characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33339including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33340&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33341characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33342&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33343is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33344
33345
33346
33347.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33348.cindex "case of local parts"
33349.cindex "local part" "case of"
33350RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33351be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33352addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33353because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33354routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33355original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33356router option.
33357
33358.cindex "mixed-case login names"
33359If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33360assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33361your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33362correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33363.code
33364correct_case:
33365 driver = redirect
33366 domains = +local_domains
33367 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33368 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33369 @$domain
33370.endd
33371For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33372(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33373up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33374on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33375local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33376
33377
33378
33379.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33380.cindex "dot" "in local part"
33381.cindex "local part" "dots in"
33382RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33383part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33384middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33385empty components for compatibility.
33386
33387
33388
33389.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33390.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33391Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33392happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33393in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33394&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33395
33396Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33397in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33398routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33399example, a header such as
33400.code
33401To: hare@teaparty
33402.endd
33403might get rewritten as
33404.code
33405To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33406.endd
33407Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33408does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33409been routed.
33410
33411Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33412addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33413result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33414deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33415immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33416routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33417.ecindex IIDmesproc
33418
33419
33420
33421. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33422. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33423
33424.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33425.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33426.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33427Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33428LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33429closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33430processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33431
33432.ilist
33433SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33434.next
33435SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33436.next
33437Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33438.endlist
33439
33440For mail delivery, the following are available:
33441
33442.ilist
33443SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33444.next
33445LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33446&"lmtp"&);
33447.next
33448LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33449transport);
33450.next
33451Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33452the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33453.endlist
33454
33455&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33456stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33457used to contain the envelope information.
33458
33459
33460
33461.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33462.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33463.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33464.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33465.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33466.cindex "EHLO"
33467.cindex "HELO"
33468.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33469Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33470The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33471processing is the same in both cases.
33472
33473If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33474parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33475command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33476&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33477such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33478.cindex "transport" "filter"
33479.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33480transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33481suppressed.
33482
33483If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33484pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33485required for the transaction.
33486
33487If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33488was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33489server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33490Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33491is called for verification.
33492
33493If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33494the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33495in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33496
33497.cindex "carriage return"
33498.cindex "linefeed"
33499Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33500LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33501order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33502line terminator.
33503
33504If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33505characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33506same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33507even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33508of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33509they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33510each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33511in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33512significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33513
33514When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33515message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33516records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33517particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33518
33519.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33520Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33521a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33522See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33523
33524.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33525.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33526When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33527looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33528messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33529creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33530a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33531so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33532does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33533turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33534
33535The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33536limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33537
33538.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33539The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33540identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33541square bracket of the IP address.
33542
33543
33544
33545
33546.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33547.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33548.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33549.cindex "host" "error"
33550Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33551message errors, and recipient errors.
33552
33553.vlist
33554.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33555A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33556particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33557
33558.ilist
33559Connection refused or timed out,
33560.next
33561Any error response code on connection,
33562.next
33563Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33564.next
33565Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33566.next
33567I/O errors at any time,
33568.next
33569Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33570the &"."& at the end of the data.
33571.endlist ilist
33572
33573For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33574EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33575error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33576host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33577the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33578alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33579host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33580made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33581
33582.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33583.cindex "message" "error"
33584A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33585particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33586message errors are:
33587
33588.ilist
33589Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33590the data,
33591.next
33592Timeout after MAIL,
33593.next
33594Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33595timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33596connection at any other time.
33597.endlist ilist
33598
33599For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33600to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33601temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33602addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33603a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33604message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33605that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33606time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33607affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33608it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33609
33610If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33611to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33612over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33613response to MAIL.
33614
33615.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33616.cindex "recipient" "error"
33617A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33618recipient errors are:
33619
33620.ilist
33621Any error response to RCPT,
33622.next
33623Timeout after RCPT.
33624.endlist
33625
33626For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33627recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33628sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33629address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33630used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33631routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33632operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33633to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33634if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33635(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33636have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33637the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33638the retry clock is reset.
33639
33640The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33641host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33642other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33643in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33644proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33645than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33646if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33647through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33648recipient's retry time.
33649.endlist
33650
33651In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33652current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33653tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33654own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33655until the next delivery attempt.
33656
33657Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33658MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33659would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33660host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33661What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33662is created.
33663
33664The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33665these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33666procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33667response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33668it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33669message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33670helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33671
33672Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33673host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33674or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33675the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33676then to be treated as a host error.
33677
33678There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33679terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33680reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33681should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33682host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33683
33684
33685
33686
33687.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33688.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33689.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33690.cindex "inetd"
33691.cindex "daemon"
33692Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33693listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33694&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33695.code
33696smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33697.endd
33698Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33699agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33700a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33701the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33702with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33703stream and exits with an error code.
33704
33705By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33706disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33707unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33708&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33709
33710.cindex "carriage return"
33711.cindex "linefeed"
33712Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33713LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33714order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33715line terminator.
33716Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33717sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33718sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33719
33720.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33721.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33722One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33723HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33724commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33725the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33726Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33727match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33728
33729.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33730.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33731The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33732a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33733&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33734false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33735&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33736value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33737message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33738
33739When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33740its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33741logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33742
33743The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33744prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33745number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33746&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33747rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33748
33749The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33750subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33751for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33752things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33753processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33754sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33755it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33756
33757When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33758and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33759high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33760&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33761applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33762
33763Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33764can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33765&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33766number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33767SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33768&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33769subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33770a delivery process.
33771
33772The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33773&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33774started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33775handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33776however, available with &'inetd'&.
33777
33778Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33779are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33780to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33781section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33782
33783Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33784MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33785&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33786
33787
33788
33789.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33790.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33791If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33792commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33793the error response to the last command. The default value for
33794&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33795abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33796circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33797
33798
33799.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33800.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33801.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33802A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33803something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33804address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33805sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33806&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33807drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33808default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33809broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33810
33811
33812
33813.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33814.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33815The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33816DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33817many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33818denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33819client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33820defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33821
33822When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33823allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33824but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33825or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33826starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33827counted.
33828
33829The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33830STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33831RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33832
33833You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33834&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33835&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33836the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33837specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33838
33839
33840
33841
33842.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33843When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33844runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33845appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33846If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33847
33848.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33849When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33850called with the &%-bv%& option.
33851
33852.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33853When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33854EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33855than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33856as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33857of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33858VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33859RCPT failures.
33860
33861
33862
33863.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33864.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33865RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33866overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33867disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33868the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33869should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33870
33871The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33872delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33873the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33874text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33875specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33876the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33877argument. For example,
33878.code
33879ETRN #brigadoon
33880.endd
33881runs the command
33882.code
33883exim -R brigadoon
33884.endd
33885which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33886containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33887default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33888for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33889a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33890
33891.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33892Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33893record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33894the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33895the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33896a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33897left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33898Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33899
33900.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33901For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33902used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33903whatever the form of its argument. For
33904example:
33905.code
33906smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33907 $sender_host_address
33908.endd
33909.vindex "&$domain$&"
33910The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33911expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33912and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33913wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33914under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33915for it to change them before running the command.
33916
33917
33918
33919.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33920.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33921Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33922standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33923line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33924&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33925messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33926sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33927an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33928identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33929runs for RCPT commands:
33930.code
33931accept hosts = :
33932.endd
33933This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33934
33935
33936
33937.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33938.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33939.cindex "batched SMTP output"
33940Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33941batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33942be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33943delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33944envelope along with the message.
33945
33946The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33947MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33948the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33949HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33950can be used to specify it.
33951
33952Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33953one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33954to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33955this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33956chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33957
33958.vindex "&$host$&"
33959When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33960sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33961transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33962router:
33963.code
33964begin routers
33965route_append:
33966 driver = manualroute
33967 transport = smtp_appendfile
33968 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33969
33970begin transports
33971smtp_appendfile:
33972 driver = appendfile
33973 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33974 batch_max = 1000
33975 use_bsmtp
33976 user = exim
33977.endd
33978This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33979format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33980message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33981
33982
33983
33984.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33985.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33986.cindex "batched SMTP input"
33987The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33988reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33989is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33990sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33991rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33992and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33993as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33994
33995Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33996ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33997
33998If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33999the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
34000standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
34001make some use of automatically, for example:
34002.code
34003554 Unexpected end of file
34004Transaction started in line 10
34005Error detected in line 14
34006.endd
34007It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
34008file, for example:
34009.code
34010An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
34011The error message was:
34012
34013501 '>' missing at end of address
34014
34015The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
34016The error was detected in line 12.
34017The SMTP command at fault was:
34018
34019rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
34020
340211 previous message was successfully processed.
34022The rest of the batch was abandoned.
34023.endd
34024The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
34025messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
34026accepted.
34027.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
34028.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
34029
34030
34031
34032. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34033. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34034
34035.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
34036 "Customizing messages"
34037When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
34038configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
34039to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
34040the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
34041string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
34042
34043The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
34044cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
34045option. Exim also adds the line
34046.code
34047Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
34048.endd
34049to all warning and bounce messages,
34050
34051
34052.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
34053.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
34054.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
34055If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
34056message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
34057delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
34058&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
34059
34060When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
34061constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
34062separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
34063opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
34064logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
34065item.
34066
34067.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
34068.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
34069Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
34070expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
34071the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
34072&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
34073option, rounded to a whole number.
34074
34075The items must appear in the file in the following order:
34076
34077.ilist
34078The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34079&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34080.next
34081The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
34082failing addresses with their error messages.
34083.next
34084The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
34085returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
34086.next
34087The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
34088The fields exist for back-compatibility
34089.endlist
34090
34091The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
34092following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
34093other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
34094.code
34095Subject: Mail delivery failed
34096 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34097 {: returning message to sender}}
34098****
34099This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34100
34101A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
34102 {that you sent }{sent by
34103
34104<$sender_address>
34105
34106}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
34107This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
34108****
34109The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
34110****
34111------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
34112 ------
34113****
34114------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
34115 only the first
34116------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
34117****
34118.endd
34119.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
34120.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
34121.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
34122The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
34123warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
34124text sections:
34125
34126.ilist
34127The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34128&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34129.next
34130The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34131the delayed addresses.
34132.next
34133The third item then ends the message.
34134.endlist
34135
34136The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34137have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34138.code
34139Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34140 $warn_message_delay
34141****
34142This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34143
34144A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34145{that you sent }{sent by
34146
34147<$sender_address>
34148
34149}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34150more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34151
34152The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34153The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34154The date of the message is: $h_date
34155
34156The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34157****
34158No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34159continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34160intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34161mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34162the message will be returned to you.
34163.endd
34164.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34165.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34166However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34167appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34168&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34169minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34170of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34171multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34172handled them.
34173
34174
34175
34176
34177. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34178. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34179
34180.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34181This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34182common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34183
34184
34185
34186.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34187.cindex "smart host" "example router"
34188If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34189should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34190routing explicitly:
34191.code
34192send_to_smart_host:
34193 driver = manualroute
34194 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34195 transport = remote_smtp
34196.endd
34197You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34198If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34199receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34200synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34201&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34202
34203
34204
34205
34206.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34207.cindex "mailing lists"
34208Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34209requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34210Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34211
34212The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34213is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34214independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34215lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34216.code
34217lists:
34218 driver = redirect
34219 domains = lists.example
34220 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34221 forbid_pipe
34222 forbid_file
34223 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34224 no_more
34225.endd
34226This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34227in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34228such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34229routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34230
34231The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34232expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34233a mailing list.
34234
34235.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34236The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34237taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34238original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34239the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34240
34241For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34242&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34243&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34244&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34245There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34246the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34247such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34248or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34249&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34250
34251
34252
34253.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34254.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34255If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34256delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34257list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34258list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34259addresses are not rigorously checked.
34260
34261If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34262entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34263&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34264whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34265&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34266
34267
34268
34269.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34270.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34271Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34272in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34273recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34274cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34275delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34276account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34277the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34278message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34279
34280If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34281on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34282router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34283&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34284&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34285subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34286failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34287pre-existing messages.
34288
34289The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34290addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34291addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34292&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34293one level of expansion anyway.
34294
34295
34296
34297.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34298.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34299The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34300send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34301from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34302&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34303
34304The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34305of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34306.code
34307lists_request:
34308 driver = redirect
34309 domains = lists.example
34310 local_part_suffix = -request
34311 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34312 no_more
34313
34314lists_post:
34315 driver = redirect
34316 domains = lists.example
34317 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34318 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34319 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34320 forbid_pipe
34321 forbid_file
34322 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34323 no_more
34324
34325lists_closed:
34326 driver = redirect
34327 domains = lists.example
34328 allow_fail
34329 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34330.endd
34331All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34332they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34333&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34334mailing list.
34335
34336The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34337checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34338checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34339necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34340because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34341not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34342means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34343&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34344&"unrouteable address"& error.
34345
34346The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34347a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34348the address, giving a suitable error message.
34349
34350
34351
34352
34353.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34354.cindex "VERP"
34355.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34356.cindex "envelope sender"
34357Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34358are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34359address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34360the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34361if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34362original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34363
34364.oindex &%errors_to%&
34365.oindex &%return_path%&
34366Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34367facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34368list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34369these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34370host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34371of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34372of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34373.code
34374verp_smtp:
34375 driver = smtp
34376 max_rcpt = 1
34377 return_path = \
34378 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34379 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34380.endd
34381This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34382SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34383&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34384local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34385example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34386&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34387&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34388rewritten as
34389.code
34390somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34391.endd
34392.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34393For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34394have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34395achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34396might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34397&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34398
34399Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34400probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34401extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34402can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34403.code
34404dnslookup:
34405 driver = dnslookup
34406 domains = ! +local_domains
34407 transport = \
34408 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34409 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34410 no_more
34411.endd
34412If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34413of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34414routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34415errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34416address.
34417
34418On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34419&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34420SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34421and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34422of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34423.code
34424verp_dnslookup:
34425 driver = dnslookup
34426 domains = ! +local_domains
34427 transport = remote_smtp
34428 errors_to = \
34429 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34430 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34431 no_more
34432.endd
34433Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34434configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34435Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34436router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34437them.
34438
34439The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34440message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34441host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34442a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34443a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34444than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34445used).
34446
34447
34448
34449
34450
34451
34452.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34453.cindex "virtual domains"
34454.cindex "domain" "virtual"
34455The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34456meanings:
34457
34458.ilist
34459A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34460aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34461top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34462.next
34463One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34464with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34465have login accounts on that host.
34466.endlist
34467
34468The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34469the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34470aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34471virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34472whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34473to a router of this form:
34474.code
34475virtual:
34476 driver = redirect
34477 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34478 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34479 no_more
34480.endd
34481The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34482is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34483domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34484part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34485setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34486string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34487
34488This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34489follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34490can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34491a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34492
34493The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34494way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34495valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34496.code
34497my_domains:
34498 driver = accept
34499 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34500 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34501 transport = my_mailboxes
34502.endd
34503The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34504can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34505file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34506option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34507because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34508follows:
34509.code
34510my_mailboxes:
34511 driver = appendfile
34512 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34513 user = mail
34514.endd
34515This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34516required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34517
34518The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34519requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34520up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34521information about the domains.
34522
34523
34524
34525.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34526.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34527.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34528.cindex "local part" "prefix"
34529.cindex "local part" "suffix"
34530Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34531incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34532allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34533identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34534parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34535&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34536example, consider this router:
34537.code
34538userforward:
34539 driver = redirect
34540 check_local_user
34541 file = $home/.forward
34542 local_part_suffix = -*
34543 local_part_suffix_optional
34544 allow_filter
34545.endd
34546.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34547It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34548&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34549cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34550.code
34551if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34552save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34553endif
34554.endd
34555If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34556fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34557&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34558control over which suffixes are valid.
34559
34560Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34561&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34562another MTA:
34563.code
34564userforward:
34565 driver = redirect
34566 check_local_user
34567 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34568 local_part_suffix = -*
34569 local_part_suffix_optional
34570 allow_filter
34571.endd
34572If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34573example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34574does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34575subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34576&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34577
34578
34579
34580.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34581.cindex "vacation processing"
34582The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34583a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34584(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34585This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34586that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34587
34588.ilist
34589A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34590can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34591alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34592&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34593.code
34594spqr, vacation-spqr
34595.endd
34596.next
34597The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34598vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34599user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34600ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34601to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34602message.
34603.endlist
34604
34605Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34606use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34607
34608
34609
34610.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34611.cindex "message" "copying every"
34612Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34613be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34614command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34615each day's messages.
34616
34617There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34618messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34619delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34620notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34621
34622
34623
34624.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34625.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34626It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34627Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34628arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34629permanently connected.
34630
34631Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34632particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34633Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34634
34635
34636.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34637It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34638host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34639approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34640being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34641some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34642to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34643resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34644
34645A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34646intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34647into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34648format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34649destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34650in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34651if required.
34652
34653On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34654you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34655intermittent host. For example:
34656.code
34657cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34658.endd
34659This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34660which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34661online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34662options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34663causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34664connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34665immediately.
34666
34667If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34668issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34669mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34670used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34671avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34672Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34673arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34674
34675
34676
34677.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34678The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34679increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34680connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34681delivered immediately.
34682
34683.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34684.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34685.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34686Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34687not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34688possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34689each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34690avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34691&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34692first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34693normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34694destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34695single SMTP connection.
34696
34697
34698
34699. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34700. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34701
34702.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34703 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34704.cindex "client, non-queueing"
34705.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34706On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34707email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34708configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34709However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34710configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34711&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34712messages this way.
34713
34714If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34715run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34716any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34717continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34718email is not desirable.
34719
34720There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34721&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34722any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34723host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34724informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34725to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34726to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34727
34728There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34729that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34730ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34731before sending a message to the smart host.
34732
34733Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34734tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34735overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34736
34737.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34738There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34739Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34740assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34741just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34742compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34743router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34744
34745When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34746following ways:
34747
34748.ilist
34749A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34750In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34751.next
34752Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34753assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34754&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34755does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34756successful, a zero return code is given.
34757.next
34758Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34759be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34760the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34761must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34762deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34763are.
34764.next
34765If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34766failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34767successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34768.next
34769Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34770is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34771smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34772the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34773there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34774.next
34775If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34776connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34777failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34778.next
34779When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34780(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34781value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34782are ever generated.
34783.next
34784No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34785.next
34786A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34787true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34788&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34789.endlist
34790
34791The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34792the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34793deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34794privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34795to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34796the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34797
34798
34799
34800
34801. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34802. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34803
34804.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34805.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34806.cindex "log" "types of"
34807Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34808and the panic log:
34809
34810.ilist
34811.cindex "main log"
34812The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34813line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34814down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34815out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34816them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34817they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34818analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34819&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34820.next
34821.cindex "reject log"
34822The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34823of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34824The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34825the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34826is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34827lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34828reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34829host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34830can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34831false.
34832.next
34833.cindex "panic log"
34834.cindex "system log"
34835When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34836error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34837are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34838other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34839therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34840regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34841panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34842is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34843message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34844.endlist
34845
34846Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34847example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34848In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34849.code
348502001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34851 by QUIT
34852.endd
34853By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34854ways of changing this:
34855
34856.ilist
34857You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34858you set
34859.code
34860timezone = UTC
34861.endd
34862the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34863.next
34864If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34865example:
34866.code
348672003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34868.endd
34869.endlist
34870
34871.cindex "log" "process ids in"
34872.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34873Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34874request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34875&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34876brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34877
34878
34879
34880
34881.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34882.cindex "log" "destination"
34883.cindex "log" "to file"
34884.cindex "log" "to syslog"
34885.cindex "syslog"
34886The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34887should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34888are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34889arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34890It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34891need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34892Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34893
34894The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34895&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34896configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34897references to the host name:
34898.code
34899log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34900.endd
34901It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34902rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34903start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34904before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34905configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34906log at all.
34907
34908The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34909list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34910facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34911colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34912otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34913point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34914implying the use of a default path.
34915
34916When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34917LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34918&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34919mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34920files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34921equivalent to the setting:
34922.code
34923log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34924.endd
34925If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34926or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34927that is where the logs are written.
34928
34929A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34930are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34931
34932Here are some examples of possible settings:
34933.display
34934&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34935&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34936&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34937&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34938.endd
34939If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34940error is logged.
34941
34942
34943
34944.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34945.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34946.cindex "cycling logs"
34947.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34948.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34949Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34950log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34951provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34952main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34953keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34954
34955An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34956and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34957example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34958message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34959that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34960something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34961ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34962&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34963does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34964tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34965for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34966renamed.
34967
34968
34969
34970.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34971.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34972Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34973periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34974for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34975&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34976the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34977point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34978.code
34979log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34980log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34981log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34982log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34983.endd
34984As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34985examples of names generated by the above examples:
34986.code
34987/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34988/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34989/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34990/var/log/exim/main.200212
34991.endd
34992When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34993files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34994will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34995run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34996
34997The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34998is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34999When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
35000the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
35001non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
35002character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
35003log names:
35004.code
35005/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35006/var/log/exim-panic.log
35007/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
35008/var/log/exim/panic
35009.endd
35010
35011
35012.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
35013.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
35014The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
35015except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
35016Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
35017that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
35018&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
35019by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
35020&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
35021SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
35022&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
35023LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
35024the time and host name to each line.
35025The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
35026
35027.ilist
35028&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
35029.next
35030&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
35031.next
35032&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
35033.endlist
35034
35035Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
35036written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
35037these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
35038by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
35039
35040Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
35041entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
35042these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
35043calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
35044870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
35045additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
35046replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
35047RFC 3164, you should set
35048.code
35049SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
35050.endd
35051in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
35052lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
35053
35054To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
35055entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
35056where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
35057components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
35058because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
35059delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
35060870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
35061&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
35062name, and pid as added by syslog:
35063.code
35064[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
35065[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
35066[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
35067[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
35068[5/5] mple>)
35069.endd
35070The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
35071(LOG_NOTICE):
35072.code
35073[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
35074[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
35075[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
35076[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
35077[5\18] .example>)
35078[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
35079[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
35080[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
35081[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
35082[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
35083[11\18] 09:43 +0100
35084[12\18] F From: <>
35085[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
35086[18\18] X-something: this is another header
35087[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
35088[16\18] le>
35089[17\18] B Bcc:
35090[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
35091.endd
35092Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
35093without modification.
35094
35095If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
35096display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
35097the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
35098where it is.
35099
35100
35101
35102.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
35103One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
35104successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
35105picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
35106timestamp. The flags are:
35107.display
35108&`<=`& message arrival
35109&`=>`& normal message delivery
35110&`->`& additional address in same delivery
35111&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
35112&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
35113&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
35114&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
35115.endd
35116
35117
35118.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
35119.cindex "log" "reception line"
35120The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35121message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
35122several lines in order to fit it on the page:
35123.code
351242002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
35125 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35126 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35127.endd
35128The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35129bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35130generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35131.code
35132R=<message id>
35133.endd
35134which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35135
35136.cindex "HELO"
35137.cindex "EHLO"
35138For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35139record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35140received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35141host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35142above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35143&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35144by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35145verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35146EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35147name in parentheses.
35148
35149Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35150without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35151the log containing text like these examples:
35152.code
35153H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35154H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35155.endd
35156This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35157on.
35158
35159For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35160the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35161of Exim.
35162
35163.cindex "authentication" "logging"
35164.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35165For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35166message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35167of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35168extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35169session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35170suite that was used.
35171
35172The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35173hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35174value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35175there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35176was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35177&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35178authenticator name.
35179
35180.cindex "size" "of message"
35181The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35182received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35183headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35184message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35185other).
35186
35187The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35188data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35189
35190
35191
35192.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35193.cindex "log" "delivery line"
35194The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35195delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35196deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
35197to fit it on the page:
35198.code
351992002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35200 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
352012002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35202 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35203 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35204.endd
35205For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35206after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35207intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35208last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35209fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35210
35211If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35212followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35213If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35214option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35215
35216If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35217for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35218.display
35219&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35220.endd
35221If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35222parentheses afterwards.
35223
35224.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35225When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35226SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35227flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35228down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35229lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35230
35231.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35232.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35233When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35234line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35235rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35236
35237The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35238&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35239
35240The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35241data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35242
35243
35244.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35245.cindex "discarded messages"
35246.cindex "message" "discarded"
35247.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35248When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35249obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35250.code
352512002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35252 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35253.endd
35254is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35255because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35256.code
352571999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35258 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35259.endd
35260
35261
35262.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35263When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35264.code
352652002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35266 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35267.endd
35268In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35269last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35270written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35271.code
352722002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35273 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35274.endd
35275When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35276a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35277appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35278
35279
35280
35281.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35282.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35283If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35284following form is logged:
35285.code
352861995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35287 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35288.endd
35289If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35290the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35291.code
352922002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35293 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35294 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35295 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35296 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35297.endd
35298The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35299used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35300disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35301flagged with &`**`&.
35302
35303
35304
35305.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35306.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35307If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35308used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35309&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35310
35311
35312
35313.section "Completion" "SECID257"
35314A line of the form
35315.code
353162002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35317.endd
35318is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35319at the end of its processing.
35320
35321
35322
35323
35324.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35325.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35326A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35327the following table:
35328.display
35329&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35330&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35331&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35332&`CV `& certificate verification status
35333&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35334&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35335&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35336&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35337&`H `& host name and IP address
35338&`I `& local interface used
35339&`id `& message id for incoming message
35340&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35341&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35342&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35343&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35344&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35345&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35346&`S `& size of message
35347&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35348&`ST `& shadow transport name
35349&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35350&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35351&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35352&`X `& TLS cipher suite
35353.endd
35354
35355
35356.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35357Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35358self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35359
35360.ilist
35361.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35362&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35363during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35364This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35365during the first delivery attempt.
35366.next
35367&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35368temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35369for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35370.next
35371.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35372&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35373some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35374common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35375&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35376doing.
35377.next
35378.cindex "error" "ignored"
35379&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35380message:
35381.olist
35382Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35383&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35384.next
35385A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35386failed. The delivery was discarded.
35387.next
35388A delivery set up by a router configured with
35389. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35390. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35391.code
35392 errors_to = <>
35393.endd
35394failed. The delivery was discarded.
35395.endlist olist
35396.endlist ilist
35397
35398
35399
35400
35401
35402.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35403.cindex "log" "selectors"
35404By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35405default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35406&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35407example:
35408.code
35409log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35410.endd
35411The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35412selection marked by asterisks:
35413.display
35414&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35415&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35416&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35417&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35418&` arguments `& command line arguments
35419&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35420&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35421&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35422&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35423&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35424&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35425&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35426&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35427&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35428&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35429&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35430.new
35431&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
35432.wen
35433&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35434&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35435&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35436&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35437&` pid `& Exim process id
35438&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35439&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35440&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35441&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35442&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35443&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35444&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35445&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35446&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35447&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35448&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35449&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35450&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35451&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35452&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35453&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35454&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35455&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35456&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35457&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35458&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35459&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35460
35461&` all `& all of the above
35462.endd
35463See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
35464section &<<SECID99>>&
35465
35466More details on each of these items follows:
35467
35468.ilist
35469.cindex "8BITMIME"
35470.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35471&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35472which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35473that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35474&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35475&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35476.next
35477.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35478&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35479its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35480this log selector is set.
35481.next
35482.cindex "log" "rewriting"
35483.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35484&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35485rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35486such users cannot access the log).
35487.next
35488.cindex "log" "full parentage"
35489&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35490delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35491parentheses between them.
35492.next
35493.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35494.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35495&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35496to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35497feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35498&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35499privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35500that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35501are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35502because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35503only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35504between the caller and Exim.
35505.next
35506.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35507&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35508connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35509.next
35510.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35511.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35512&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35513started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35514messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35515process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35516.next
35517.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35518&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35519perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35520.next
35521.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35522.cindex "size" "of message"
35523&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35524the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35525.next
35526.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35527.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35528.cindex "black list (DNS)"
35529&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35530DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35531.next
35532.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35533.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35534&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35535is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35536command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35537selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35538.next
35539.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35540&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35541any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35542log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35543routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35544.next
35545.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35546.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35547&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35548client's ident port times out.
35549.next
35550.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35551.cindex "log" "local interface"
35552.cindex "log" "local address and port"
35553.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35554.cindex "interface" "logging"
35555&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35556to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35557followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35558added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
35559rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
35560.new
35561The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35562.wen
35563.next
35564.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35565.cindex "port" "logging remote"
35566.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35567.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35568.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35569&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35570added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35571in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35572changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35573&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35574important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35575.next
35576.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35577&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35578connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35579.next
35580.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
35581.cindex "log" "local interface"
35582.cindex "log" "local address and port"
35583.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35584.cindex "interface" "logging"
35585.new
35586&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
35587interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
35588followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
35589off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
35590.wen
35591.next
35592.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35593.cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35594.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35595&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35596containing => tags) following the IP address.
35597.new
35598The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
35599&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
35600.wen
35601This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
35602configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
35603local port is a random ephemeral port.
35604.next
35605.cindex "log" "process ids in"
35606.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35607&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35608immediately after the time and date.
35609.next
35610.cindex "log" "queue run"
35611.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35612&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35613.next
35614.cindex "log" "queue time"
35615&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35616local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35617&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35618includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35619This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35620delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35621message has been successfully received.
35622.next
35623&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35624the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35625example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35626message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35627.next
35628.cindex "log" "recipients"
35629&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35630as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35631that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35632addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35633has taken place.
35634Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35635in the list.
35636.next
35637.cindex "log" "sender reception"
35638&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35639the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35640&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35641.next
35642.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35643&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35644rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35645log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35646rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35647.next
35648.cindex "log" "retry defer"
35649&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35650retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35651message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35652attempt.
35653.next
35654.cindex "log" "return path"
35655&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35656the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35657This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35658or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35659.next
35660.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35661&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35662and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35663This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35664necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35665.next
35666.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35667&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35668gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35669the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35670detail is lost.
35671.next
35672.cindex "log" "size rejection"
35673&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35674it is too big.
35675.next
35676.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35677.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35678&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35679queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35680it.
35681.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35682The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35683.next
35684.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35685.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35686.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35687&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35688outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35689A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35690response.
35691.next
35692.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35693.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35694&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35695established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35696&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35697only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35698processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35699dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35700not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35701of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35702
35703For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35704included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35705reset if the daemon is restarted.
35706Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35707subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35708whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35709match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35710logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35711.next
35712.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35713.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35714&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35715RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35716and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35717line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35718.next
35719.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35720.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35721&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35722connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35723the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35724does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35725an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35726already have their own log lines.
35727
35728The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35729way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35730If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35731an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35732DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35733the same logging options.
35734
35735Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35736is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35737.code
35738C=EHLO,QUIT
35739.endd
35740shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35741than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35742the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35743setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35744have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35745.next
35746&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35747colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35748log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35749was accepted or used.
35750.next
35751.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35752.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35753&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35754encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35755because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35756been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35757it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35758received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35759.next
35760.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35761.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35762.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35763.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35764.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35765&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35766encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35767external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35768using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35769.next
35770.cindex "log" "subject"
35771.cindex "subject, logging"
35772&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35773preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35774Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35775specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35776unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35777.next
35778.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35779&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35780when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35781verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35782.next
35783.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35784.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35785&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35786connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35787.next
35788.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35789.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35790&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35791connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35792added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35793.next
35794.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35795.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35796&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35797the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35798added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35799.next
35800.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35801&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35802result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35803.endlist
35804
35805
35806.section "Message log" "SECID260"
35807.cindex "message" "log file for"
35808.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35809.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35810.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35811In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35812that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35813they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35814message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35815makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35816to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35817is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35818only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35819
35820On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35821per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35822&%message_logs%& option false.
35823.ecindex IIDloggen
35824
35825
35826
35827
35828. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35829. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35830
35831.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35832.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35833A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35834described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35835the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35836
35837.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35838.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35839 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35840.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35841.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35842.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35843.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35844 various criteria"
35845.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35846.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35847 "extract statistics from the log"
35848.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35849 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35850.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35851.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35852.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35853.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35854.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35855.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35856.endtable
35857
35858Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35859&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35860&url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35861
35862
35863
35864
35865.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35866.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35867.cindex "process, querying"
35868.cindex "SIGUSR1"
35869On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35870(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35871a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35872Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35873processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35874second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35875order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35876send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35877
35878&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35879use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35880script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35881
35882
35883Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35884varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35885but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35886system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35887it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35888options:
35889.display
35890&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35891&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35892&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35893&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35894.endd
35895An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35896.code
35897164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3589810483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3589910492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35900 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3590110592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3590210628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35903.endd
35904The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35905been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35906
35907
35908
35909.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35910.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35911.cindex "queue" "grepping"
35912This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35913.code
35914exim -bpu
35915.endd
35916or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35917.code
35918exim -bp
35919.endd
35920The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35921contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35922
35923to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35924that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35925
35926.vlist
35927.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35928Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35929tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35930.code
35931exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35932.endd
35933.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35934Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35935tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35936
35937.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35938Match against the size field.
35939
35940.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35941Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35942
35943.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35944Match messages that are older than the given time.
35945
35946.vitem &*-z*&
35947Match only frozen messages.
35948
35949.vitem &*-x*&
35950Match only non-frozen messages.
35951.endlist
35952
35953The following options control the format of the output:
35954
35955.vlist
35956.vitem &*-c*&
35957Display only the count of matching messages.
35958
35959.vitem &*-l*&
35960Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35961the default.
35962
35963.vitem &*-i*&
35964Display message ids only.
35965
35966.vitem &*-b*&
35967Brief format &-- one line per message.
35968
35969.vitem &*-R*&
35970Display messages in reverse order.
35971
35972.vitem &*-a*&
35973Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35974.endlist
35975
35976There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35977
35978
35979
35980.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35981.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35982.cindex "queue" "summary"
35983The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35984-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35985running a command such as
35986.code
35987exim -bp | exiqsumm
35988.endd
35989The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35990it, as in the following example:
35991.code
359923 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35993.endd
35994Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35995volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35996been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35997number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35998
35999A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
36000domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
36001the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
36002respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
36003domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
36004separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
36005sender.
36006
36007The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
36008this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
36009generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
36010option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
36011level"& addresses).
36012
36013
36014
36015
36016.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
36017 "SECTextspeinf"
36018.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
36019.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
36020The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
36021files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
36022extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
36023match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
36024given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
36025The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
36026If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
36027included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
36028.display
36029&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
36030.endd
36031If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
36032
36033The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
36034condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
36035they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
36036
36037By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
36038makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
36039large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
36040option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
36041case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
36042
36043The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
36044pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
36045regular expression.
36046
36047The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
36048if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
36049
36050The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
36051that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
36052normally.
36053
36054Example of &%-M%&:
36055user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
36056&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
36057displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
36058the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
36059when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
36060&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
36061search term.
36062
36063If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
36064ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
36065whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
36066If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
36067autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
36068
36069
36070.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
36071.cindex "&'exipick'&"
36072John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
36073lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
36074of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
36075&url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
36076the &%--help%& option.
36077
36078
36079.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
36080.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36081.cindex "cycling logs"
36082.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36083The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
36084&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
36085you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
36086&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
36087for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
36088There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
36089.ilist
36090&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
36091default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
36092.next
36093&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
36094&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
36095overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
36096configuration.
36097.endlist
36098
36099Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
36100the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
36101run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
36102&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
36103&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
36104logs are handled similarly.
36105
36106If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
36107&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
36108to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
36109any existing log files.
36110
36111If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
36112the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
36113using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
36114setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
36115root &%crontab%& entry of the form
36116.code
361171 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
36118.endd
36119assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
36120&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
36121
36122
36123
36124.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
36125.cindex "statistics"
36126.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
36127A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
36128information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
36129Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
36130LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
36131
36132The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
36133latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
36134lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
36135various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
36136list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
36137.code
36138eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
36139.endd
36140By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
36141messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
36142both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
36143are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
36144addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
36145options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
36146also produced per user.
36147
36148The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
36149histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
36150hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36151example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36152as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36153
36154Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36155have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36156messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36157and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36158recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36159an entirely separate message.
36160
36161&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36162of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36163each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36164not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36165least one address that failed.
36166
36167The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36168or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36169transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36170(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36171a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36172senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36173and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36174
36175The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36176came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36177without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36178
36179There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36180outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36181by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36182.code
36183perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36184.endd
36185
36186.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36187.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36188.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36189.cindex "checking access"
36190The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36191debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36192policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36193familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36194sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36195access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36196
36197The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36198two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36199.code
36200exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36201.endd
36202The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36203given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36204connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36205is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36206.code
36207Rejected:
36208550 Relay not permitted
36209.endd
36210When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36211for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36212options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36213that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36214you can use:
36215.code
36216exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36217 -f himself@there.example
36218.endd
36219Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36220mandatory arguments.
36221
36222Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36223while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36224&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36225
36226
36227
36228.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36229.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36230.cindex "building DBM files"
36231.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36232.cindex "lower casing"
36233.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36234The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36235the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36236&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36237names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36238can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36239
36240A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36241the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36242&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36243strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36244files.
36245
36246The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36247single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36248It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36249well.
36250
36251.cindex "USE_DB"
36252If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36253configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36254names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36255a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36256.code
36257exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36258.endd
36259reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36260&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36261
36262In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36263Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36264environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36265&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36266when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36267recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36268
36269If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36270finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36271option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36272this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36273&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36274There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36275&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36276return code is 2.
36277
36278
36279
36280
36281.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36282.cindex "retry" "times"
36283.cindex "&'exinext'&"
36284A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36285fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36286complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36287information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36288is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36289output. For example:
36290.code
36291$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36292kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36293 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36294 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36295 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36296roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36297 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36298 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36299 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36300 past final cutoff time
36301.endd
36302You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36303will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36304A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36305message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36306suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36307&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36308run very often.
36309
36310The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36311of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36312passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36313configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36314file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36315environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36316
36317
36318
36319.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36320.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36321.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36322Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36323uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36324arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36325second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36326
36327.ilist
36328&'retry'&: the database of retry information
36329.next
36330&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36331for remote hosts
36332.next
36333&'callout'&: the callout cache
36334.next
36335&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36336.next
36337&'misc'&: other hints data
36338.endlist
36339
36340The &'misc'& database is used for
36341
36342.ilist
36343Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36344.next
36345Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36346&(smtp)& transport)
36347.next
36348Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
36349in a transport)
36350.endlist
36351
36352
36353
36354.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36355.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36356The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36357&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36358spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36359.code
36360exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36361.endd
36362Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36363.code
36364T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3636531-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36366.endd
36367The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36368of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36369transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36370a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36371address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36372transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36373to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36374and a textual description of the error.
36375
36376The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36377the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36378ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36379exceeded.
36380
36381Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36382consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36383waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36384one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36385may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36386may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36387cross-references.
36388
36389
36390
36391.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36392.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36393The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36394database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36395days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36396updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36397since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36398for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36399updated sufficiently often.
36400
36401The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36402followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36403the retry database:
36404.code
36405exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36406.endd
36407Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36408message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36409they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36410are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36411types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36412message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36413queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36414&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36415For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36416removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36417whenever it removes information from the database.
36418
36419Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36420needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36421down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36422first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36423records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36424
36425It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36426hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36427a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36428work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36429but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36430After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36431point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36432tidied.
36433
36434&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36435databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36436
36437
36438
36439
36440.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36441.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36442The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36443Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36444getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36445is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36446key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36447displayed.
36448
36449If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36450except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36451out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36452data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36453by new data, for example:
36454.code
36455> 4 951102:1000
36456.endd
36457resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36458sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36459used as optional separators.
36460
36461
36462
36463
36464.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36465.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36466.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36467.cindex "locking mailboxes"
36468The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36469Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36470&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36471a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36472the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36473argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36474second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36475is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36476is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36477
36478.vlist
36479.vitem &%-fcntl%&
36480Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36481
36482.vitem &%-flock%&
36483Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36484supports it.
36485
36486.vitem &%-interval%&
36487This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36488interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36489
36490.vitem &%-lockfile%&
36491Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36492
36493.vitem &%-mbx%&
36494Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36495
36496.vitem &%-q%&
36497Suppress verification output.
36498
36499.vitem &%-retries%&
36500This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36501the lock (default 10).
36502
36503.vitem &%-restore_time%&
36504This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36505locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36506example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36507subsequently sees.
36508
36509.vitem &%-timeout%&
36510This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36511timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36512default), a non-blocking call is used.
36513
36514.vitem &%-v%&
36515Generate verbose output.
36516.endlist
36517
36518If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36519default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36520mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36521&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36522requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36523file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36524more than 30 minutes old.
36525
36526The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36527&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36528to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36529&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36530number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36531can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36532
36533The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36534&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36535suppresses all output except error messages.
36536
36537A command such as
36538.code
36539exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36540.endd
36541runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36542.display
36543&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36544<&'some commands'&>
36545&`End`&
36546.endd
36547runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36548suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36549such as
36550.code
36551exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36552 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36553.endd
36554Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36555second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36556.ecindex IIDutils
36557
36558
36559. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36560. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36561
36562.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36563.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36564.cindex "X-windows"
36565.cindex "&'eximon'&"
36566.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36567.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36568The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36569about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36570perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36571such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36572monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36573
36574
36575
36576.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36577The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36578script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36579binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36580be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36581&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36582parameters are for.
36583
36584The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36585a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36586preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36587.code
36588EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36589.endd
36590(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36591the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36592overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36593&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36594syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36595
36596X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36597way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36598.code
36599Eximon*background: gray94
36600.endd
36601changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36602stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36603black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36604data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36605&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36606For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36607reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36608.code
36609xrdb -merge <<End
36610Eximon*highlight: gray
36611End
36612.endd
36613.cindex "admin user"
36614In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36615&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36616
36617The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36618contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36619if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36620binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36621versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36622
36623The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36624more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36625main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36626delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36627different parts of the display.
36628
36629
36630
36631
36632.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36633.cindex "stripchart"
36634The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36635be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36636&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36637configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36638it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36639hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36640received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36641period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36642parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36643
36644The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36645displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36646title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36647For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36648
36649It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36650a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36651to a single partition.
36652
36653.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36654This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36655the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36656this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36657100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36658SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36659&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36660
36661
36662
36663
36664.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36665.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36666.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36667.cindex "window size"
36668Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36669to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36670shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36671stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36672the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36673in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36674
36675When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36676currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36677size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36678remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36679
36680The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36681stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36682the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36683The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36684&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36685the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36686
36687Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36688built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36689START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36690
36691
36692
36693.section "The log display" "SECID267"
36694.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36695The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36696the main log is maintained.
36697To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36698removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36699The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36700syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36701to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36702
36703The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36704move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36705scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36706LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36707to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36708much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36709a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36710only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36711available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36712normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36713configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36714
36715Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36716and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36717respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36718It cannot go further back up the log.
36719
36720The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36721normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36722by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36723by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36724back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36725the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36726
36727Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36728There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36729the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36730happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36731&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36732^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36733
36734The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36735widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36736&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36737eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36738However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36739provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36740come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36741unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36742on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36743window.
36744
36745
36746
36747.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36748.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36749The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36750are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36751as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36752parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36753at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36754the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36755there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36756to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36757
36758When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36759and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36760with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36761pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36762type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36763such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36764of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36765
36766If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36767are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36768example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36769&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36770has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36771cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36772a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36773
36774While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36775else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36776queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36777pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36778
36779The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36780time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36781message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36782a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36783recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36784listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36785an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36786not shown.
36787
36788.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36789If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36790
36791The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36792of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36793The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36794available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36795display is updated.
36796
36797
36798
36799.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36800.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36801If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36802pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36803line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36804any selected text.
36805
36806If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36807MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36808set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36809value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36810run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36811.code
36812EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36813.endd
36814The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36815follows:
36816
36817.ilist
36818&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36819in a new text window.
36820.next
36821&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36822information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36823&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36824.next
36825&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36826displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36827amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36828option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36829.next
36830&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36831delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36832frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36833a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36834up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36835.next
36836&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36837that the message be frozen.
36838.next
36839.cindex "thawing messages"
36840.cindex "unfreezing messages"
36841.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36842&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36843that the message be thawed.
36844.next
36845.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36846&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36847that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36848for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36849.next
36850&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36851that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36852message.
36853.next
36854&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36855be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36856is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36857Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36858causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36859additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36860which case no action is taken.
36861.next
36862&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36863can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36864is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36865Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36866causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36867recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36868case no action is taken.
36869.next
36870&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36871mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36872.next
36873&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36874sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36875&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36876in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36877bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36878not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36879the address is qualified with that domain.
36880.endlist
36881
36882When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36883other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36884particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36885output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36886from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36887&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36888if no output is generated.
36889
36890The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36891thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36892&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36893force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36894
36895In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36896cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36897and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36898.ecindex IIDeximon
36899
36900
36901
36902
36903
36904. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36905. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36906
36907.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36908.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36909This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36910which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36911
36912For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36913Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36914existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36915chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36916security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36917its security as compared with other MTAs.
36918
36919What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36920have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36921absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36922as soon as possible.
36923
36924
36925.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36926.cindex "security" "build-time features"
36927There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36928to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36929Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36930penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36931
36932.ilist
36933ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36934start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36935names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36936value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36937&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36938default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36939
36940If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36941which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36942into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36943configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36944.next
36945
36946If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36947or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36948file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36949the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36950root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36951right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36952reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36953it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36954privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36955separate commands.
36956
36957.next
36958The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36959with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36960CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36961requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36962the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36963but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36964previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36965.next
36966If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36967is disabled.
36968.next
36969FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36970never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36971option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36972to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36973is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36974.endlist
36975
36976
36977
36978.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36979.cindex "setuid"
36980.cindex "root privilege"
36981The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36982privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36983example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36984may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36985discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36986is required for two things:
36987
36988.ilist
36989To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36990the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36991not required.
36992.next
36993To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36994perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36995configuration.
36996.endlist
36997
36998It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36999receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
37000obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
37001For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
37002&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
37003group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
37004is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
37005&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
37006
37007Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
37008abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
37009&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
37010
37011After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
37012uid and gid in the following cases:
37013
37014.ilist
37015.oindex "&%-C%&"
37016.oindex "&%-D%&"
37017If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
37018the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
37019calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
37020the calling process.
37021However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
37022option may not be used at all.
37023If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
37024can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
37025user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
37026.next
37027.oindex "&%-be%&"
37028.oindex "&%-bf%&"
37029.oindex "&%-bF%&"
37030If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
37031(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
37032calling process.
37033.next
37034If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
37035process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
37036uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
37037runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
37038testing address verification
37039.oindex "&%-bv%&"
37040.oindex "&%-bh%&"
37041(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
37042option).
37043.next
37044For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
37045remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
37046.endlist
37047
37048The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
37049
37050.ilist
37051A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
37052user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
37053function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
37054will be used during message reception.
37055.next
37056A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
37057job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
37058.next
37059A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
37060but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
37061subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
37062deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
37063remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
37064subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
37065while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
37066generating bounce and warning messages.
37067
37068While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
37069process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
37070this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
37071gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
37072.next
37073A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
37074the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
37075.endlist
37076
37077
37078
37079
37080.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
37081.cindex "privilege, running without"
37082.cindex "unprivileged running"
37083.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
37084Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
37085operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
37086by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
37087gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
37088(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
37089routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
37090to any other uid.
37091
37092.cindex SIGHUP
37093.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
37094Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
37095that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
37096correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
37097
37098An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
37099to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
37100process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
37101when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
37102SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
37103
37104It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
37105stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
37106been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
37107effect.
37108
37109If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
37110set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
37111to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
37112
37113In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
37114those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
37115Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
37116that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
37117discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
37118have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
37119number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
37120address this problem at this time.
37121
37122For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
37123is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
37124&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
37125be used in the most straightforward way.
37126
37127If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
37128number of restrictions on what you can do:
37129
37130.ilist
37131You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
37132&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
37133normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
37134work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
37135explicit specification of another user causes an error.
37136.next
37137Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
37138not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
37139.next
37140Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
37141the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
37142and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
37143enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
37144.next
37145Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
37146some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
37147
37148.olist
37149They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
37150implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
37151mode of the mailbox files themselves.
37152.next
37153You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37154owned by the Exim user.
37155.next
37156You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37157on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37158mailboxes need to be created manually.
37159.endlist olist
37160.endlist ilist
37161
37162
37163These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37164However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37165gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37166gives more security at essentially no cost.
37167
37168If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37169&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37170
37171
37172
37173
37174.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37175Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37176are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37177
37178
37179
37180.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37181.cindex "security" "local commands"
37182.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37183There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37184commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37185configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37186run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37187
37188.ilist
37189Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37190injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37191be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37192allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37193has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37194.next
37195A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37196&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37197&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37198hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37199NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37200forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37201need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37202.next
37203The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37204administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37205Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37206.next
37207Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37208taint checking might apply to their usage.
37209.next
37210Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37211administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37212instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37213.next
37214Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37215Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37216each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37217of opaque strings.
37218The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37219real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37220injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37221Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37222.endlist
37223
37224
37225
37226
37227.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37228.cindex "security" "data sources"
37229.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37230.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37231.cindex "PCRE" "security"
37232If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37233are some issues to be aware of:
37234
37235.ilist
37236Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37237.next
37238Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37239.next
37240Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37241data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37242"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37243expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37244when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37245possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37246data.
37247.next
37248It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37249&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37250items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37251.next
37252Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37253expected to yield one result.
37254.endlist
37255
37256
37257
37258
37259.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37260.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37261.cindex "IP source routing"
37262Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37263some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37264IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37265IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37266
37267
37268
37269.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37270Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37271be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37272
37273
37274
37275
37276.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37277.cindex "trusted users"
37278.cindex "admin user"
37279.cindex "privileged user"
37280.cindex "user" "trusted"
37281.cindex "user" "admin"
37282Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37283able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37284addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37285local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37286permit a remote host to be specified.
37287
37288.oindex "&%-f%&"
37289However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37290in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37291message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37292but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37293permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37294the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37295
37296Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37297other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37298the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37299as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37300group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37301
37302Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37303can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37304them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37305the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37306includes the contents of files on the spool.
37307
37308.oindex "&%-M%&"
37309.oindex "&%-q%&"
37310By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37311delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37312restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37313Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37314queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37315setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37316
37317Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37318the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37319the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37320group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37321the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37322unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37323files.
37324
37325
37326
37327.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37328.cindex "spool directory" "files"
37329Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37330set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37331&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37332any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37333
37334
37335
37336.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37337Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37338of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37339with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37340to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37341this.
37342
37343
37344
37345.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37346The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37347are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37348Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37349converted output.
37350
37351
37352
37353.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37354Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37355to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37356does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37357arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37358
37359
37360
37361.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37362Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37363defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37364loading it.
37365
37366
37367.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37368.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37369A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37370&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37371The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37372that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37373conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37374
37375The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37376the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37377string.
37378
37379
37380
37381.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37382Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37383formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37384the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37385
37386
37387
37388.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37389These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37390enough to hold the result.
37391.ecindex IIDsecurcon
37392
37393
37394
37395
37396. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37397. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37398
37399.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37400.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37401.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37402.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37403.cindex "spool files" "editing"
37404A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37405followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37406the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37407kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37408two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37409is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37410themselves are recoverable.
37411
37412Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37413need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37414on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37415
37416.ilist
37417You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37418fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37419which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37420place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37421lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37422.next
37423.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37424If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37425&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37426present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37427will always be the case.
37428.next
37429If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37430.next
37431If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37432signature.
37433.endlist
37434All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37435
37436Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37437its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37438files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37439the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37440the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37441is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37442file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37443-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37444attempt.
37445
37446.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37447.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37448.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37449The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37450process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37451gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37452message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37453normally the Exim user.
37454
37455The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37456transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37457empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37458in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37459created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37460&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37461leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37462&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37463
37464The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37465was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37466start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37467warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37468
37469There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37470order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37471
37472.vlist
37473.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37474This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37475&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37476recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37477this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37478identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37479the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37480the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37481the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37482newlines.
37483
37484.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37485A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37486defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37487The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37488starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37489character. It may contain internal newlines.
37490
37491.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37492A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37493Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37494length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37495starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37496character. It may contain internal newlines.
37497
37498.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37499This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37500&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37501
37502.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37503This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37504lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37505transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37506messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37507
37508.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37509This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37510(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37511time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37512hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37513
37514.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37515The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37516&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37517
37518.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37519The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37520&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37521
37522.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37523This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37524present.
37525
37526.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37527This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37528present if the number is greater than zero.
37529
37530.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37531This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37532file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37533
37534.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37535.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37536The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37537
37538.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37539This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37540command.
37541
37542.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37543This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37544the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37545messages.
37546
37547.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37548If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37549the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37550&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37551
37552.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37553This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37554address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37555
37556.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37557.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37558.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37559This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37560if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37561received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37562
37563.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37564For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37565unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37566ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37567supplied by the remote host, if any.
37568
37569.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37570This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37571which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37572generated messages.
37573
37574.vitem &%-local%&
37575The message is from a local sender.
37576
37577.vitem &%-localerror%&
37578The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37579
37580.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37581This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37582when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37583variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37584
37585.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37586The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37587Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37588
37589.vitem &%-N%&
37590A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37591actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37592&%-N%& is assumed.
37593
37594.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37595This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37596the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37597
37598.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37599The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37600to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37601
37602.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37603If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37604of &$spam_score_int$&.
37605
37606.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37607A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37608certificate was verified by the server.
37609
37610.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37611When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37612name of the cipher suite that was used.
37613
37614.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37615When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37616was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37617certificate.
37618.endlist
37619
37620Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37621is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37622line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37623is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37624the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37625balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37626to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37627original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37628addresses are complete.
37629
37630If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37631the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37632Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37633tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37634right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37635follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37636.code
37637YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37638NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37639NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37640.endd
37641After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37642This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37643recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37644delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37645example:
37646.code
376474
37648editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37649darcy@austen.fict.example
37650rdo@foundation
37651alice@wonderland.fict.example
37652.endd
37653However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37654result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37655line is of the following form:
37656.display
37657<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37658 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37659.endd
37660The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37661the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37662fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37663original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37664envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37665length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37666characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37667that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37668
37669
37670A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37671which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37672when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37673character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37674embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37675following:
37676
37677.table2 50pt
37678.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37679.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37680.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37681.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37682.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37683.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37684.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37685.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37686.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37687.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37688.endtable
37689
37690Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37691purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37692typical set of headers:
37693.code
37694111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37695id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37696049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37697038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37698042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37699049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37700099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37701darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37702104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37703darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37704038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37705.endd
37706The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37707&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37708unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37709.ecindex IIDforspo1
37710.ecindex IIDforspo2
37711.ecindex IIDforspo3
37712
37713. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37714. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37715
37716.chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37717 "DKIM Support"
37718.cindex "DKIM"
37719
37720DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37721linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37722be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37723DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37724
37725Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37726disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37727
37728Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37729.olist
37730Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37731It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37732(including transport filters)
37733except cutthrough delivery.
37734.next
37735Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37736ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37737different signature contexts.
37738.endlist
37739
37740In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37741default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37742Exim's standard controls.
37743
37744Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37745on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37746exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37747signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37748.code
377492009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37750 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37751 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37752 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37753.endd
37754You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37755or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37756control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37757where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37758senders).
37759
37760
37761.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37762.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37763
37764Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37765These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37766
37767.option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37768MANDATORY:
37769The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37770option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37771
37772.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37773MANDATORY:
37774This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37775variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37776variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37777option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37778
37779.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37780MANDATORY:
37781This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37782&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37783The result can either
37784.ilist
37785be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37786.next
37787start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37788the private key.
37789.next
37790be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37791be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37792is set.
37793.endlist
37794
37795.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37796OPTIONAL:
37797This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37798The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37799The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37800only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37801
37802.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37803OPTIONAL:
37804This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37805should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37806either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37807unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37808variables here.
37809
37810.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37811OPTIONAL:
37812When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37813list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37814signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37815used.
37816
37817
37818.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37819.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37820
37821Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37822&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37823syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37824A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37825If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
37826If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37827summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37828
37829To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37830containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37831runtime of the ACL.
37832
37833Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37834more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37835&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37836&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37837
37838The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37839list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37840called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37841the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37842list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37843&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37844it defaults as:
37845.code
37846dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37847.endd
37848This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37849DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37850call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37851.code
37852dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37853.endd
37854This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37855and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37856You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37857.code
37858dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37859.endd
37860
37861If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37862&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37863
37864
37865Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37866available (from most to least important):
37867
37868
37869.vlist
37870.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37871The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37872an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37873&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37874.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37875A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37876.ilist
37877&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37878identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37879.next
37880&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37881More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37882.next
37883&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37884available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37885.next
37886&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37887.endlist
37888.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37889A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37890"fail" or "invalid". One of
37891.ilist
37892&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37893key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37894.next
37895&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37896record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37897.next
37898&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37899body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37900means that the message body was modified in transit.
37901.next
37902&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37903could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37904re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37905DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37906.endlist
37907.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37908The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37909an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37910reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37911.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37912The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37913if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37914identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37915.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37916The key record selector string.
37917.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37918The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37919.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37920The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37921.vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37922The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37923.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37924A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37925(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37926.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37927The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37928limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37929that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37930.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37931UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37932When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37933.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37934UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37935signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37936signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37937integer size comparisons against this value.
37938.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37939A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37940.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37941"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37942.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37943"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37944.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37945Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37946in the key record.
37947.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37948Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37949in the key record.
37950.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37951Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37952.endlist
37953
37954In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37955
37956.vlist
37957.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37958ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37959for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37960(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37961verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37962
37963.code
37964# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37965warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37966 sender_domains = gmail.com
37967 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37968 dkim_status = none
37969.endd
37970
37971.vitem &%dkim_status%&
37972ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37973results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37974to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37975
37976.code
37977deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37978 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37979 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37980 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37981.endd
37982
37983The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37984see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37985for more information of what they mean.
37986.endlist
37987
37988. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37989. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37990
37991.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37992 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37993.cindex "adding drivers"
37994.cindex "new drivers, adding"
37995.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37996The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37997authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37998
37999.olist
38000Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
38001existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
38002.next
38003Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
38004.display
38005<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
38006.endd
38007where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
38008code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
38009should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
38010.next
38011Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
38012.code
38013#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
38014.endd
38015.next
38016Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
38017and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
38018.next
38019Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
38020near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
38021Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
38022As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
38023simple form that most lookups have.
38024.next
38025Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
38026&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
38027driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
38028.next
38029Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
38030&_src_&.
38031.next
38032Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
38033as for other drivers and lookups.
38034.endlist
38035
38036Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
38037proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
38038occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
38039options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
38040searched using a binary chop procedure.
38041
38042There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
38043the interface that is expected.
38044
38045
38046
38047
38048. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38049. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38050
38051. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38052. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
38053. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
38054. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
38055. processors.
38056. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38057
38058.literal xml
38059<?sdop
38060 format="newpage"
38061 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
38062 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
38063?>
38064.literal off
38065
38066.makeindex "Options index" "option"
38067.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
38068.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
38069
38070
38071. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38072. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////